Transaction Hash:
Block:
22030187 at Mar-12-2025 10:27:59 AM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.000203616174736722 ETH
$0.51
Gas Used:
185,394 Gas / 1.098288913 Gwei
Emitted Events:
157 |
SafeguardPool.PerformanceUpdated( targetBalancePerPT0=104657650109618953, targetBalancePerPT1=54480795656257, performance=1016835266604495038, amount0Per1=1890549418530000000000, time=1741775279 )
|
158 |
SafeguardPool.Transfer( from=[Sender] 0x2f5f498bc3ab1da44a987897db04b1f016027a59, to=0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000, value=99999999999999000000 )
|
159 |
Vault.PoolBalanceChanged( poolId=5EE945D9BFA5AD48C64FC7ACFED497D3546C0D03000200000000000000000000, liquidityProvider=[Sender] 0x2f5f498bc3ab1da44a987897db04b1f016027a59, tokens=[0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48, 0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2], deltas=[-11372468, -4968481463093873], protocolFeeAmounts=[0, 0] )
|
160 |
FiatTokenProxy.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000d315a9c38ec871068fec378e4ce78af528c76293, 0x0000000000000000000000002f5f498bc3ab1da44a987897db04b1f016027a59, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000ad87b4 )
|
161 |
WETH9.Transfer( src=[Receiver] Vault, dst=[Sender] 0x2f5f498bc3ab1da44a987897db04b1f016027a59, wad=4968481463093873 )
|
Account State Difference:
Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
---|---|---|---|---|---|
0x2F5F498b...016027A59 | (Swaap Finance V2: Deployer) |
0.603546712683866614 Eth
Nonce: 137
|
0.603343096509129892 Eth
Nonce: 138
| 0.000203616174736722 | |
0x4838B106...B0BAD5f97
Miner
| (Titan Builder) | 5.780528256962039974 Eth | 5.780620953962039974 Eth | 0.000092697 | |
0x5EE945D9...3546c0d03 | |||||
0xA0b86991...E3606eB48 | |||||
0xC02aaA39...83C756Cc2 | |||||
0xd315a9C3...528C76293 | (Swaap Finance: Vault) |
Execution Trace
Vault.exitPool( poolId=5EE945D9BFA5AD48C64FC7ACFED497D3546C0D03000200000000000000000000, sender=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, recipient=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, request=[{name:assets, type:address[], order:1, indexed:false, value:[0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48, 0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2], valueString:[0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48, 0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2]}, {name:minAmountsOut, type:uint256[], order:2, indexed:false, value:[11338351, 4953576018575028], valueString:[11338351, 4953576018575028]}, {name:userData, type:bytes, order:3, indexed:false, value:0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000056BC75E2D6300BDC0, valueString:0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000056BC75E2D6300BDC0}, {name:toInternalBalance, type:bool, order:4, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}] )
-
ProtocolFeesCollector.STATICCALL( )
SafeguardPool.onExitPool( poolId=5EE945D9BFA5AD48C64FC7ACFED497D3546C0D03000200000000000000000000, sender=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, recipient=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, balances=[1691153985, 738842838898715057], lastChangeBlock=21781092, protocolSwapFeePercentage=0, userData=0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000056BC75E2D6300BDC0 ) => ( [11372468, 4968481463093873], [0, 0] )
SafeguardPool.CALL( )
-
Vault.getPoolTokens( poolId=5EE945D9BFA5AD48C64FC7ACFED497D3546C0D03000200000000000000000000 ) => ( tokens=[0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48, 0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2], balances=[1691153985, 738842838898715057], lastChangeBlock=21781092 )
EACAggregatorProxy.STATICCALL( )
-
AccessControlledOCR2Aggregator.STATICCALL( )
-
-
FiatTokenProxy.a9059cbb( )
-
FiatTokenV2_2.transfer( to=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, value=11372468 ) => ( True )
-
-
WETH9.transfer( dst=0x2F5F498bC3AB1dA44a987897dB04b1F016027A59, wad=4968481463093873 ) => ( True )
exitPool[PoolBalances (ln:5826)]
_joinOrExit[PoolBalances (ln:5833)]
ensureInputLengthMatch[PoolBalances (ln:5883)]
_require[InputHelpers (ln:1752)]
_translateToIERC20[PoolBalances (ln:5886)]
_validateTokensAndGetBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5887)]
_getPoolTokens[PoolBalances (ln:6091)]
ensureInputLengthMatch[PoolBalances (ln:6092)]
_require[InputHelpers (ln:1752)]
_require[PoolBalances (ln:6093)]
_require[PoolBalances (ln:6095)]
_callPoolBalanceChange[PoolBalances (ln:5892)]
totalsAndLastChangeBlock[PoolBalances (ln:5918)]
_getPoolAddress[PoolBalances (ln:5919)]
onJoinPool[PoolBalances (ln:5921)]
_getProtocolSwapFeePercentage[PoolBalances (ln:5927)]
onExitPool[PoolBalances (ln:5930)]
_getProtocolSwapFeePercentage[PoolBalances (ln:5936)]
ensureInputLengthMatch[PoolBalances (ln:5939)]
_require[InputHelpers (ln:1752)]
_updatePoolBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5894)]
_computeJoinPoolFinalBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5955)]
_require[PoolBalances (ln:5993)]
increaseCash[PoolBalances (ln:5998)]
decreaseCash[PoolBalances (ln:5999)]
_computeExitPoolFinalBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5956)]
_require[PoolBalances (ln:6016)]
decreaseCash[PoolBalances (ln:6019)]
add[PoolBalances (ln:6019)]
_getPoolSpecialization[PoolBalances (ln:5958)]
_setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5960)]
_setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5962)]
_setGeneralPoolBalances[PoolBalances (ln:5965)]
PoolBalanceChanged[PoolBalances (ln:5968)]
_unsafeCastToInt256[PoolBalances (ln:5973)]
_processJoinPoolTransfers[PoolBalances (ln:5898)]
_receiveAsset[PoolBalances (ln:6045)]
_isETH[PoolBalances (ln:6046)]
add[PoolBalances (ln:6047)]
_payFeeAmount[PoolBalances (ln:6050)]
_translateToIERC20[PoolBalances (ln:6050)]
_handleRemainingEth[PoolBalances (ln:6053)]
_processExitPoolTransfers[PoolBalances (ln:5899)]
_sendAsset[PoolBalances (ln:6075)]
_payFeeAmount[PoolBalances (ln:6077)]
_translateToIERC20[PoolBalances (ln:6077)]
_toPoolBalanceChange[PoolBalances (ln:5833)]
File 1 of 8: Vault
File 2 of 8: SafeguardPool
File 3 of 8: FiatTokenProxy
File 4 of 8: WETH9
File 5 of 8: ProtocolFeesCollector
File 6 of 8: EACAggregatorProxy
File 7 of 8: AccessControlledOCR2Aggregator
File 8 of 8: FiatTokenV2_2
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // solhint-disable /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. */ function _require( bool condition, uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix ) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode, prefix); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure { _revert(errorCode, 0x42414c); // This is the raw byte representation of "BAL" } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix) pure { uint256 prefixUint = uint256(uint24(prefix)); // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format: // 'BAL#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999). // // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters. // // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999 // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. // We first append the '#' character (0x23) to the prefix. In the case of 'BAL', it results in 0x42414c23 ('BAL#') // Then, we shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let formattedPrefix := shl(24, add(0x23, shl(8, prefixUint))) let revertReason := shl(200, add(formattedPrefix, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The string length is fixed: 7 characters. mstore(0x24, 7) // Finally, the string itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } library Errors { // Math uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0; uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1; uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2; uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3; uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4; uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5; uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6; uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7; uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8; uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9; // Input uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102; uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103; uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_DATA = 105; // Shared pools uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200; uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201; uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202; uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203; uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206; uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207; uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209; uint256 internal constant NOT_TWO_TOKENS = 210; uint256 internal constant DISABLED = 211; // Pools uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300; uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301; uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302; uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303; uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305; uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307; uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308; uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310; uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_SECONDS_QUERY = 312; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_NOT_INITIALIZED = 313; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_QUERY_TOO_OLD = 314; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_INDEX = 315; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_BAD_SECS = 316; uint256 internal constant AMP_END_TIME_TOO_CLOSE = 317; uint256 internal constant AMP_ONGOING_UPDATE = 318; uint256 internal constant AMP_RATE_TOO_HIGH = 319; uint256 internal constant AMP_NO_ONGOING_UPDATE = 320; uint256 internal constant STABLE_INVARIANT_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 321; uint256 internal constant STABLE_GET_BALANCE_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 322; uint256 internal constant RELAYER_NOT_CONTRACT = 323; uint256 internal constant BASE_POOL_RELAYER_NOT_CALLED = 324; uint256 internal constant REBALANCING_RELAYER_REENTERED = 325; uint256 internal constant GRADUAL_UPDATE_TIME_TRAVEL = 326; uint256 internal constant SWAPS_DISABLED = 327; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_LBP_OWNER = 328; uint256 internal constant PRICE_RATE_OVERFLOW = 329; uint256 internal constant INVALID_JOIN_EXIT_KIND_WHILE_SWAPS_DISABLED = 330; uint256 internal constant WEIGHT_CHANGE_TOO_FAST = 331; uint256 internal constant LOWER_GREATER_THAN_UPPER_TARGET = 332; uint256 internal constant UPPER_TARGET_TOO_HIGH = 333; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_LINEAR_POOL = 334; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_TARGET_RANGE = 335; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_EXIT_KIND = 336; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_EXIT = 337; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 338; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_MANAGED_POOL = 339; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_PHANTOM_POOL = 340; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_DOES_NOT_HAVE_RATE_PROVIDER = 341; uint256 internal constant INVALID_INITIALIZATION = 342; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_NEW_TARGET_RANGE = 343; uint256 internal constant FEATURE_DISABLED = 344; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED_POOL_CONTROLLER = 345; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_DURING_FEE_CHANGE = 346; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_PENDING_FEE_CHANGE = 347; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_DURING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 348; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_PENDING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 349; uint256 internal constant MAX_WEIGHT = 350; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_JOIN = 351; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 352; uint256 internal constant FRACTIONAL_TARGET = 353; uint256 internal constant ADD_OR_REMOVE_BPT = 354; uint256 internal constant INVALID_CIRCUIT_BREAKER_BOUNDS = 355; uint256 internal constant CIRCUIT_BREAKER_TRIPPED = 356; uint256 internal constant MALICIOUS_QUERY_REVERT = 357; uint256 internal constant JOINS_EXITS_DISABLED = 358; // Lib uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401; uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402; uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403; uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404; uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409; uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414; uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417; uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421; uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422; uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423; uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424; uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_OWNER = 426; uint256 internal constant NEW_OWNER_IS_ZERO = 427; uint256 internal constant CODE_DEPLOYMENT_FAILED = 428; uint256 internal constant CALL_TO_NON_CONTRACT = 429; uint256 internal constant LOW_LEVEL_CALL_FAILED = 430; uint256 internal constant NOT_PAUSED = 431; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_ALREADY_ALLOWLISTED = 432; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_NOT_ALLOWLISTED = 433; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 434; uint256 internal constant INVALID_OPERATION = 435; uint256 internal constant CODEC_OVERFLOW = 436; uint256 internal constant IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 437; uint256 internal constant NOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 438; uint256 internal constant INDUCED_FAILURE = 439; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_SIGNATURE = 440; uint256 internal constant MALFORMED_SIGNATURE = 441; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_UINT64 = 442; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_FEE_TYPE = 443; uint256 internal constant BURN_FROM_ZERO = 444; // Vault uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502; uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503; uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504; uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505; uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506; uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507; uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509; uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510; uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511; uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513; uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514; uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516; uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517; uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524; uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525; uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526; uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528; // Fees uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600; uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602; uint256 internal constant AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 603; // FeeSplitter uint256 internal constant SPLITTER_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 700; // Misc uint256 internal constant UNIMPLEMENTED = 998; uint256 internal constant SHOULD_NOT_HAPPEN = 999; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthentication { /** * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`. */ function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions. */ interface ISignaturesValidator { /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator. */ function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages. */ function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper. */ interface ITemporarilyPausable { /** * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`. */ event PausedStateChanged(bool paused); /** * @dev Returns the current paused state. */ function getPausedState() external view returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for WETH9. * See https://github.com/gnosis/canonical-weth/blob/0dd1ea3e295eef916d0c6223ec63141137d22d67/contracts/WETH9.sol */ interface IWETH is IERC20 { function deposit() external payable; function withdraw(uint256 amount) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like * types. * * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers. */ interface IAsset { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthorizer { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`. */ function canPerform( bytes32 actionId, address account, address where ) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not * the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from * either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool */ interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs { /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of * each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault. * The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect * the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join. * * `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account * designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `balances` contains the total balances * for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares. */ function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many * tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes * to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`, * as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on * `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share. * * `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account * to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `balances` contains the total token balances for each token * the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares. */ function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Returns this Pool's ID, used when interacting with the Vault (to e.g. join the Pool or swap with it). */ function getPoolId() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the current swap fee percentage as a 18 decimal fixed point number, so e.g. 1e17 corresponds to a * 10% swap fee. */ function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the scaling factors of each of the Pool's tokens. This is an implementation detail that is typically * not relevant for outside parties, but which might be useful for some types of Pools. */ function getScalingFactors() external view returns (uint256[] memory); function queryJoin( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn); function queryExit( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver. import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IFlashLoanRecipient { /** * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient. * * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert. * * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call. */ function receiveFlashLoan( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory feeAmounts, bytes memory userData ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev IPools with the General specialization setting should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will * grant to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IGeneralPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 indexIn, uint256 indexOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant * to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; interface IPoolSwapStructs { // This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and // IMinimalSwapInfoPool. // // This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or // 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known. // // The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take // in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`. // // All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in // some Pools. // // `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than // one Pool. // // The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization: // - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total // balance. // - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance. // // `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address // where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens. // // `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party. struct SwapRequest { IVault.SwapKind kind; IERC20 tokenIn; IERC20 tokenOut; uint256 amount; // Misc data bytes32 poolId; uint256 lastChangeBlock; address from; address to; bytes userData; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; interface IProtocolFeesCollector { event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage); event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage); function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external; function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external; function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external; function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts); function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); function vault() external view returns (IVault); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "./IAsset.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "./IProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that * don't override one of these declarations. */ interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable, IAuthentication { // Generalities about the Vault: // // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful. // // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g. // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results. // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered. // // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools. // Authorizer // // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller // can perform a given action. /** * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer. */ function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); /** * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this. * * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event. */ function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`. */ event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer); // Relayers // // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions, // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield // this power, two things must occur: // - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This // means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended // functions. // - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf. // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user. /** * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise. * * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event. */ function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external; /** * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`. */ event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved); // Internal Balance // // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. // // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. /** * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens. */ function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer) * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance. * * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. */ function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable; /** * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping. */ struct UserBalanceOp { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; } // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`: // // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is // relevant for relayers). // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send // it to the recipient as ETH. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event. enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL } /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance. * * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH * address. */ event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta); /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account. */ event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount); // Pools // // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced // functionality: // // - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads), // which increase with the number of registered tokens. // // - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are // independent of the number of registered tokens. // // - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool. enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN } /** * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be * changed. * * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`, * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract. * * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words, * multiple Pools may share the same contract. * * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event. */ function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`. */ event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting. */ function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization); /** * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens, * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens. * * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in * ascending order. * * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`, * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an * Asset Manager should not be made lightly. * * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a * different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event. */ function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`. */ event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers); /** * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call. * * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event. */ function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`. */ event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens); /** * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token. * * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token` * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`. * * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`, * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`. * * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager. */ function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of * the tokens' `balances` changed. * * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order. * * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same * order as passed to `registerTokens`. * * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo` * instead. */ function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ); /** * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized * Pool shares. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces * these maximums. * * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers). * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable; struct JoinPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] maxAmountsIn; bytes userData; bool fromInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see * `getPoolTokenInfo`). * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: * it just enforces these minimums. * * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit. * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise, * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to * do so will trigger a revert. * * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and * passed directly to the Pool's contract. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external; struct ExitPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] minAmountsOut; bytes userData; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively. */ event PoolBalanceChanged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed liquidityProvider, IERC20[] tokens, int256[] deltas, uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts ); enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT } // Swaps // // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this, // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote. // // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together // individual swaps. // // There are two swap kinds: // - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient). // - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender). // // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at // the final intended token. // // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost // much less gas than they would otherwise. // // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only // updating the Pool's internal accounting). // // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified. // // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly). // // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers). // // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens. enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT } /** * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool. * * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`. * * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`. * * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. * * Emits a `Swap` event. */ function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (uint256); /** * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on * the `kind` value. * * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct SingleSwap { bytes32 poolId; SwapKind kind; IAsset assetIn; IAsset assetOut; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value. * * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at * the same index in the `assets` array. * * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind. * * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`. * * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses, * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer. * * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the * equivalent `swap` call. * * Emits `Swap` events. */ function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (int256[] memory); /** * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH. * * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct BatchSwapStep { bytes32 poolId; uint256 assetInIndex; uint256 assetOutIndex; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`. */ event Swap( bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20 indexed tokenIn, IERC20 indexed tokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ); /** * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the * `recipient` account. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20 * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender` * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of * `joinPool`. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`. * * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a * revert. */ struct FundManagement { address sender; bool fromInternalBalance; address payable recipient; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result. * * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH) * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive. * * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct. * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens, * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address. * * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas); // Flash Loans /** * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it, * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned. * * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order. * * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the * `receiveFlashLoan` call. * * Emits `FlashLoan` events. */ function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external; /** * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`. */ event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount); // Asset Management // // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings. // // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit, // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols. // // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface. /** * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates. * * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once. * * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`. */ function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external; struct PoolBalanceOp { PoolBalanceOpKind kind; bytes32 poolId; IERC20 token; uint256 amount; } /** * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total. * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss). */ enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE } /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`. */ event PoolBalanceManaged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed assetManager, IERC20 indexed token, int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta ); // Protocol Fees // // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by // permissioned accounts. // // There are two kinds of protocol fees: // // - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent. // // - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather, // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share. /** * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module. */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (IProtocolFeesCollector); /** * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an * error in some part of the system. * * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled. * * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled: * - depositing and transferring internal balance * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance) * - swaps * - joining Pools * - Asset Manager interactions * * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited. */ function setPaused(bool paused) external; /** * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance. */ function WETH() external view returns (IWETH); // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; /** * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions. * * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic. */ abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication { bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator; /** * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in * multi contract systems. * * There are two main uses for it: * - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers * unique. The contract's own address is a good option. * - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier * shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead. */ constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) { _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticate() { _authenticateCaller(); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function. */ function _authenticateCaller() internal view { bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig); _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED); } function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) { // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of // multiple contracts. return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector)); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../openzeppelin/EIP712.sol"; /** * @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls. */ abstract contract EOASignaturesValidator is ISignaturesValidator, EIP712 { // Replay attack prevention for each account. mapping(address => uint256) internal _nextNonce; function getDomainSeparator() public view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } function getNextNonce(address account) public view override returns (uint256) { return _nextNonce[account]; } function _ensureValidSignature( address account, bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 errorCode ) internal { return _ensureValidSignature(account, structHash, signature, type(uint256).max, errorCode); } function _ensureValidSignature( address account, bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 deadline, uint256 errorCode ) internal { bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); _require(_isValidSignature(account, digest, signature), errorCode); // We could check for the deadline before validating the signature, but this leads to saner error processing (as // we only care about expired deadlines if the signature is correct) and only affects the gas cost of the revert // scenario, which will only occur infrequently, if ever. // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(deadline >= block.timestamp, Errors.EXPIRED_SIGNATURE); // We only advance the nonce after validating the signature. This is irrelevant for this module, but it can be // important in derived contracts that override _isValidSignature (e.g. SignaturesValidator), as we want for // the observable state to still have the current nonce as the next valid one. _nextNonce[account] += 1; } function _isValidSignature( address account, bytes32 digest, bytes memory signature ) internal view virtual returns (bool) { _require(signature.length == 65, Errors.MALFORMED_SIGNATURE); bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint8 v; // ecrecover takes the r, s and v signature parameters, and the only way to get them is to use assembly. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) s := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60))) } address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s); // ecrecover returns the zero address on recover failure, so we need to handle that explicitly. return (recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == account); } function _toArraySignature( uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { bytes memory signature = new bytes(65); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { mstore(add(signature, 32), r) mstore(add(signature, 64), s) mstore8(add(signature, 96), v) } return signature; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./EOASignaturesValidator.sol"; /** * @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls. * * This contract relies on the fact that Solidity contracts can be called with extra calldata, and enables * meta-transaction schemes by appending an EIP712 signature of the original calldata at the end. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_entrypointTypeHash` function to map function selectors to EIP712 structs. */ abstract contract ExtraCalldataEOASignaturesValidator is EOASignaturesValidator { // The appended data consists of a deadline, plus the [v,r,s] signature. For simplicity, we use a full 256 bit slot // for each of these values, even if 'v' is typically an 8 bit value. uint256 internal constant _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH = 4 * 32; /** * @dev Reverts with `errorCode` unless a valid signature for `user` was appended to the calldata. */ function _validateExtraCalldataSignature(address user, uint256 errorCode) internal { bytes32 typeHash = _entrypointTypeHash(); // Prevent accidental signature validation for functions that don't have an associated type hash. _require(typeHash != bytes32(0), errorCode); uint256 deadline = _deadline(); // All type hashes have this format: (bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline). bytes32 structHash = keccak256( abi.encode(typeHash, keccak256(_calldata()), msg.sender, getNextNonce(user), deadline) ); _ensureValidSignature(user, structHash, _signature(), deadline, errorCode); } /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 type hash for the current entry point function, which can be identified by its function * selector (available as `msg.sig`). * * The type hash must conform to the following format: * <name>(bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline) * * If 0x00, all signatures will be considered invalid. */ function _entrypointTypeHash() internal view virtual returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Extracts the signature deadline from extra calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _deadline() internal pure returns (uint256) { // The deadline is the first extra argument at the end of the original calldata. return uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0)); } /** * @dev Extracts the signature parameters from extra calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. This is not a security risk, as that data would not * be considered a valid signature in the first place. */ function _signature() internal pure returns (bytes memory) { // v, r and s are appended after the signature deadline, in that order. uint8 v = uint8(uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x20))); bytes32 r = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x40); bytes32 s = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x60); return _toArraySignature(v, r, s); } /** * @dev Returns the original calldata, without the extra bytes containing the signature. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _calldata() internal pure returns (bytes memory result) { result = msg.data; // A calldata to memory assignment results in memory allocation and copy of contents. if (result.length > _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We simply overwrite the array length with the reduced one. mstore(result, sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH)) } } } /** * @dev Returns a 256 bit word from 'extra' calldata, at some offset from the expected end of the original calldata. * * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. */ function _decodeExtraCalldataWord(uint256 offset) private pure returns (bytes32 result) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { result := calldataload(add(sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH), offset)) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; library InputHelpers { function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure { _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureInputLengthMatch( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 c ) internal pure { _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure { if (array.length < 2) { return; } address previous = array[0]; for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) { address current = array[i]; _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY); previous = current; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; /** * @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be * used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified. * * The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be * unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets * system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful * analysis later determines there was a false alarm. * * If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional * Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time * to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires. * * Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is * irreversible. */ abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable { // The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime; uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime; bool private _paused; constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) { _require(pauseWindowDuration <= PausableConstants.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION); _require( bufferPeriodDuration <= PausableConstants.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION ); uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration; _pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime; _bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration; } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ modifier whenNotPaused() { _ensureNotPaused(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer * Period. */ function getPausedState() external view override returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ) { paused = !_isNotPaused(); pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime(); bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime(); } /** * @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and * unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally. */ function _setPaused(bool paused) internal { if (paused) { _require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED); } else { _require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED); } _paused = paused; emit PausedStateChanged(paused); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ function _ensureNotPaused() internal view { _require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is not paused. */ function _ensurePaused() internal view { _require(!_isNotPaused(), Errors.NOT_PAUSED); } /** * @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no * longer accessed. */ function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) { // After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access. return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused; } // These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place. function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _pauseWindowEndTime; } function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _bufferPeriodEndTime; } } /** * @dev Keep the maximum durations in a single place. */ library PausableConstants { uint256 public constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 270 days; uint256 public constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 90 days; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./LogExpMath.sol"; /* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */ library FixedPoint { // solhint-disable no-inline-assembly uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places uint256 internal constant TWO = 2 * ONE; uint256 internal constant FOUR = 4 * ONE; uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14) // Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE). uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18; function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return product / ONE; } function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, if x == 0 then the result is zero // // Equivalent to: // result = product == 0 ? 0 : ((product - 1) / FixedPoint.ONE) + 1; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(product)), add(div(sub(product, 1), ONE), 1)) } } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(a == 0 || aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow return aInflated / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(a == 0 || aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, if x == 0 then the result is zero // // Equivalent to: // result = a == 0 ? 0 : (a * FixedPoint.ONE - 1) / b + 1; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(aInflated)), add(div(sub(aInflated, 1), b), 1)) } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive). */ function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Optimize for when y equals 1.0, 2.0 or 4.0, as those are very simple to implement and occur often in 50/50 // and 80/20 Weighted Pools if (y == ONE) { return x; } else if (y == TWO) { return mulDown(x, x); } else if (y == FOUR) { uint256 square = mulDown(x, x); return mulDown(square, square); } else { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); if (raw < maxError) { return 0; } else { return sub(raw, maxError); } } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative). */ function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Optimize for when y equals 1.0, 2.0 or 4.0, as those are very simple to implement and occur often in 50/50 // and 80/20 Weighted Pools if (y == ONE) { return x; } else if (y == TWO) { return mulUp(x, x); } else if (y == FOUR) { uint256 square = mulUp(x, x); return mulUp(square, square); } else { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); return add(raw, maxError); } } /** * @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1. * * Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and * prevents intermediate negative values. */ function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0; assembly { result := mul(lt(x, ONE), sub(ONE, x)) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated // documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the // rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to // permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: // The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the // Software. // THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE // WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR // COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR // OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable */ /** * @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument). * * Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural * exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number). * * @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli * @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman * @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z */ library LogExpMath { // All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying // two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them. // All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers. int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18; // Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the // case of ln36, 36 decimals. int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20; int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36; // The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used. // // Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is // (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221. // The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument // ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312. // We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin. int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18; int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18; // Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point // 256 bit integer. int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17; int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17; uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20); // 18 decimal constants int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7 int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals) int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6 int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals) // 20 decimal constants int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5 int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2) int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4 int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3) int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3 int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4) int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2 int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5) int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1 int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6) int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0 int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7) int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1 int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8) int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2 int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9) int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3 int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10) int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4 int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11) /** * @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent. * * Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (y == 0) { // We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one. return uint256(ONE_18); } if (x == 0) { return 0; } // Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to // arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means // x^y = exp(y * ln(x)). // The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(x >> 255 == 0, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 x_int256 = int256(x); // We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In // both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end. // This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 y_int256 = int256(y); int256 logx_times_y; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { int256 ln_36_x = _ln_36(x_int256); // ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just // bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal // multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the // (downscaled) last 18 decimals. logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18); } else { logx_times_y = _ln(x_int256) * y_int256; } logx_times_y /= ONE_18; // Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y _require( MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS ); return uint256(exp(logx_times_y)); } /** * @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent. * * Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT); if (x < 0) { // We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it // fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT). // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x)); } // First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n, // where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 // because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the // decomposition. // At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n. // exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause // intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals. // Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the // decomposition. // For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct // it and compute the accumulated product. int256 firstAN; if (x >= x0) { x -= x0; firstAN = a0; } else if (x >= x1) { x -= x1; firstAN = a1; } else { firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places } // We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the // smaller terms. x *= 100; // `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point // one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20. int256 product = ONE_20; if (x >= x2) { x -= x2; product = (product * a2) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x3) { x -= x3; product = (product * a3) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x4) { x -= x4; product = (product * a4) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x5) { x -= x5; product = (product * a5) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x6) { x -= x6; product = (product * a6) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x7) { x -= x7; product = (product * a7) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x8) { x -= x8; product = (product * a8) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x9) { x -= x9; product = (product * a9) / ONE_20; } // x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already. // Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series // expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!). int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places. int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!). // The first term is simply x. term = x; seriesSum += term; // Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number, // multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not. term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12; seriesSum += term; // 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision. // We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor // approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply // all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication), // and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value. return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100; } /** * @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument. */ function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) { // This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base). // Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by // upscaling. int256 logBase; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logBase = _ln_36(base); } else { logBase = _ln(base) * ONE_18; } int256 logArg; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logArg = _ln_36(arg); } else { logArg = _ln(arg) * ONE_18; } // When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase; } /** * @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) { // The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero. _require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < a && a < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { return _ln_36(a) / ONE_18; } else { return _ln(a); } } /** * @dev Internal natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function _ln(int256 a) private pure returns (int256) { if (a < ONE_18) { // Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less // than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call. // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return (-_ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a)); } // First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which // we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is, // ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot // be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a. // At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n. // ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point // numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by // ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point. // For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide // by it and compute the accumulated sum. int256 sum = 0; if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) { a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x0; } if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) { a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x1; } // All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format. sum *= 100; a *= 100; // Because further a_n are 20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them. if (a >= a2) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a2; sum += x2; } if (a >= a3) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a3; sum += x3; } if (a >= a4) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a4; sum += x4; } if (a >= a5) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a5; sum += x5; } if (a >= a6) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a6; sum += x6; } if (a >= a7) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a7; sum += x7; } if (a >= a8) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a8; sum += x8; } if (a >= a9) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a9; sum += x9; } if (a >= a10) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a10; sum += x10; } if (a >= a11) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a11; sum += x11; } // a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series // that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36. // Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1). // ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_20. int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 11; // 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder) seriesSum *= 2; // We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both // with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal // value. return (sum + seriesSum) / 100; } /** * @dev Intrnal high precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument, * for x close to one. * * Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND. */ function _ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) { // Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits // worthwhile. // First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value. x *= ONE_18; // We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1). // ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_36. int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 11; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 13; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 15; // 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point). return seriesSum * 2; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks. * Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library. */ library Math { // solhint-disable no-inline-assembly /** * @dev Returns the absolute value of a signed integer. */ function abs(int256 a) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = a > 0 ? uint256(a) : uint256(-a) assembly { let s := sar(255, a) result := sub(xor(a, s), s) } } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a + b; _require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a - b; _require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = (a < b) ? b : a; assembly { result := sub(a, mul(sub(a, b), lt(a, b))) } } /** * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to `result = (a < b) ? a : b` assembly { result := sub(a, mul(sub(a, b), gt(a, b))) } } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a * b; _require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return c; } function div( uint256 a, uint256 b, bool roundUp ) internal pure returns (uint256) { return roundUp ? divUp(a, b) : divDown(a, b); } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); return a / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); // Equivalent to: // result = a == 0 ? 0 : 1 + (a - 1) / b; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(a)), add(1, div(sub(a, 1), b))) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the Address library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered by removing the `isContract` checks on // `functionCall` and `functionDelegateCall` in order to save gas, as the recipients are known to be contracts. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } // solhint-disable max-line-length /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); _require(success, Errors.ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call(data); return verifyCallResult(success, returndata); } // solhint-enable max-line-length /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but passing some native ETH as msg.value to the call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionCallWithValue( address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value ) internal returns (bytes memory) { // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data); return verifyCallResult(success, returndata); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return verifyCallResult(success, returndata); } /** * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling up the * revert reason or using the one provided. * * _Available since v4.3._ */ function verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { _revert(Errors.LOW_LEVEL_CALL_FAILED); } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { _HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name)); _HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version)); _TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)"); } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash)); } // solc-ignore-next-line func-mutability function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { chainId := chainid() } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the EnumerableMap library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to include the following: // * a map from IERC20 to bytes32 // * entries are stored in mappings instead of arrays, reducing implicit storage reads for out-of-bounds checks // * unchecked_at and unchecked_valueAt, which allow for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios // * indexOf, unchecked_indexOf and unchecked_setAt, which allow for more gas efficient data writes in some scenarios // // Additionally, the base private functions that work on bytes32 were removed and replaced with a native implementation // for IERC20 keys, to reduce bytecode size and runtime costs. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Library for managing an enumerable variant of Solidity's * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/types.html#mapping-types[`mapping`] * type. * * Maps have the following properties: * * - Entries are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Entries are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private myMap; * } * ``` */ library EnumerableMap { // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Map type with bytes32 keys: this was replaced with // IERC20ToBytes32Map and IERC20ToUint256Map, resulting in more dense bytecode (as long as each contract only uses // one of these - there'll otherwise be duplicated code). // IERC20ToBytes32Map // solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase struct IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry { IERC20 _key; bytes32 _value; } struct IERC20ToBytes32Map { // Number of entries in the map uint256 _length; // Storage of map keys and values mapping(uint256 => IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry) _entries; // Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1 // because index 0 means a key is not in the map. mapping(IERC20 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing * key. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not * already present. */ function set( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key, bytes32 value ) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to !contains(map, key) if (keyIndex == 0) { uint256 previousLength = map._length; map._entries[previousLength] = IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value }); map._length = previousLength + 1; // The entry is stored at previousLength, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value map._indexes[key] = previousLength + 1; return true; } else { map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value; return false; } } /** * @dev Updates the value for an entry, given its key's index. The key index can be retrieved via * {unchecked_indexOf}, and it should be noted that key indices may change when calling {set} or {remove}. O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {set}, but it should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_setAt( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index, bytes32 value ) internal { map._entries[index]._value = value; } /** * @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present. */ function remove(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to contains(map, key) if (keyIndex != 0) { // To delete a key-value pair from the _entries pseudo-array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the // one at the highest index, and then remove this last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the pseudo-array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = map._length - 1; // The swap is only necessary if we're not removing the last element if (toDeleteIndex != lastIndex) { IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex]; // Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry; // Update the index for the moved entry map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based } // Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored delete map._entries[lastIndex]; map._length = lastIndex; // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete map._indexes[key]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1). */ function contains(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (bool) { return map._indexes[key] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1). */ function length(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._length; } /** * @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the * array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) { _require(map._length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(map, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the map (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) { IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index]; return (entry._key, entry._value); } /** * @dev Same as {unchecked_At}, except it only returns the value and not the key (performing one less storage * read). O(1). */ function unchecked_valueAt(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) { return map._entries[index]._value; } /** * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. Reverts with `errorCode` otherwise. */ function get( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode ) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 index = map._indexes[key]; _require(index > 0, errorCode); return unchecked_valueAt(map, index - 1); } /** * @dev Returns the index for `key`. * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. */ function indexOf( IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode ) internal view returns (uint256) { uint256 uncheckedIndex = unchecked_indexOf(map, key); _require(uncheckedIndex != 0, errorCode); return uncheckedIndex - 1; } /** * @dev Returns the index for `key` **plus one**. Does not revert if the key is not in the map, and returns 0 * instead. */ function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._indexes[key]; } // IERC20ToUint256Map struct IERC20ToUint256MapEntry { IERC20 _key; uint256 _value; } struct IERC20ToUint256Map { // Number of entries in the map uint256 _length; // Storage of map keys and values mapping(uint256 => IERC20ToUint256MapEntry) _entries; // Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1 // because index 0 means a key is not in the map. mapping(IERC20 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing * key. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not * already present. */ function set( IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 value ) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to !contains(map, key) if (keyIndex == 0) { uint256 previousLength = map._length; map._entries[previousLength] = IERC20ToUint256MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value }); map._length = previousLength + 1; // The entry is stored at previousLength, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value map._indexes[key] = previousLength + 1; return true; } else { map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value; return false; } } /** * @dev Updates the value for an entry, given its key's index. The key index can be retrieved via * {unchecked_indexOf}, and it should be noted that key indices may change when calling {set} or {remove}. O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {set}, but it should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_setAt( IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, uint256 index, uint256 value ) internal { map._entries[index]._value = value; } /** * @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1). * * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present. */ function remove(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key]; // Equivalent to contains(map, key) if (keyIndex != 0) { // To delete a key-value pair from the _entries pseudo-array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the // one at the highest index, and then remove this last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the pseudo-array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = map._length - 1; // The swap is only necessary if we're not removing the last element if (toDeleteIndex != lastIndex) { IERC20ToUint256MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex]; // Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry; // Update the index for the moved entry map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based } // Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored delete map._entries[lastIndex]; map._length = lastIndex; // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete map._indexes[key]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1). */ function contains(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (bool) { return map._indexes[key] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1). */ function length(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._length; } /** * @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the * array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, uint256) { _require(map._length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(map, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the map (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ function unchecked_at(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, uint256) { IERC20ToUint256MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index]; return (entry._key, entry._value); } /** * @dev Same as {unchecked_At}, except it only returns the value and not the key (performing one less storage * read). O(1). */ function unchecked_valueAt(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._entries[index]._value; } /** * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1). * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. Reverts with `errorCode` otherwise. */ function get( IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode ) internal view returns (uint256) { uint256 index = map._indexes[key]; _require(index > 0, errorCode); return unchecked_valueAt(map, index - 1); } /** * @dev Returns the index for `key`. * * Requirements: * * - `key` must be in the map. */ function indexOf( IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode ) internal view returns (uint256) { uint256 uncheckedIndex = unchecked_indexOf(map, key); _require(uncheckedIndex != 0, errorCode); return uncheckedIndex - 1; } /** * @dev Returns the index for `key` **plus one**. Does not revert if the key is not in the map, and returns 0 * instead. */ function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20ToUint256Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (uint256) { return map._indexes[key]; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the EnumerableSet library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to remove the base private functions that // work on bytes32, replacing them with a native implementation for address and bytes32 values, to reduce bytecode // size and runtime costs. // The `unchecked_at` function was also added, which allows for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Library for managing * https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive * types. * * Sets have the following properties: * * - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time * (O(1)). * - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering. * * ``` * contract Example { * // Add the library methods * using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; * * // Declare a set state variable * EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet; * } * ``` * * As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`) * and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported. */ library EnumerableSet { // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Set type with bytes32 values: this was replaced with // AddressSet, which uses address keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode. struct AddressSet { // Storage of set values address[] _values; // Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0 // means a value is not in the set. mapping(address => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, if it was not already present. */ function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { if (!contains(set, value)) { set._values.push(value); // The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value set._indexes[value] = set._values.length; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was * present. */ function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value]; if (valueIndex != 0) { // Equivalent to contains(set, value) // To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in // the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1; // The swap is only necessary if we're not removing the last element if (toDeleteIndex != lastIndex) { address lastValue = set._values[lastIndex]; // Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue; // Update the index for the moved value set._indexes[lastValue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based } // Delete the slot where the moved value was stored set._values.pop(); // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete set._indexes[value]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) { return set._indexes[value] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1). */ function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return set._values.length; } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) { _require(set._values.length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(set, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the set (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function unchecked_at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) { return set._values[index]; } function rawIndexOf(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (uint256) { return set._indexes[value] - 1; } struct Bytes32Set { // Storage of set values bytes32[] _values; // Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0 // means a value is not in the set. mapping(bytes32 => uint256) _indexes; } /** * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not * already present. */ function add(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) { if (!contains(set, value)) { set._values.push(value); // The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes // and use 0 as a sentinel value set._indexes[value] = set._values.length; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1). * * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was present. */ function remove(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) { // We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value]; if (valueIndex != 0) { // Equivalent to contains(set, value) // To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in // the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop'). // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}. uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1; uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1; // The swap is only necessary if we're not removing the last element if (toDeleteIndex != lastIndex) { bytes32 lastValue = set._values[lastIndex]; // Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue; // Update the index for the moved value set._indexes[lastValue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based } // Delete the slot where the moved value was stored set._values.pop(); // Delete the index for the deleted slot delete set._indexes[value]; return true; } else { return false; } } /** * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1). */ function contains(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (bool) { return set._indexes[value] != 0; } /** * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1). */ function length(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (uint256) { return set._values.length; } /** * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1). * * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed. * * Requirements: * * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}. */ function at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) { _require(set._values.length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); return unchecked_at(set, index); } /** * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the set (i.e. if it is equal or larger * than {length}). O(1). * * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be * within bounds. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function unchecked_at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) { return set._values[index]; } function rawIndexOf(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (uint256) { return set._indexes[value] - 1; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size. // Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using // private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs, but reduced bytecode size. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function. * * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested * (reentrant) calls to them. * * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry * points to them. * * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways * to protect against it, check out our blog post * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul]. */ abstract contract ReentrancyGuard { // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled. // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive, // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect. uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1; uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2; uint256 private _status; constructor() { _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } /** * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly. * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant` * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a * `private` function that does the actual work. */ modifier nonReentrant() { _enterNonReentrant(); _; _exitNonReentrant(); } function _enterNonReentrant() private { // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY); // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail _status = _ENTERED; } function _exitNonReentrant() private { // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200) _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow * checks. * * Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can * easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually * assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by * reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. * * Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing * all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting. */ library SafeCast { /** * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256. * * Requirements: * * - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256. */ function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(value >> 255 == 0, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256); return int256(value); } /** * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into an unsigned uint64. * * Requirements: * * - input must be less than or equal to maxUint64. */ function toUint64(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint64) { _require(value <= type(uint64).max, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_UINT64); return uint64(value); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to reduce gas costs. // The `safeTransfer` and `safeTransferFrom` functions assume that `token` is a contract (an account with code), and // work differently from the OpenZeppelin version if it is not. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @title SafeERC20 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be * successful. * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract, * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc. */ library SafeERC20 { function safeApprove( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { // Some contracts need their allowance reduced to 0 before setting it to an arbitrary amount. if (value != 0 && token.allowance(address(this), address(to)) != 0) { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, 0)); } _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransfer( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransferFrom( IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)); } /** * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false). * * WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert. */ function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private { // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since // we're implementing it ourselves. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data); // If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { if eq(success, 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } } // Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs _require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IAsset.sol"; abstract contract AssetHelpers { // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase IWETH private immutable _weth; // Sentinel value used to indicate WETH with wrapping/unwrapping semantics. The zero address is a good choice for // multiple reasons: it is cheap to pass as a calldata argument, it is a known invalid token and non-contract, and // it is an address Pools cannot register as a token. address private constant _ETH = address(0); constructor(IWETH weth) { _weth = weth; } // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function _WETH() internal view returns (IWETH) { return _weth; } /** * @dev Returns true if `asset` is the sentinel value that represents ETH. */ function _isETH(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (bool) { return address(asset) == _ETH; } /** * @dev Translates `asset` into an equivalent IERC20 token address. If `asset` represents ETH, it will be translated * to the WETH contract. */ function _translateToIERC20(IAsset asset) internal view returns (IERC20) { return _isETH(asset) ? _WETH() : _asIERC20(asset); } /** * @dev Same as `_translateToIERC20(IAsset)`, but for an entire array. */ function _translateToIERC20(IAsset[] memory assets) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory) { IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](assets.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) { tokens[i] = _translateToIERC20(assets[i]); } return tokens; } /** * @dev Interprets `asset` as an IERC20 token. This function should only be called on `asset` if `_isETH` previously * returned false for it, that is, if `asset` is guaranteed not to be the ETH sentinel value. */ function _asIERC20(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (IERC20) { return IERC20(address(asset)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "./UserBalance.sol"; import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "./balances/GeneralPoolsBalance.sol"; import "./balances/MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance.sol"; import "./balances/TwoTokenPoolsBalance.sol"; abstract contract AssetManagers is ReentrancyGuard, GeneralPoolsBalance, MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance, TwoTokenPoolsBalance { using Math for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Stores the Asset Manager for each token of each Pool. mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => address)) internal _poolAssetManagers; function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { // This variable could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each // loop iteration, increasing gas costs. PoolBalanceOp memory op; for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; ++i) { // By indexing the array only once, we don't spend extra gas in the same bounds check. op = ops[i]; bytes32 poolId = op.poolId; _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); IERC20 token = op.token; _require(_isTokenRegistered(poolId, token), Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); _require(_poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] == msg.sender, Errors.SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER); PoolBalanceOpKind kind = op.kind; uint256 amount = op.amount; (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) = _performPoolManagementOperation(kind, poolId, token, amount); emit PoolBalanceManaged(poolId, msg.sender, token, cashDelta, managedDelta); } } /** * @dev Performs the `kind` Asset Manager operation on a Pool. * * Withdrawals will transfer `amount` tokens to the caller, deposits will transfer `amount` tokens from the caller, * and updates will set the managed balance to `amount`. * * Returns a tuple with the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call. */ function _performPoolManagementOperation( PoolBalanceOpKind kind, bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256, int256) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW) { return _withdrawPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } else if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT) { return _depositPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } else { // PoolBalanceOpKind.UPDATE return _updateManagedBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount); } } /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'cash' to 'managed' balance, and transfers them to the caller. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary. */ function _withdrawPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _generalPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount); } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amount); } // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer. cashDelta = int256(-amount); managedDelta = int256(amount); } /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'managed' to 'cash' balance, and transfers them from the caller. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary. */ function _depositPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _generalPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount); } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount); } // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer. cashDelta = int256(amount); managedDelta = int256(-amount); } /** * @dev Sets a Pool's 'managed' balance to `amount`. * * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call (the 'cash' delta will always be zero). */ function _updateManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) { if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { managedDelta = _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { managedDelta = _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL managedDelta = _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount); } cashDelta = 0; } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered for `poolId`. */ function _isTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) private view returns (bool) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { return _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { return _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL return _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IAsset.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/Address.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "./AssetHelpers.sol"; abstract contract AssetTransfersHandler is AssetHelpers { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using Address for address payable; /** * @dev Receives `amount` of `asset` from `sender`. If `fromInternalBalance` is true, it first withdraws as much * as possible from Internal Balance, then transfers any remaining amount. * * If `asset` is ETH, `fromInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds * will be wrapped into WETH. * * WARNING: this function does not check that the contract caller has actually supplied any ETH - it is up to the * caller of this function to check that this is true to prevent the Vault from using its own ETH (though the Vault * typically doesn't hold any). */ function _receiveAsset( IAsset asset, uint256 amount, address sender, bool fromInternalBalance ) internal { if (amount == 0) { return; } if (_isETH(asset)) { _require(!fromInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE); // The ETH amount to receive is deposited into the WETH contract, which will in turn mint WETH for // the Vault at a 1:1 ratio. // A check for this condition is also introduced by the compiler, but this one provides a revert reason. // Note we're checking for the Vault's total balance, *not* ETH sent in this transaction. _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH); _WETH().deposit{ value: amount }(); } else { IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (fromInternalBalance) { // We take as many tokens from Internal Balance as possible: any remaining amounts will be transferred. uint256 deductedBalance = _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, true); // Because `deductedBalance` will be always the lesser of the current internal balance // and the amount to decrease, it is safe to perform unchecked arithmetic. amount -= deductedBalance; } if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(sender, address(this), amount); } } } /** * @dev Sends `amount` of `asset` to `recipient`. If `toInternalBalance` is true, the asset is deposited as Internal * Balance instead of being transferred. * * If `asset` is ETH, `toInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds * are instead sent directly after unwrapping WETH. */ function _sendAsset( IAsset asset, uint256 amount, address payable recipient, bool toInternalBalance ) internal { if (amount == 0) { return; } if (_isETH(asset)) { // Sending ETH is not as involved as receiving it: the only special behavior is it cannot be // deposited to Internal Balance. _require(!toInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE); // First, the Vault withdraws deposited ETH from the WETH contract, by burning the same amount of WETH // from the Vault. This receipt will be handled by the Vault's `receive`. _WETH().withdraw(amount); // Then, the withdrawn ETH is sent to the recipient. recipient.sendValue(amount); } else { IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (toInternalBalance) { _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount); } else { token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } } /** * @dev Returns excess ETH back to the contract caller, assuming `amountUsed` has been spent. Reverts * if the caller sent less ETH than `amountUsed`. * * Because the caller might not know exactly how much ETH a Vault action will require, they may send extra. * Note that this excess value is returned *to the contract caller* (msg.sender). If caller and e.g. swap sender are * not the same (because the caller is a relayer for the sender), then it is up to the caller to manage this * returned ETH. */ function _handleRemainingEth(uint256 amountUsed) internal { _require(msg.value >= amountUsed, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH); uint256 excess = msg.value - amountUsed; if (excess > 0) { msg.sender.sendValue(excess); } } /** * @dev Enables the Vault to receive ETH. This is required for it to be able to unwrap WETH, which sends ETH to the * caller. * * Any ETH sent to the Vault outside of the WETH unwrapping mechanism would be forever locked inside the Vault, so * we prevent that from happening. Other mechanisms used to send ETH to the Vault (such as being the recipient of an * ETH swap, Pool exit or withdrawal, contract self-destruction, or receiving the block mining reward) will result * in locked funds, but are not otherwise a security or soundness issue. This check only exists as an attempt to * prevent user error. */ receive() external payable { _require(msg.sender == address(_WETH()), Errors.ETH_TRANSFER); } // This contract uses virtual internal functions instead of inheriting from the modules that implement them (in // this case UserBalance) in order to decouple it from the rest of the system and enable standalone testing by // implementing these with mocks. function _increaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal virtual; function _decreaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount, bool capped ) internal virtual returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; // This library is used to create a data structure that represents a token's balance for a Pool. 'cash' is how many // tokens the Pool has sitting inside of the Vault. 'managed' is how many tokens were withdrawn from the Vault by the // Pool's Asset Manager. 'total' is the sum of these two, and represents the Pool's total token balance, including // tokens that are *not* inside of the Vault. // // 'cash' is updated whenever tokens enter and exit the Vault, while 'managed' is only updated if the reason tokens are // moving is due to an Asset Manager action. This is reflected in the different methods available: 'increaseCash' // and 'decreaseCash' for swaps and add/remove liquidity events, and 'cashToManaged' and 'managedToCash' for events // transferring funds to and from the Asset Manager. // // The Vault disallows the Pool's 'cash' from becoming negative. In other words, it can never use any tokens that are // not inside the Vault. // // One of the goals of this library is to store the entire token balance in a single storage slot, which is why we use // 112 bit unsigned integers for 'cash' and 'managed'. For consistency, we also disallow any combination of 'cash' and // 'managed' that yields a 'total' that doesn't fit in 112 bits. // // The remaining 32 bits of the slot are used to store the most recent block when the total balance changed. This // can be used to implement price oracles that are resilient to 'sandwich' attacks. // // We could use a Solidity struct to pack these three values together in a single storage slot, but unfortunately // Solidity only allows for structs to live in either storage, calldata or memory. Because a memory struct still takes // up a slot in the stack (to store its memory location), and because the entire balance fits in a single stack slot // (two 112 bit values plus the 32 bit block), using memory is strictly less gas performant. Therefore, we do manual // packing and unpacking. // // Since we cannot define new types, we rely on bytes32 to represent these values instead, as it doesn't have any // associated arithmetic operations and therefore reduces the chance of misuse. library BalanceAllocation { using Math for uint256; // The 'cash' portion of the balance is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while the // 'managed' part uses the following 112 bits. The most significant 32 bits are used to store the block /** * @dev Returns the total amount of Pool tokens, including those that are not currently in the Vault ('managed'). */ function total(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are 112 bit values, we don't need checked arithmetic. Additionally, `toBalance` // ensures that 'total' always fits in 112 bits. return cash(balance) + managed(balance); } /** * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens currently in the Vault. */ function cash(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(balance) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens that are being managed by an Asset Manager. */ function managed(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(balance >> 112) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the last block when the total balance changed. */ function lastChangeBlock(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(32) - 1; return uint256(balance >> 224) & mask; } /** * @dev Returns the difference in 'managed' between two balances. */ function managedDelta(bytes32 newBalance, bytes32 oldBalance) internal pure returns (int256) { // Because `managed` is a 112 bit value, we can safely perform unchecked arithmetic in 256 bits. return int256(managed(newBalance)) - int256(managed(oldBalance)); } /** * @dev Returns the total balance for each entry in `balances`, as well as the latest block when the total * balance of *any* of them last changed. */ function totalsAndLastChangeBlock(bytes32[] memory balances) internal pure returns ( uint256[] memory results, uint256 lastChangeBlock_ // Avoid shadowing ) { results = new uint256[](balances.length); lastChangeBlock_ = 0; for (uint256 i = 0; i < results.length; i++) { bytes32 balance = balances[i]; results[i] = total(balance); lastChangeBlock_ = Math.max(lastChangeBlock_, lastChangeBlock(balance)); } } /** * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing * with zero. */ function isZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) { // We simply need to check the least significant 224 bytes of the word: the block does not affect this. uint256 mask = 2**(224) - 1; return (uint256(balance) & mask) == 0; } /** * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is not zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing * with zero. */ function isNotZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) { return !isZero(balance); } /** * @dev Packs together `cash` and `managed` amounts with a block to create a balance value. * * For consistency, this also checks that the sum of `cash` and `managed` (`total`) fits in 112 bits. */ function toBalance( uint256 _cash, uint256 _managed, uint256 _blockNumber ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 _total = _cash + _managed; // Since both 'cash' and 'managed' are positive integers, by checking that their sum ('total') fits in 112 bits // we are also indirectly checking that both 'cash' and 'managed' themselves fit in 112 bits. _require(_total >= _cash && _total < 2**112, Errors.BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW); // We assume the block fits in 32 bits - this is expected to hold for at least a few decades. return _pack(_cash, _managed, _blockNumber); } /** * @dev Increases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent to the Vault (except * for Asset Manager deposits). * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero. */ function increaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount); uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Decreases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent from the Vault * (except for Asset Manager withdrawals). * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero. */ function decreaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount); uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Moves 'cash' into 'managed', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager withdraws Pool tokens * from the Vault. */ function cashToManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount); uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).add(amount); uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance); return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Moves 'managed' into 'cash', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager deposits Pool tokens * into the Vault. */ function managedToCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount); uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).sub(amount); uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance); return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Sets 'managed' balance to an arbitrary value, changing 'total'. Called when the Asset Manager reports * profits or losses. It's the Manager's responsibility to provide a meaningful value. * * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `newManaged` is equal to the current 'managed' value. */ function setManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 newManaged) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 currentCash = cash(balance); uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number; return toBalance(currentCash, newManaged, newLastChangeBlock); } // Alternative mode for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting // Instead of storing cash and external for each 'token in' a single storage slot, Two Token Pools store the cash // for both tokens in the same slot, and the managed for both in another one. This reduces the gas cost for swaps, // because the only slot that needs to be updated is the one with the cash. However, it also means that managing // balances is more cumbersome, as both tokens need to be read/written at the same time. // // The field with both cash balances packed is called sharedCash, and the one with external amounts is called // sharedManaged. These two are collectively called the 'shared' balance fields. In both of these, the portion // that corresponds to token A is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while token B's part // uses the next least significant 112 bits. // // Because only cash is written to during a swap, we store the last total balance change block with the // packed cash fields. Typically Pools have a distinct block per token: in the case of Two Token Pools they // are the same. /** * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token A. This function can be used to decode both * shared cash and managed balances. */ function _decodeBalanceA(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(sharedBalance) & mask; } /** * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token B. This function can be used to decode both * shared cash and managed balances. */ function _decodeBalanceB(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) { uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1; return uint256(sharedBalance >> 112) & mask; } // To decode the last balance change block, we can simply use the `blockNumber` function. /** * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token A. */ function fromSharedToBalanceA(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps. // Both token A and token B use the same block return toBalance(_decodeBalanceA(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceA(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash)); } /** * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token B. */ function fromSharedToBalanceB(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps. // Both token A and token B use the same block return toBalance(_decodeBalanceB(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceB(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash)); } /** * @dev Returns the sharedCash shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B. */ function toSharedCash(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // Both balances are assigned the same block Since it is possible a single one of them has changed (for // example, in an Asset Manager update), we keep the latest (largest) one. uint32 newLastChangeBlock = uint32(Math.max(lastChangeBlock(tokenABalance), lastChangeBlock(tokenBBalance))); return _pack(cash(tokenABalance), cash(tokenBBalance), newLastChangeBlock); } /** * @dev Returns the sharedManaged shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B. */ function toSharedManaged(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) { // We don't bother storing a last change block, as it is read from the shared cash field. return _pack(managed(tokenABalance), managed(tokenBBalance), 0); } // Shared functions /** * @dev Packs together two uint112 and one uint32 into a bytes32 */ function _pack( uint256 _leastSignificant, uint256 _midSignificant, uint256 _mostSignificant ) private pure returns (bytes32) { return bytes32((_mostSignificant << 224) + (_midSignificant << 112) + _leastSignificant); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; abstract contract GeneralPoolsBalance { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map; // Data for Pools with the General specialization setting // // These Pools use the IGeneralPool interface, which means the Vault must query the balance for *all* of their // tokens in every swap. If we kept a mapping of token to balance plus a set (array) of tokens, it'd be very gas // intensive to read all token addresses just to then do a lookup on the balance mapping. // // Instead, we use our customized EnumerableMap, which lets us read the N balances in N+1 storage accesses (one for // each token in the Pool), access the index of any 'token in' a single read (required for the IGeneralPool call), // and update an entry's value given its index. // Map of token -> balance pairs for each Pool with this specialization. Many functions rely on storage pointers to // a Pool's EnumerableMap to save gas when computing storage slots. mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map) internal _generalPoolsBalances; /** * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _registerGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // EnumerableMaps require an explicit initial value when creating a key-value pair: we use zero, the same // value that is found in uninitialized storage, which corresponds to an empty balance. bool added = poolBalances.set(tokens[i], 0); _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); _require(currentBalance.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); // We don't need to check remove's return value, since _getGeneralPoolBalance already checks that the token // was registered. poolBalances.remove(token); } } /** * @dev Sets the balances of a General Pool's tokens to `balances`. * * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens. */ function _setGeneralPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId, bytes32[] memory balances) internal { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; ++i) { // Since we assume all balances are properly ordered, we can simply use `unchecked_setAt` to avoid one less // storage read per token. poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(i, balances[i]); } } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _generalPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _generalPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a General Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a General Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with the * current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateGeneralPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount); poolBalances.set(token, newBalance); return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance); } /** * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a General Pool. The order may change when tokens are * registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. */ function _getGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; tokens = new IERC20[](poolBalances.length()); balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableMap's length, we can use // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads. (tokens[i], balances[i]) = poolBalances.unchecked_at(i); } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getGeneralPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; return _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token); } /** * @dev Same as `_getGeneralPoolBalance` but using a Pool's storage pointer, which saves gas in repeated reads and * writes. */ function _getGeneralPoolBalance(EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances, IERC20 token) private view returns (bytes32) { return poolBalances.get(token, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a General Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. */ function _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId]; return poolBalances.contains(token); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "../PoolRegistry.sol"; abstract contract MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; // Data for Pools with the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting // // These Pools use the IMinimalSwapInfoPool interface, and so the Vault must read the balance of the two tokens // in the swap. The best solution is to use a mapping from token to balance, which lets us read or write any token's // balance in a single storage access. // // We also keep a set of registered tokens. Because tokens with non-zero balance are by definition registered, in // some balance getters we skip checking for token registration if a non-zero balance is found, saving gas by // performing a single read instead of two. mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => bytes32)) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances; mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens; /** * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { bool added = poolTokens.add(address(tokens[i])); _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty // balance. } } /** * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates */ function _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; _require(_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token].isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the balance (which may have // a non-zero last change block). delete _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; bool removed = poolTokens.remove(address(token)); _require(removed, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Sets the balances of a Minimal Swap Info Pool's tokens to `balances`. * * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens. */ function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances ) internal { for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][tokens[i]] = balances[i]; } } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. */ function _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. */ function _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with * the current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that * `token` is registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { bytes32 currentBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token); bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount); _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token] = newBalance; return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance); } /** * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. The order may change when * tokens are registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. */ function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; tokens = new IERC20[](poolTokens.length()); balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableSet's length, we can use // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads. IERC20 token = IERC20(poolTokens.unchecked_at(i)); tokens[i] = token; balances[i] = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * Requirements: * * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { bytes32 balance = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token]; // A non-zero balance guarantees that the token is registered. If zero, we manually check if the token is // registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which lets us save // gas by not performing the check. bool tokenRegistered = balance.isNotZero() || _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId].contains(address(token)); if (!tokenRegistered) { // The token might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } return balance; } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting. */ function _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId]; return poolTokens.contains(address(token)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./BalanceAllocation.sol"; import "../PoolRegistry.sol"; abstract contract TwoTokenPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; // Data for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting // // These are similar to the Minimal Swap Info Pool case (because the Pool only has two tokens, and therefore there // are only two balances to read), but there's a key difference in how data is stored. Keeping a set makes little // sense, as it will only ever hold two tokens, so we can just store those two directly. // // The gas savings associated with using these Pools come from how token balances are stored: cash amounts for token // A and token B are packed together, as are managed amounts. Because only cash changes in a swap, there's no need // to write to this second storage slot. A single last change block number for both tokens is stored with the packed // cash fields. struct TwoTokenPoolBalances { bytes32 sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged; } // We could just keep a mapping from Pool ID to TwoTokenSharedBalances, but there's an issue: we wouldn't know to // which tokens those balances correspond. This would mean having to also check which are registered with the Pool. // // What we do instead to save those storage reads is keep a nested mapping from the token pair hash to the balances // struct. The Pool only has two tokens, so only a single entry of this mapping is set (the one that corresponds to // that pair's hash). // // This has the trade-off of making Vault code that interacts with these Pools cumbersome: both balances must be // accessed at the same time by using both token addresses, and some logic is needed to determine how the pair hash // is computed. We do this by sorting the tokens, calling the token with the lowest numerical address value token A, // and the other one token B. In functions where the token arguments could be either A or B, we use X and Y instead. // // If users query a token pair containing an unregistered token, the Pool will generate a hash for a mapping entry // that was not set, and return zero balances. Non-zero balances are only possible if both tokens in the pair // are registered with the Pool, which means we don't have to check the TwoTokenPoolTokens struct, and can save // storage reads. struct TwoTokenPoolTokens { IERC20 tokenA; IERC20 tokenB; mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolBalances) balances; } mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolTokens) private _twoTokenPoolTokens; /** * @dev Registers tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must not be the same * - The tokens must be ordered: tokenX < tokenY */ function _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal { // Not technically true since we didn't register yet, but this is consistent with the error messages of other // specialization settings. _require(tokenX != tokenY, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED); _require(tokenX < tokenY, Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS); // A Two Token Pool with no registered tokens is identified by having zero addresses for tokens A and B. TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; _require(poolTokens.tokenA == IERC20(0) && poolTokens.tokenB == IERC20(0), Errors.TOKENS_ALREADY_SET); // Since tokenX < tokenY, tokenX is A and tokenY is B poolTokens.tokenA = tokenX; poolTokens.tokenB = tokenY; // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty // balance. } /** * @dev Deregisters tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. * * Requirements: * * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool * - both tokens must have zero balance in the Vault */ function _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal { ( bytes32 balanceA, bytes32 balanceB, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(poolId, tokenX, tokenY); _require(balanceA.isZero() && balanceB.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE); delete _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the packed cash field (which may // have a non-zero last change block). delete poolBalances.sharedCash; } /** * @dev Sets the cash balances of a Two Token Pool's tokens. * * WARNING: this assumes `tokenA` and `tokenB` are the Pool's two registered tokens, and are in the correct order. */ function _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB ) internal { bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash]; poolBalances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from cash into managed. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from managed into cash. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. */ function _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal { _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Two Token Pool to `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal returns (int256) { return _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount); } /** * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with * the current balance and `amount`. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is * registered for that Pool. * * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call. */ function _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation, uint256 amount ) private returns (int256) { ( TwoTokenPoolBalances storage balances, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, , bytes32 balanceB ) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); int256 delta; if (token == tokenA) { bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceA, amount); delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceA); balanceA = newBalance; } else { // token == tokenB bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceB, amount); delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceB); balanceB = newBalance; } balances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB); balances.sharedManaged = BalanceAllocation.toSharedManaged(balanceA, balanceB); return delta; } /* * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Two Token Pool. The order may change when * tokens are registered or deregistered. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. */ function _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); // Both tokens will either be zero (if unregistered) or non-zero (if registered), but we keep the full check for // clarity. if (tokenA == IERC20(0) || tokenB == IERC20(0)) { return (new IERC20[](0), new bytes32[](0)); } // Note that functions relying on this getter expect tokens to be properly ordered, so we use the (A, B) // ordering. tokens = new IERC20[](2); tokens[0] = tokenA; tokens[1] = tokenB; balances = new bytes32[](2); balances[0] = balanceA; balances[1] = balanceB; } /** * @dev Same as `_getTwoTokenPoolTokens`, except it returns the two tokens and balances directly instead of using * an array, as well as a storage pointer to the `TwoTokenPoolBalances` struct, which can be used to update it * without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot. */ function _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId) private view returns ( TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB ) { TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; tokenA = poolTokens.tokenA; tokenB = poolTokens.tokenB; bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); poolBalances = poolTokens.balances[pairHash]; bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged; balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged); balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged); } /** * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting. * * This function is convenient but not particularly gas efficient, and should be avoided during gas-sensitive * operations, such as swaps. For those, _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances provides a more flexible interface. * * Requirements: * * - `token` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) { // We can't just read the balance of token, because we need to know the full pair in order to compute the pair // hash and access the balance mapping. We therefore rely on `_getTwoTokenPoolBalances`. (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId); if (token == tokenA) { return balanceA; } else if (token == tokenB) { return balanceB; } else { _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } } /** * @dev Returns the balance of the two tokens in a Two Token Pool. * * The returned balances are those of token A and token B, where token A is the lowest of token X and token Y, and * token B the other. * * This function also returns a storage pointer to the TwoTokenPoolBalances struct associated with the token pair, * which can be used to update it without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot. * * Requirements: * * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool */ function _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances( bytes32 poolId, IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY ) internal view returns ( bytes32 balanceA, bytes32 balanceB, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) { (IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) = _sortTwoTokens(tokenX, tokenY); bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB); poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash]; // Because we're reading balances using the pair hash, if either token X or token Y is not registered then // *both* balance entries will be zero. bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash; bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged; // A non-zero balance guarantees that both tokens are registered. If zero, we manually check whether each // token is registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which // lets us save gas by not performing the check. bool tokensRegistered = sharedCash.isNotZero() || sharedManaged.isNotZero() || (_isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenA) && _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenB)); if (!tokensRegistered) { // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged); balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged); } /** * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Two Token Pool. * * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting. */ function _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) { TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId]; // The zero address can never be a registered token. return (token == poolTokens.tokenA || token == poolTokens.tokenB) && token != IERC20(0); } /** * @dev Returns the hash associated with a given token pair. */ function _getTwoTokenPairHash(IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) private pure returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenA, tokenB)); } /** * @dev Sorts two tokens in ascending order, returning them as a (tokenA, tokenB) tuple. */ function _sortTwoTokens(IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY) private pure returns (IERC20, IERC20) { return tokenX < tokenY ? (tokenX, tokenY) : (tokenY, tokenX); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./ProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; /** * @dev To reduce the bytecode size of the Vault, most of the protocol fee logic is not here, but in the * ProtocolFeesCollector contract. */ abstract contract Fees is IVault { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; ProtocolFeesCollector private immutable _protocolFeesCollector; constructor() { _protocolFeesCollector = new ProtocolFeesCollector(IVault(this)); } function getProtocolFeesCollector() public view override returns (IProtocolFeesCollector) { return _protocolFeesCollector; } /** * @dev Returns the protocol swap fee percentage. */ function _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage() internal view returns (uint256) { return getProtocolFeesCollector().getSwapFeePercentage(); } /** * @dev Returns the protocol fee amount to charge for a flash loan of `amount`. */ function _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // Fixed point multiplication introduces error: we round up, which means in certain scenarios the charged // percentage can be slightly higher than intended. uint256 percentage = getProtocolFeesCollector().getFlashLoanFeePercentage(); return FixedPoint.mulUp(amount, percentage); } function _payFeeAmount(IERC20 token, uint256 amount) internal { if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransfer(address(getProtocolFeesCollector()), amount); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. // This flash loan provider was based on the Aave protocol's open source // implementation and terminology and interfaces are intentionally kept // similar pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "./Fees.sol"; /** * @dev Handles Flash Loans through the Vault. Calls the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the flash loan recipient * contract, which implements the `IFlashLoanRecipient` interface. */ abstract contract FlashLoans is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, TemporarilyPausable { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); uint256[] memory feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); uint256[] memory preLoanBalances = new uint256[](tokens.length); // Used to ensure `tokens` is sorted in ascending order, which ensures token uniqueness. IERC20 previousToken = IERC20(0); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; _require(token > previousToken, token == IERC20(0) ? Errors.ZERO_TOKEN : Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS); previousToken = token; preLoanBalances[i] = token.balanceOf(address(this)); feeAmounts[i] = _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(amount); _require(preLoanBalances[i] >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE); token.safeTransfer(address(recipient), amount); } recipient.receiveFlashLoan(tokens, amounts, feeAmounts, userData); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 preLoanBalance = preLoanBalances[i]; // Checking for loan repayment first (without accounting for fees) makes for simpler debugging, and results // in more accurate revert reasons if the flash loan protocol fee percentage is zero. uint256 postLoanBalance = token.balanceOf(address(this)); _require(postLoanBalance >= preLoanBalance, Errors.INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE); // No need for checked arithmetic since we know the loan was fully repaid. uint256 receivedFeeAmount = postLoanBalance - preLoanBalance; _require(receivedFeeAmount >= feeAmounts[i], Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT); _payFeeAmount(token, receivedFeeAmount); emit FlashLoan(recipient, token, amounts[i], receivedFeeAmount); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; /** * @dev Maintains the Pool ID data structure, implements Pool ID creation and registration, and defines useful modifiers * and helper functions for ensuring correct behavior when working with Pools. */ abstract contract PoolRegistry is ReentrancyGuard, VaultAuthorization { // Each pool is represented by their unique Pool ID. We use `bytes32` for them, for lack of a way to define new // types. mapping(bytes32 => bool) private _isPoolRegistered; // We keep an increasing nonce to make Pool IDs unique. It is interpreted as a `uint80`, but storing it as a // `uint256` results in reduced bytecode on reads and writes due to the lack of masking. uint256 private _nextPoolNonce; /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool. */ modifier withRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) { _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract. */ modifier onlyPool(bytes32 poolId) { _ensurePoolIsSender(poolId); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool. */ function _ensureRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) internal view { _require(_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); } /** * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract. */ function _ensurePoolIsSender(bytes32 poolId) private view { _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId); _require(msg.sender == _getPoolAddress(poolId), Errors.CALLER_NOT_POOL); } function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused returns (bytes32) { // Each Pool is assigned a unique ID based on an incrementing nonce. This assumes there will never be more than // 2**80 Pools, and the nonce will not overflow. bytes32 poolId = _toPoolId(msg.sender, specialization, uint80(_nextPoolNonce)); _require(!_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Should never happen as Pool IDs are unique. _isPoolRegistered[poolId] = true; _nextPoolNonce += 1; // Note that msg.sender is the pool's contract emit PoolRegistered(poolId, msg.sender, specialization); return poolId; } function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns (address, PoolSpecialization) { return (_getPoolAddress(poolId), _getPoolSpecialization(poolId)); } /** * @dev Creates a Pool ID. * * These are deterministically created by packing the Pool's contract address and its specialization setting into * the ID. This saves gas by making this data easily retrievable from a Pool ID with no storage accesses. * * Since a single contract can register multiple Pools, a unique nonce must be provided to ensure Pool IDs are * unique. * * Pool IDs have the following layout: * | 20 bytes pool contract address | 2 bytes specialization setting | 10 bytes nonce | * MSB LSB * * 2 bytes for the specialization setting is a bit overkill: there only three of them, which means two bits would * suffice. However, there's nothing else of interest to store in this extra space. */ function _toPoolId( address pool, PoolSpecialization specialization, uint80 nonce ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { bytes32 serialized; serialized |= bytes32(uint256(nonce)); serialized |= bytes32(uint256(specialization)) << (10 * 8); serialized |= bytes32(uint256(pool)) << (12 * 8); return serialized; } /** * @dev Returns the address of a Pool's contract. * * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas. */ function _getPoolAddress(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (address) { // 12 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce and specialization setting. We don't need to mask, // since the logical shift already sets the upper bits to zero. return address(uint256(poolId) >> (12 * 8)); } /** * @dev Returns the specialization setting of a Pool. * * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas. */ function _getPoolSpecialization(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (PoolSpecialization specialization) { // 10 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce, followed by a 2 byte mask to remove the address. uint256 value = uint256(poolId >> (10 * 8)) & (2**(2 * 8) - 1); // Casting a value into an enum results in a runtime check that reverts unless the value is within the enum's // range. Passing an invalid Pool ID to this function would then result in an obscure revert with no reason // string: we instead perform the check ourselves to help in error diagnosis. // There are three Pool specialization settings: general, minimal swap info and two tokens, which correspond to // values 0, 1 and 2. _require(value < 3, Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Because we have checked that `value` is within the enum range, we can use assembly to skip the runtime check. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { specialization := value } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "./AssetManagers.sol"; import "./PoolRegistry.sol"; import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; abstract contract PoolTokens is ReentrancyGuard, PoolRegistry, AssetManagers { using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[]; function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, assetManagers.length); // Validates token addresses and assigns Asset Managers for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; _require(token != IERC20(0), Errors.INVALID_TOKEN); _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] = assetManagers[i]; } PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2); _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _registerGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } emit TokensRegistered(poolId, tokens, assetManagers); } function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2); _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens); } // The deregister calls above ensure the total token balance is zero. Therefore it is now safe to remove any // associated Asset Managers, since they hold no Pool balance. for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { delete _poolAssetManagers[poolId][tokens[i]]; } emit TokensDeregistered(poolId, tokens); } function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ) { bytes32[] memory rawBalances; (tokens, rawBalances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId); (balances, lastChangeBlock) = rawBalances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock(); } function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view override withRegisteredPool(poolId) returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ) { bytes32 balance; PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { balance = _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(poolId, token); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { balance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL balance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token); } cash = balance.cash(); managed = balance.managed(); lastChangeBlock = balance.lastChangeBlock(); assetManager = _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token]; } /** * @dev Returns all of `poolId`'s registered tokens, along with their raw balances. */ function _getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) { PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { return _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { return _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL return _getGeneralPoolTokens(poolId); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; /** * @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the * Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size. * * The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are * sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated * to the Vault's own authorizer. */ contract ProtocolFeesCollector is IProtocolFeesCollector, Authentication, ReentrancyGuard { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%). uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50% uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1% IVault public immutable override vault; // All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers. // The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not // actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due // when users join and exit them. uint256 private _swapFeePercentage; // The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent. uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage; constructor(IVault _vault) // The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action // identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) { vault = _vault; } function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external override nonReentrant authenticate { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external override authenticate { _require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH); _swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage; emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage); } function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external override authenticate { _require( newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH ); _flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage; emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage); } function getSwapFeePercentage() external view override returns (uint256) { return _swapFeePercentage; } function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view override returns (uint256) { return _flashLoanFeePercentage; } function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view override returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) { feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this)); } } function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) { return vault.getAuthorizer(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "./AssetTransfersHandler.sol"; import "./VaultAuthorization.sol"; /** * Implement User Balance interactions, which combine Internal Balance and using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. * * Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later * transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination * when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced * gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. * * Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. */ abstract contract UserBalance is ReentrancyGuard, AssetTransfersHandler, VaultAuthorization { using Math for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Internal Balance for each token, for each account. mapping(address => mapping(IERC20 => uint256)) private _internalTokenBalance; function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view override returns (uint256[] memory balances) { balances = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) { balances[i] = _getInternalBalance(user, tokens[i]); } } function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable override nonReentrant { // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess. uint256 ethWrapped = 0; // Cache for these checks so we only perform them once (if at all). bool checkedCallerIsRelayer = false; bool checkedNotPaused = false; for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; i++) { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; // This destructuring by calling `_validateUserBalanceOp` seems odd, but results in reduced bytecode size. (kind, asset, amount, sender, recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer) = _validateUserBalanceOp( ops[i], checkedCallerIsRelayer ); if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW_INTERNAL) { // Internal Balance withdrawals can always be performed by an authorized account. _withdrawFromInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount); } else { // All other operations are blocked if the contract is paused. // We cache the result of the pause check and skip it for other operations in this same transaction // (if any). if (!checkedNotPaused) { _ensureNotPaused(); checkedNotPaused = true; } if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT_INTERNAL) { _depositToInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount); // Keep track of all ETH wrapped into WETH as part of a deposit. if (_isETH(asset)) { ethWrapped = ethWrapped.add(amount); } } else { // Transfers don't support ETH. _require(!_isETH(asset), Errors.CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL); IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset); if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.TRANSFER_INTERNAL) { _transferInternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount); } else { // TRANSFER_EXTERNAL _transferToExternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount); } } } } // Handle any remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(ethWrapped); } function _depositToInternalBalance( IAsset asset, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount); _receiveAsset(asset, amount, sender, false); } function _withdrawFromInternalBalance( IAsset asset, address sender, address payable recipient, uint256 amount ) private { // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`. _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount, false); _sendAsset(asset, amount, recipient, false); } function _transferInternalBalance( IERC20 token, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`. _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, false); _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount); } function _transferToExternalBalance( IERC20 token, address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) private { if (amount > 0) { token.safeTransferFrom(sender, recipient, amount); emit ExternalBalanceTransfer(token, sender, recipient, amount); } } /** * @dev Increases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. */ function _increaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount ) internal override { uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token); uint256 newBalance = currentBalance.add(amount); _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, amount.toInt256()); } /** * @dev Decreases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. If `allowPartial` is true, this function * doesn't revert if `account` doesn't have enough balance, and sets it to zero and returns the deducted amount * instead. */ function _decreaseInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 amount, bool allowPartial ) internal override returns (uint256 deducted) { uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token); _require(allowPartial || (currentBalance >= amount), Errors.INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE); deducted = Math.min(currentBalance, amount); // By construction, `deducted` is lower or equal to `currentBalance`, so we don't need to use checked // arithmetic. uint256 newBalance = currentBalance - deducted; _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, -(deducted.toInt256())); } /** * @dev Sets `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` to `newBalance`. * * Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. This event includes `delta`, which is the amount the balance increased * (if positive) or decreased (if negative). To avoid reading the current balance in order to compute the delta, * this function relies on the caller providing it directly. */ function _setInternalBalance( address account, IERC20 token, uint256 newBalance, int256 delta ) private { _internalTokenBalance[account][token] = newBalance; emit InternalBalanceChanged(account, token, delta); } /** * @dev Returns `account`'s Internal Balance for `token`. */ function _getInternalBalance(address account, IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) { return _internalTokenBalance[account][token]; } /** * @dev Destructures a User Balance operation, validating that the contract caller is allowed to perform it. */ function _validateUserBalanceOp(UserBalanceOp memory op, bool checkedCallerIsRelayer) private view returns ( UserBalanceOpKind, IAsset, uint256, address, address payable, bool ) { // The only argument we need to validate is `sender`, which can only be either the contract caller, or a // relayer approved by `sender`. address sender = op.sender; if (sender != msg.sender) { // We need to check both that the contract caller is a relayer, and that `sender` approved them. // Because the relayer check is global (i.e. independent of `sender`), we cache that result and skip it for // other operations in this same transaction (if any). if (!checkedCallerIsRelayer) { _authenticateCaller(); checkedCallerIsRelayer = true; } _require(_hasApprovedRelayer(sender, msg.sender), Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER); } return (op.kind, op.asset, op.amount, sender, op.recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IAuthorizer.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/ExtraCalldataEOASignaturesValidator.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; /** * @dev Manages access control of Vault permissioned functions by relying on the Authorizer and signature validation. * * Additionally handles relayer access and approval. */ abstract contract VaultAuthorization is IVault, ReentrancyGuard, Authentication, ExtraCalldataEOASignaturesValidator, TemporarilyPausable { // Ideally, we'd store the type hashes as immutable state variables to avoid computing the hash at runtime, but // unfortunately immutable variables cannot be used in assembly, so we just keep the precomputed hashes instead. // _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("JoinPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = 0x3f7b71252bd19113ff48c19c6e004a9bcfcca320a0d74d58e85877cbd7dcae58; // _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("ExitPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = 0x8bbc57f66ea936902f50a71ce12b92c43f3c5340bb40c27c4e90ab84eeae3353; // _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("Swap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0xe192dcbc143b1e244ad73b813fd3c097b832ad260a157340b4e5e5beda067abe; // _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("BatchSwap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0x9bfc43a4d98313c6766986ffd7c916c7481566d9f224c6819af0a53388aced3a; // _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = // keccak256("SetRelayerApproval(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"); bytes32 private constant _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = 0xa3f865aa351e51cfeb40f5178d1564bb629fe9030b83caf6361d1baaf5b90b5a; IAuthorizer private _authorizer; mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _approvedRelayers; /** * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call this function (that * is, it is a relayer for that function), and either: * a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or * b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata. * * Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticateFor(address user) { _authenticateFor(user); _; } constructor(IAuthorizer authorizer) // The Vault is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) EIP712("Balancer V2 Vault", "1") { _setAuthorizer(authorizer); } function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external override nonReentrant authenticate { _setAuthorizer(newAuthorizer); } function _setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) private { emit AuthorizerChanged(newAuthorizer); _authorizer = newAuthorizer; } function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) { return _authorizer; } function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(sender) { _approvedRelayers[sender][relayer] = approved; emit RelayerApprovalChanged(relayer, sender, approved); } function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view override returns (bool) { return _hasApprovedRelayer(user, relayer); } /** * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call the entry point * function (that is, it is a relayer for that function) and either: * a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or * b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata. */ function _authenticateFor(address user) internal { if (msg.sender != user) { // In this context, 'permission to call a function' means 'being a relayer for a function'. _authenticateCaller(); // Being a relayer is not sufficient: `user` must have also approved the caller either via // `setRelayerApproval`, or by providing a signature appended to the calldata. if (!_hasApprovedRelayer(user, msg.sender)) { _validateExtraCalldataSignature(user, Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER); } } } /** * @dev Returns true if `user` approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function _hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) internal view returns (bool) { return _approvedRelayers[user][relayer]; } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view override returns (bool) { // Access control is delegated to the Authorizer. return _authorizer.canPerform(actionId, user, address(this)); } function _entrypointTypeHash() internal pure override returns (bytes32 hash) { // This is a simple switch-case statement, trivially written in Solidity by chaining else-if statements, but the // assembly implementation results in much denser bytecode. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // The function selector is located at the first 4 bytes of calldata. We copy the first full calldata // 256 word, and then perform a logical shift to the right, moving the selector to the least significant // 4 bytes. let selector := shr(224, calldataload(0)) // With the selector in the least significant 4 bytes, we can use 4 byte literals with leading zeros, // resulting in dense bytecode (PUSH4 opcodes). switch selector case 0xb95cac28 { hash := _JOIN_TYPE_HASH } case 0x8bdb3913 { hash := _EXIT_TYPE_HASH } case 0x52bbbe29 { hash := _SWAP_TYPE_HASH } case 0x945bcec9 { hash := _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH } case 0xfa6e671d { hash := _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH } default { hash := 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IBasePool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/Fees.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/PoolTokens.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/UserBalance.sol"; /** * @dev Stores the Asset Managers (by Pool and token), and implements the top level Asset Manager and Pool interfaces, * such as registering and deregistering tokens, joining and exiting Pools, and informational functions like `getPool` * and `getPoolTokens`, delegating to specialization-specific functions as needed. * * `managePoolBalance` handles all Asset Manager interactions. */ abstract contract PoolBalances is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, PoolTokens, UserBalance { using Math for uint256; using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[]; function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable override whenNotPaused { // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead. // Note that `recipient` is not actually payable in the context of a join - we cast it because we handle both // joins and exits at once. _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN, poolId, sender, payable(recipient), _toPoolBalanceChange(request)); } function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external override { // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead. _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.EXIT, poolId, sender, recipient, _toPoolBalanceChange(request)); } // This has the exact same layout as JoinPoolRequest and ExitPoolRequest, except the `maxAmountsIn` and // `minAmountsOut` are called `limits`. Internally we use this struct for both since these two functions are quite // similar, but expose the others to callers for clarity. struct PoolBalanceChange { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] limits; bytes userData; bool useInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Converts a JoinPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost. */ function _toPoolBalanceChange(JoinPoolRequest memory request) private pure returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { change := request } } /** * @dev Converts an ExitPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost. */ function _toPoolBalanceChange(ExitPoolRequest memory request) private pure returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { change := request } } /** * @dev Implements both `joinPool` and `exitPool`, based on `kind`. */ function _joinOrExit( PoolBalanceChangeKind kind, bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change ) private nonReentrant withRegisteredPool(poolId) authenticateFor(sender) { // This function uses a large number of stack variables (poolId, sender and recipient, balances, amounts, fees, // etc.), which leads to 'stack too deep' issues. It relies on private functions with seemingly arbitrary // interfaces to work around this limitation. InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(change.assets.length, change.limits.length); // We first check that the caller passed the Pool's registered tokens in the correct order, and retrieve the // current balance for each. IERC20[] memory tokens = _translateToIERC20(change.assets); bytes32[] memory balances = _validateTokensAndGetBalances(poolId, tokens); // The corresponding Pool hook is called to get the amounts in/out plus protocol fee amounts. ( uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) = _callPoolBalanceChange(kind, poolId, sender, recipient, change, balances); // We update the Pool balances based on the amounts in/out and fees paid. _updatePoolBalances(kind, poolId, sender, change, tokens, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); // We handle the necessary transfers and fee payments. kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN ? _processJoinPoolTransfers(sender, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) : _processExitPoolTransfers(recipient, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); } /** * @dev Calls the corresponding Pool hook to get the amounts in/out plus protocol fee amounts, and returns them. */ function _callPoolBalanceChange( PoolBalanceChangeKind kind, bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances ) private returns ( uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) { (uint256[] memory totalBalances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = balances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock(); IBasePool pool = IBasePool(_getPoolAddress(poolId)); (amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN ? pool.onJoinPool( poolId, sender, recipient, totalBalances, lastChangeBlock, _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(), change.userData ) : pool.onExitPool( poolId, sender, recipient, totalBalances, lastChangeBlock, _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(), change.userData ); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, amountsInOrOut.length, dueProtocolFeeAmounts.length); } /** * @dev Updates the Pool balances based on the amounts in/out and fees paid. */ function _updatePoolBalances( PoolBalanceChangeKind kind, bytes32 poolId, address sender, PoolBalanceChange memory change, IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private { bytes32[] memory finalBalances = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN ? _computeJoinPoolFinalBalances(balances, change.limits, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) : _computeExitPoolFinalBalances(balances, change.limits, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts); // Storing the new Pool balances. PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(poolId, tokens[0], finalBalances[0], tokens[1], finalBalances[1]); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(poolId, tokens, finalBalances); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL _setGeneralPoolBalances(poolId, finalBalances); } bool positive = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN; // Amounts in are positive, out are negative emit PoolBalanceChanged( poolId, sender, tokens, // We can unsafely cast to int256 because balances are actually stored as uint112 _unsafeCastToInt256(amountsInOrOut, positive), dueProtocolFeeAmounts ); } /** * @dev Computes the final balances for a Pool join, which are the current balances plus `amountsIn` minus * accumulated protocol swap fees. */ function _computeJoinPoolFinalBalances( bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory maxAmountsIn, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private view returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) { uint256 length = balances.length; finalBalances = new bytes32[](length); for (uint256 i; i < length; ++i) { uint256 amountIn = amountsIn[i]; _require(amountIn <= maxAmountsIn[i], Errors.JOIN_ABOVE_MAX); uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; // Compute the new Pool balances. Note that the fee amount might be larger than `amountIn`, // resulting in an overall decrease of the Pool's balance for a token. finalBalances[i] = (amountIn >= feeAmount) // This lets us skip checked arithmetic ? balances[i].increaseCash(amountIn - feeAmount) : balances[i].decreaseCash(feeAmount - amountIn); } } /** * @dev Computes the final balances for a Pool exit, which are the current balances minus `amountsOut` and fees * paid (`dueProtocolFeeAmounts`). */ function _computeExitPoolFinalBalances( bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory minAmountsOut, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private view returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) { uint256 length = balances.length; finalBalances = new bytes32[](length); for (uint256 i; i < length; ++i) { uint256 amountOut = amountsOut[i]; _require(amountOut >= minAmountsOut[i], Errors.EXIT_BELOW_MIN); uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; // Compute the new Pool balances. A Pool's token balance always decreases after an exit (potentially by 0). finalBalances[i] = balances[i].decreaseCash(amountOut.add(feeAmount)); } } /** * @dev Transfers `amountsIn` from `sender`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays * accumulated protocol swap fees. * * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current balances plus `amountsIn` minus accumulated protocol * swap fees. */ function _processJoinPoolTransfers( address sender, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private { // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess. uint256 wrappedEth; // change.assets.length == balances.length uint256 length = balances.length; for (uint256 i; i < length; ++i) { uint256 amountIn = amountsIn[i]; // Receive assets from the sender - possibly from Internal Balance. IAsset asset = change.assets[i]; _receiveAsset(asset, amountIn, sender, change.useInternalBalance); if (_isETH(asset)) { wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(amountIn); } uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount); } // Handle any used and remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth); } /** * @dev Transfers `amountsOut` to `recipient`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays * accumulated protocol swap fees from the Pool. * * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current `balances` minus `amountsOut` and fees paid * (`dueProtocolFeeAmounts`). */ function _processExitPoolTransfers( address payable recipient, PoolBalanceChange memory change, bytes32[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts ) private { uint256 length = balances.length; for (uint256 i; i < length; ++i) { uint256 amountOut = amountsOut[i]; // Send tokens to the recipient - possibly to Internal Balance IAsset asset = change.assets[i]; _sendAsset(asset, amountOut, recipient, change.useInternalBalance); uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]; _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount); } } /** * @dev Returns the total balance for `poolId`'s `expectedTokens`. * * `expectedTokens` must exactly equal the token array returned by `getPoolTokens`: both arrays must have the same * length, elements and order. Additionally, the Pool must have at least one registered token. */ function _validateTokensAndGetBalances(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory expectedTokens) private view returns (bytes32[] memory) { (IERC20[] memory actualTokens, bytes32[] memory balances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(actualTokens.length, expectedTokens.length); _require(actualTokens.length > 0, Errors.POOL_NO_TOKENS); for (uint256 i; i < actualTokens.length; ++i) { _require(actualTokens[i] == expectedTokens[i], Errors.TOKENS_MISMATCH); } return balances; } /** * @dev Casts an array of uint256 to int256, setting the sign of the result according to the `positive` flag, * without checking whether the values fit in the signed 256 bit range. */ function _unsafeCastToInt256(uint256[] memory values, bool positive) private pure returns (int256[] memory signedValues) { signedValues = new int256[](values.length); for (uint256 i; i < values.length; ++i) { signedValues[i] = positive ? int256(values[i]) : -int256(values[i]); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IGeneralPool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "./PoolBalances.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/balances/BalanceAllocation.sol"; /** * Implements the Vault's high-level swap functionality. * * Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. They need not trust the Pool * contracts to do this: all security checks are made by the Vault. * * The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. * In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), * and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). * More complex swaps, such as one 'token in' to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together * individual swaps. */ abstract contract Swaps is ReentrancyGuard, PoolBalances { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet; using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map; using Math for int256; using Math for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; using BalanceAllocation for bytes32; function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(funds.sender) returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE); // This revert reason is for consistency with `batchSwap`: an equivalent `swap` performed using that function // would result in this error. _require(singleSwap.amount > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP); IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetIn); IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetOut); _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN); // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once. IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest; poolRequest.poolId = singleSwap.poolId; poolRequest.kind = singleSwap.kind; poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn; poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut; poolRequest.amount = singleSwap.amount; poolRequest.userData = singleSwap.userData; poolRequest.from = funds.sender; poolRequest.to = funds.recipient; // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized. uint256 amountIn; uint256 amountOut; (amountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest); _require(singleSwap.kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? amountOut >= limit : amountIn <= limit, Errors.SWAP_LIMIT); _receiveAsset(singleSwap.assetIn, amountIn, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance); _sendAsset(singleSwap.assetOut, amountOut, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance); // If the asset in is ETH, then `amountIn` ETH was wrapped into WETH. _handleRemainingEth(_isETH(singleSwap.assetIn) ? amountIn : 0); } function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(funds.sender) returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) { // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(assets.length, limits.length); // Perform the swaps, updating the Pool token balances and computing the net Vault asset deltas. assetDeltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind); // Process asset deltas, by either transferring assets from the sender (for positive deltas) or to the recipient // (for negative deltas). uint256 wrappedEth = 0; for (uint256 i; i < assets.length; ++i) { IAsset asset = assets[i]; int256 delta = assetDeltas[i]; _require(delta <= limits[i], Errors.SWAP_LIMIT); if (delta > 0) { uint256 toReceive = uint256(delta); _receiveAsset(asset, toReceive, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance); if (_isETH(asset)) { wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(toReceive); } } else if (delta < 0) { uint256 toSend = uint256(-delta); _sendAsset(asset, toSend, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance); } } // Handle any used and remaining ETH. _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth); } // For `_swapWithPools` to handle both 'given in' and 'given out' swaps, it internally tracks the 'given' amount // (supplied by the caller), and the 'calculated' amount (returned by the Pool in response to the swap request). /** * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'given' token (the token whose * amount is supplied by the caller). */ function _tokenGiven( SwapKind kind, IERC20 tokenIn, IERC20 tokenOut ) private pure returns (IERC20) { return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenIn : tokenOut; } /** * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'calculated' token (the token whose * amount is calculated by the Pool). */ function _tokenCalculated( SwapKind kind, IERC20 tokenIn, IERC20 tokenOut ) private pure returns (IERC20) { return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenOut : tokenIn; } /** * @dev Returns an ordered pair (amountIn, amountOut) given the 'given' and 'calculated' amounts, and the swap kind. */ function _getAmounts( SwapKind kind, uint256 amountGiven, uint256 amountCalculated ) private pure returns (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) { if (kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) { (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountGiven, amountCalculated); } else { // SwapKind.GIVEN_OUT (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountCalculated, amountGiven); } } /** * @dev Performs all `swaps`, calling swap hooks on the Pool contracts and updating their balances. Does not cause * any transfer of tokens - instead it returns the net Vault token deltas: positive if the Vault should receive * tokens, and negative if it should send them. */ function _swapWithPools( BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, SwapKind kind ) private returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) { assetDeltas = new int256[](assets.length); // These variables could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each // loop iteration, increasing gas costs. BatchSwapStep memory batchSwapStep; IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest; // These store data about the previous swap here to implement multihop logic across swaps. IERC20 previousTokenCalculated; uint256 previousAmountCalculated; for (uint256 i; i < swaps.length; ++i) { batchSwapStep = swaps[i]; bool withinBounds = batchSwapStep.assetInIndex < assets.length && batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex < assets.length; _require(withinBounds, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex]); IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex]); _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN); // Sentinel value for multihop logic if (batchSwapStep.amount == 0) { // When the amount given is zero, we use the calculated amount for the previous swap, as long as the // current swap's given token is the previous calculated token. This makes it possible to swap a // given amount of token A for token B, and then use the resulting token B amount to swap for token C. _require(i > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP); bool usingPreviousToken = previousTokenCalculated == _tokenGiven(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut); _require(usingPreviousToken, Errors.MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP); batchSwapStep.amount = previousAmountCalculated; } // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once poolRequest.poolId = batchSwapStep.poolId; poolRequest.kind = kind; poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn; poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut; poolRequest.amount = batchSwapStep.amount; poolRequest.userData = batchSwapStep.userData; poolRequest.from = funds.sender; poolRequest.to = funds.recipient; // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized uint256 amountIn; uint256 amountOut; (previousAmountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest); previousTokenCalculated = _tokenCalculated(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut); // Accumulate Vault deltas across swaps assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex].add(amountIn.toInt256()); assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex].sub( amountOut.toInt256() ); } } /** * @dev Performs a swap according to the parameters specified in `request`, calling the Pool's contract hook and * updating the Pool's balance. * * Returns the amount of tokens going into or out of the Vault as a result of this swap, depending on the swap kind. */ function _swapWithPool(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request) private returns ( uint256 amountCalculated, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ) { // Get the calculated amount from the Pool and update its balances address pool = _getPoolAddress(request.poolId); PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(request.poolId); if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) { amountCalculated = _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool)); } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) { amountCalculated = _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool)); } else { // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL amountCalculated = _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(request, IGeneralPool(pool)); } (amountIn, amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); emit Swap(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut, amountIn, amountOut); } function _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { // For gas efficiency reasons, this function uses low-level knowledge of how Two Token Pool balances are // stored internally, instead of using getters and setters for all operations. ( bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance, TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut); // We have the two Pool balances, but we don't know which one is 'token in' or 'token out'. bytes32 tokenInBalance; bytes32 tokenOutBalance; // In Two Token Pools, token A has a smaller address than token B if (request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut) { // in is A, out is B tokenInBalance = tokenABalance; tokenOutBalance = tokenBBalance; } else { // in is B, out is A tokenOutBalance = tokenABalance; tokenInBalance = tokenBBalance; } // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( request, pool, tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance ); // We check the token ordering again to create the new shared cash packed struct poolBalances.sharedCash = request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut ? BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance) // in is A, out is B : BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenOutBalance, tokenInBalance); // in is B, out is A } function _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest( IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool ) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { bytes32 tokenInBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenIn); bytes32 tokenOutBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenOut); // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( request, pool, tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance ); _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenIn] = tokenInBalance; _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenOut] = tokenOutBalance; } /** * @dev Calls the onSwap hook for a Pool that implements IMinimalSwapInfoPool: both Minimal Swap Info and Two Token * Pools do this. */ function _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook( IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool, bytes32 tokenInBalance, bytes32 tokenOutBalance ) internal returns ( bytes32 newTokenInBalance, bytes32 newTokenOutBalance, uint256 amountCalculated ) { uint256 tokenInTotal = tokenInBalance.total(); uint256 tokenOutTotal = tokenOutBalance.total(); request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(tokenInBalance.lastChangeBlock(), tokenOutBalance.lastChangeBlock()); // Perform the swap request callback, and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, tokenInTotal, tokenOutTotal); (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); newTokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn); newTokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut); } function _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IGeneralPool pool) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) { bytes32 tokenInBalance; bytes32 tokenOutBalance; // We access both token indexes without checking existence, because we will do it manually immediately after. EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[request.poolId]; uint256 indexIn = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenIn); uint256 indexOut = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenOut); if (indexIn == 0 || indexOut == 0) { // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a // more accurate revert reason. _ensureRegisteredPool(request.poolId); _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED); } // EnumerableMap stores indices *plus one* to use the zero index as a sentinel value - because these are valid, // we can undo this. indexIn -= 1; indexOut -= 1; uint256 tokenAmount = poolBalances.length(); uint256[] memory currentBalances = new uint256[](tokenAmount); request.lastChangeBlock = 0; for (uint256 i; i < tokenAmount; ++i) { // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokenAmount`, and no tokens are registered or deregistered here, we // know `i` is a valid token index and can use `unchecked_valueAt` to save storage reads. bytes32 balance = poolBalances.unchecked_valueAt(i); currentBalances[i] = balance.total(); request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(request.lastChangeBlock, balance.lastChangeBlock()); if (i == indexIn) { tokenInBalance = balance; } else if (i == indexOut) { tokenOutBalance = balance; } } // Perform the swap request callback and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, currentBalances, indexIn, indexOut); (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated); tokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn); tokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut); // Because no tokens were registered or deregistered between now or when we retrieved the indexes for // 'token in' and 'token out', we can use `unchecked_setAt` to save storage reads. poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexIn, tokenInBalance); poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexOut, tokenOutBalance); } // This function is not marked as `nonReentrant` because the underlying mechanism relies on reentrancy function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external override returns (int256[] memory) { // In order to accurately 'simulate' swaps, this function actually does perform the swaps, including calling the // Pool hooks and updating balances in storage. However, once it computes the final Vault Deltas, it // reverts unconditionally, returning this array as the revert data. // // By wrapping this reverting call, we can decode the deltas 'returned' and return them as a normal Solidity // function would. The only caveat is the function becomes non-view, but off-chain clients can still call it // via eth_call to get the expected result. // // This technique was inspired by the work from the Gnosis team in the Gnosis Safe contract: // https://github.com/gnosis/safe-contracts/blob/v1.2.0/contracts/GnosisSafe.sol#L265 // // Most of this function is implemented using inline assembly, as the actual work it needs to do is not // significant, and Solidity is not particularly well-suited to generate this behavior, resulting in a large // amount of generated bytecode. if (msg.sender != address(this)) { // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of // the preceding if statement will be executed instead. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // This call should always revert to decode the actual asset deltas from the revert reason switch success case 0 { // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return. // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise // there was another revert reason and we should forward it. returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04) let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason. if eq(eq(error, 0xfa61cc1200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of an array: // length + data. We need to return an ABI-encoded representation of this array. // An ABI-encoded array contains an additional field when compared to its raw memory // representation: an offset to the location of the length. The offset itself is 32 bytes long, // so the smallest value we can use is 32 for the data to be located immediately after it. mstore(0, 32) // We now copy the raw memory array from returndata into memory. Since the offset takes up 32 // bytes, we start copying at address 0x20. We also get rid of the error signature, which takes // the first four bytes of returndata. let size := sub(returndatasize(), 0x04) returndatacopy(0x20, 0x04, size) // We finally return the ABI-encoded array, which has a total length equal to that of the array // (returndata), plus the 32 bytes for the offset. return(0, add(size, 32)) } default { // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen invalid() } } } else { int256[] memory deltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We will return a raw representation of the array in memory, which is composed of a 32 byte length, // followed by the 32 byte int256 values. Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array // length (stored at `deltas`) by 32. let size := mul(mload(deltas), 32) // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(int256[])" which is 0xfa61cc12. // We store it in the previous slot to the `deltas` array. We know there will be at least one available // slot due to how the memory scratch space works. // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that. mstore(sub(deltas, 0x20), 0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000fa61cc12) let start := sub(deltas, 0x04) // When copying from `deltas` into returndata, we copy an additional 36 bytes to also return the array's // length and the error signature. revert(start, add(size, 36)) } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IAuthorizer.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/VaultAuthorization.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-vault/contracts/FlashLoans.sol"; import "./Swaps.sol"; /** * @dev The `Vault` is Balancer V2's core contract. A single instance of it exists for the entire network, and it is the * entity used to interact with Pools by Liquidity Providers who join and exit them, Traders who swap, and Asset * Managers who withdraw and deposit tokens. * * The `Vault`'s source code is split among a number of sub-contracts, with the goal of improving readability and making * understanding the system easier. Most sub-contracts have been marked as `abstract` to explicitly indicate that only * the full `Vault` is meant to be deployed. * * Roughly speaking, these are the contents of each sub-contract: * * - `AssetManagers`: Pool token Asset Manager registry, and Asset Manager interactions. * - `Fees`: set and compute protocol fees. * - `FlashLoans`: flash loan transfers and fees. * - `PoolBalances`: Pool joins and exits. * - `PoolRegistry`: Pool registration, ID management, and basic queries. * - `PoolTokens`: Pool token registration and registration, and balance queries. * - `Swaps`: Pool swaps. * - `UserBalance`: manage user balances (Internal Balance operations and external balance transfers) * - `VaultAuthorization`: access control, relayers and signature validation. * * Additionally, the different Pool specializations are handled by the `GeneralPoolsBalance`, * `MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance` and `TwoTokenPoolsBalance` sub-contracts, which in turn make use of the * `BalanceAllocation` library. * * The most important goal of the `Vault` is to make token swaps use as little gas as possible. This is reflected in a * multitude of design decisions, from minor things like the format used to store Pool IDs, to major features such as * the different Pool specialization settings. * * Finally, the large number of tasks carried out by the Vault means its bytecode is very large, close to exceeding * the contract size limit imposed by EIP 170 (https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-170). Manual tuning of the source code * was required to improve code generation and bring the bytecode size below this limit. This includes extensive * utilization of `internal` functions (particularly inside modifiers), usage of named return arguments, dedicated * storage access methods, dynamic revert reason generation, and usage of inline assembly, to name a few. */ contract Vault is VaultAuthorization, FlashLoans, Swaps { constructor( IAuthorizer authorizer, IWETH weth, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration ) VaultAuthorization(authorizer) AssetHelpers(weth) TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration) { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } function setPaused(bool paused) external override nonReentrant authenticate { _setPaused(paused); } // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function WETH() external view override returns (IWETH) { return _WETH(); } }
File 2 of 8: SafeguardPool
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; library BasePoolUserData { // Special ExitKind for all pools, used in Recovery Mode. Use the max 8-bit value to prevent conflicts // with future additions to the ExitKind enums (or any front-end code that maps to existing values) uint8 public constant RECOVERY_MODE_EXIT_KIND = 255; // Return true if this is the special exit kind. function isRecoveryModeExitKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (bool) { // Check for the "no data" case, or abi.decode would revert return self.length > 0 && abi.decode(self, (uint8)) == RECOVERY_MODE_EXIT_KIND; } // Parse the bptAmountIn out of the userData function recoveryModeExit(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn) { (, bptAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (uint8, uint256)); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IControlledPool { function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the RecoveryMode module. */ interface IRecoveryMode { /** * @dev Emitted when the Recovery Mode status changes. */ event RecoveryModeStateChanged(bool enabled); /** * @notice Enables Recovery Mode in the Pool, disabling protocol fee collection and allowing for safe proportional * exits with low computational complexity and no dependencies. */ function enableRecoveryMode() external; /** * @notice Disables Recovery Mode in the Pool, restoring protocol fee collection and disallowing proportional exits. */ function disableRecoveryMode() external; /** * @notice Returns true if the Pool is in Recovery Mode. */ function inRecoveryMode() external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // solhint-disable /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. */ function _require( bool condition, uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix ) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode, prefix); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure { _revert(errorCode, 0x42414c); // This is the raw byte representation of "BAL" } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix) pure { uint256 prefixUint = uint256(uint24(prefix)); // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format: // 'BAL#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999). // // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters. // // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999 // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. // We first append the '#' character (0x23) to the prefix. In the case of 'BAL', it results in 0x42414c23 ('BAL#') // Then, we shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let formattedPrefix := shl(24, add(0x23, shl(8, prefixUint))) let revertReason := shl(200, add(formattedPrefix, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The string length is fixed: 7 characters. mstore(0x24, 7) // Finally, the string itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } library Errors { // Math uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0; uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1; uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2; uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3; uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4; uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5; uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6; uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7; uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8; uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9; // Input uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102; uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103; uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_DATA = 105; // Shared pools uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200; uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201; uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202; uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203; uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206; uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207; uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209; uint256 internal constant NOT_TWO_TOKENS = 210; uint256 internal constant DISABLED = 211; // Pools uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300; uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301; uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302; uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303; uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305; uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307; uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308; uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310; uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_SECONDS_QUERY = 312; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_NOT_INITIALIZED = 313; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_QUERY_TOO_OLD = 314; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_INDEX = 315; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_BAD_SECS = 316; uint256 internal constant AMP_END_TIME_TOO_CLOSE = 317; uint256 internal constant AMP_ONGOING_UPDATE = 318; uint256 internal constant AMP_RATE_TOO_HIGH = 319; uint256 internal constant AMP_NO_ONGOING_UPDATE = 320; uint256 internal constant STABLE_INVARIANT_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 321; uint256 internal constant STABLE_GET_BALANCE_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 322; uint256 internal constant RELAYER_NOT_CONTRACT = 323; uint256 internal constant BASE_POOL_RELAYER_NOT_CALLED = 324; uint256 internal constant REBALANCING_RELAYER_REENTERED = 325; uint256 internal constant GRADUAL_UPDATE_TIME_TRAVEL = 326; uint256 internal constant SWAPS_DISABLED = 327; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_LBP_OWNER = 328; uint256 internal constant PRICE_RATE_OVERFLOW = 329; uint256 internal constant INVALID_JOIN_EXIT_KIND_WHILE_SWAPS_DISABLED = 330; uint256 internal constant WEIGHT_CHANGE_TOO_FAST = 331; uint256 internal constant LOWER_GREATER_THAN_UPPER_TARGET = 332; uint256 internal constant UPPER_TARGET_TOO_HIGH = 333; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_LINEAR_POOL = 334; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_TARGET_RANGE = 335; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_EXIT_KIND = 336; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_EXIT = 337; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 338; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_MANAGED_POOL = 339; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_PHANTOM_POOL = 340; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_DOES_NOT_HAVE_RATE_PROVIDER = 341; uint256 internal constant INVALID_INITIALIZATION = 342; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_NEW_TARGET_RANGE = 343; uint256 internal constant FEATURE_DISABLED = 344; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED_POOL_CONTROLLER = 345; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_DURING_FEE_CHANGE = 346; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_PENDING_FEE_CHANGE = 347; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_DURING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 348; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_PENDING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 349; uint256 internal constant MAX_WEIGHT = 350; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_JOIN = 351; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 352; uint256 internal constant FRACTIONAL_TARGET = 353; uint256 internal constant ADD_OR_REMOVE_BPT = 354; uint256 internal constant INVALID_CIRCUIT_BREAKER_BOUNDS = 355; uint256 internal constant CIRCUIT_BREAKER_TRIPPED = 356; uint256 internal constant MALICIOUS_QUERY_REVERT = 357; uint256 internal constant JOINS_EXITS_DISABLED = 358; // Lib uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401; uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402; uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403; uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404; uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409; uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414; uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417; uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421; uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422; uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423; uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424; uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_OWNER = 426; uint256 internal constant NEW_OWNER_IS_ZERO = 427; uint256 internal constant CODE_DEPLOYMENT_FAILED = 428; uint256 internal constant CALL_TO_NON_CONTRACT = 429; uint256 internal constant LOW_LEVEL_CALL_FAILED = 430; uint256 internal constant NOT_PAUSED = 431; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_ALREADY_ALLOWLISTED = 432; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_NOT_ALLOWLISTED = 433; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 434; uint256 internal constant INVALID_OPERATION = 435; uint256 internal constant CODEC_OVERFLOW = 436; uint256 internal constant IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 437; uint256 internal constant NOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 438; uint256 internal constant INDUCED_FAILURE = 439; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_SIGNATURE = 440; uint256 internal constant MALFORMED_SIGNATURE = 441; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_UINT64 = 442; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_FEE_TYPE = 443; uint256 internal constant BURN_FROM_ZERO = 444; // Vault uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502; uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503; uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504; uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505; uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506; uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507; uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509; uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510; uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511; uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513; uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514; uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516; uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517; uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524; uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525; uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526; uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528; // Fees uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600; uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602; uint256 internal constant AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 603; // FeeSplitter uint256 internal constant SPLITTER_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 700; // Misc uint256 internal constant UNIMPLEMENTED = 998; uint256 internal constant SHOULD_NOT_HAPPEN = 999; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthentication { /** * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`. */ function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions. */ interface ISignaturesValidator { /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator. */ function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages. */ function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper. */ interface ITemporarilyPausable { /** * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`. */ event PausedStateChanged(bool paused); /** * @dev Returns the current paused state. */ function getPausedState() external view returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for WETH9. * See https://github.com/gnosis/canonical-weth/blob/0dd1ea3e295eef916d0c6223ec63141137d22d67/contracts/WETH9.sol */ interface IWETH is IERC20 { function deposit() external payable; function withdraw(uint256 amount) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. */ interface IERC20Permit { /** * @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over `owner`'s tokens, * given `owner`'s signed approval. * * IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction * ordering also apply here. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future. * - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner` * over the EIP712-formatted function arguments. * - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}). * * For more information on the signature format, see the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP * section]. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external; /** * @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be * included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}. * * Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This * prevents a signature from being used multiple times. */ function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for `permit`, as defined by {EIP712}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like * types. * * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers. */ interface IAsset { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthorizer { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`. */ function canPerform( bytes32 actionId, address account, address where ) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not * the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from * either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool */ interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs { /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of * each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault. * The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect * the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join. * * `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account * designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `balances` contains the total balances * for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares. */ function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many * tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes * to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`, * as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on * `protocolSwapFeePercentage`. * * Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share. * * `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account * to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `balances` contains the total token balances for each token * the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total * balance. * * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of * exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.) * * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any * state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares. */ function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts); /** * @dev Returns this Pool's ID, used when interacting with the Vault (to e.g. join the Pool or swap with it). */ function getPoolId() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the current swap fee percentage as a 18 decimal fixed point number, so e.g. 1e17 corresponds to a * 10% swap fee. */ function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the scaling factors of each of the Pool's tokens. This is an implementation detail that is typically * not relevant for outside parties, but which might be useful for some types of Pools. */ function getScalingFactors() external view returns (uint256[] memory); function queryJoin( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn); function queryExit( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver. import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IFlashLoanRecipient { /** * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient. * * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert. * * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call. */ function receiveFlashLoan( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory feeAmounts, bytes memory userData ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./IBasePool.sol"; /** * @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface. * * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool. * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant * to the pool in a 'given out' swap. * * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is * indeed the Vault. */ interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool { function onSwap( SwapRequest memory swapRequest, uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn, uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut ) external returns (uint256 amount); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; interface IPoolSwapStructs { // This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and // IMinimalSwapInfoPool. // // This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or // 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known. // // The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take // in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`. // // All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in // some Pools. // // `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than // one Pool. // // The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization: // - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total // balance. // - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance. // // `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address // where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens. // // `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party. struct SwapRequest { IVault.SwapKind kind; IERC20 tokenIn; IERC20 tokenOut; uint256 amount; // Misc data bytes32 poolId; uint256 lastChangeBlock; address from; address to; bytes userData; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; interface IProtocolFeesCollector { event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage); event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage); function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external; function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external; function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external; function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts); function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); function vault() external view returns (IVault); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "./IAsset.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "./IProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that * don't override one of these declarations. */ interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable, IAuthentication { // Generalities about the Vault: // // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful. // // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g. // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results. // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered. // // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools. // Authorizer // // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller // can perform a given action. /** * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer. */ function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); /** * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this. * * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event. */ function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`. */ event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer); // Relayers // // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions, // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield // this power, two things must occur: // - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This // means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended // functions. // - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf. // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user. /** * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise. * * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event. */ function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external; /** * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`. */ event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved); // Internal Balance // // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. // // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. /** * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens. */ function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer) * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance. * * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. */ function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable; /** * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping. */ struct UserBalanceOp { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; } // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`: // // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is // relevant for relayers). // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send // it to the recipient as ETH. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event. enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL } /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance. * * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH * address. */ event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta); /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account. */ event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount); // Pools // // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced // functionality: // // - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads), // which increase with the number of registered tokens. // // - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are // independent of the number of registered tokens. // // - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool. enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN } /** * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be * changed. * * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`, * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract. * * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words, * multiple Pools may share the same contract. * * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event. */ function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`. */ event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting. */ function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization); /** * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens, * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens. * * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in * ascending order. * * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`, * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an * Asset Manager should not be made lightly. * * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a * different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event. */ function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`. */ event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers); /** * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call. * * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event. */ function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`. */ event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens); /** * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token. * * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token` * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`. * * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`, * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`. * * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager. */ function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of * the tokens' `balances` changed. * * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order. * * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same * order as passed to `registerTokens`. * * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo` * instead. */ function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ); /** * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized * Pool shares. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces * these maximums. * * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers). * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable; struct JoinPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] maxAmountsIn; bytes userData; bool fromInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see * `getPoolTokenInfo`). * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: * it just enforces these minimums. * * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit. * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise, * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to * do so will trigger a revert. * * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and * passed directly to the Pool's contract. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external; struct ExitPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] minAmountsOut; bytes userData; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively. */ event PoolBalanceChanged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed liquidityProvider, IERC20[] tokens, int256[] deltas, uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts ); enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT } // Swaps // // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this, // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote. // // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together // individual swaps. // // There are two swap kinds: // - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient). // - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender). // // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at // the final intended token. // // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost // much less gas than they would otherwise. // // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only // updating the Pool's internal accounting). // // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified. // // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly). // // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers). // // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens. enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT } /** * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool. * * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`. * * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`. * * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. * * Emits a `Swap` event. */ function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (uint256); /** * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on * the `kind` value. * * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct SingleSwap { bytes32 poolId; SwapKind kind; IAsset assetIn; IAsset assetOut; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value. * * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at * the same index in the `assets` array. * * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind. * * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`. * * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses, * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer. * * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the * equivalent `swap` call. * * Emits `Swap` events. */ function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (int256[] memory); /** * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH. * * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct BatchSwapStep { bytes32 poolId; uint256 assetInIndex; uint256 assetOutIndex; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`. */ event Swap( bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20 indexed tokenIn, IERC20 indexed tokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ); /** * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the * `recipient` account. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20 * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender` * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of * `joinPool`. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`. * * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a * revert. */ struct FundManagement { address sender; bool fromInternalBalance; address payable recipient; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result. * * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH) * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive. * * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct. * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens, * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address. * * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas); // Flash Loans /** * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it, * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned. * * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order. * * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the * `receiveFlashLoan` call. * * Emits `FlashLoan` events. */ function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external; /** * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`. */ event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount); // Asset Management // // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings. // // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit, // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols. // // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface. /** * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates. * * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once. * * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`. */ function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external; struct PoolBalanceOp { PoolBalanceOpKind kind; bytes32 poolId; IERC20 token; uint256 amount; } /** * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total. * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss). */ enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE } /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`. */ event PoolBalanceManaged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed assetManager, IERC20 indexed token, int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta ); // Protocol Fees // // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by // permissioned accounts. // // There are two kinds of protocol fees: // // - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent. // // - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather, // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share. /** * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module. */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (IProtocolFeesCollector); /** * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an * error in some part of the system. * * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled. * * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled: * - depositing and transferring internal balance * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance) * - swaps * - joining Pools * - Asset Manager interactions * * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited. */ function setPaused(bool paused) external; /** * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance. */ function WETH() external view returns (IWETH); // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ERC20Permit.sol"; /** * @title Highly opinionated token implementation * @author Balancer Labs * @dev * - Includes functions to increase and decrease allowance as a workaround * for the well-known issue with `approve`: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * - Allows for 'infinite allowance', where an allowance of 0xff..ff is not * decreased by calls to transferFrom * - Lets a token holder use `transferFrom` to send their own tokens, * without first setting allowance * - Emits 'Approval' events whenever allowance is changed by `transferFrom` * - Assigns infinite allowance for all token holders to the Vault */ contract BalancerPoolToken is ERC20Permit { IVault private immutable _vault; constructor( string memory tokenName, string memory tokenSymbol, IVault vault ) ERC20(tokenName, tokenSymbol) ERC20Permit(tokenName) { _vault = vault; } function getVault() public view returns (IVault) { return _vault; } // Overrides /** * @dev Override to grant the Vault infinite allowance, causing for Pool Tokens to not require approval. * * This is sound as the Vault already provides authorization mechanisms when initiation token transfers, which this * contract inherits. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view override returns (uint256) { if (spender == address(getVault())) { return uint256(-1); } else { return super.allowance(owner, spender); } } /** * @dev Override to allow for 'infinite allowance' and let the token owner use `transferFrom` with no self-allowance */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) public override returns (bool) { uint256 currentAllowance = allowance(sender, msg.sender); _require(msg.sender == sender || currentAllowance >= amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE); _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); if (msg.sender != sender && currentAllowance != uint256(-1)) { // Because of the previous require, we know that if msg.sender != sender then currentAllowance >= amount _approve(sender, msg.sender, currentAllowance - amount); } return true; } /** * @dev Override to allow decreasing allowance by more than the current amount (setting it to zero) */ function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 amount) public override returns (bool) { uint256 currentAllowance = allowance(msg.sender, spender); if (amount >= currentAllowance) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, 0); } else { // No risk of underflow due to if condition _approve(msg.sender, spender, currentAllowance - amount); } return true; } // Internal functions function _mintPoolTokens(address recipient, uint256 amount) internal { _mint(recipient, amount); } function _burnPoolTokens(address sender, uint256 amount) internal { _burn(sender, amount); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/pool-utils/IControlledPool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IBasePool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/WordCodec.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/ScalingHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "./lib/PoolRegistrationLib.sol"; import "./BalancerPoolToken.sol"; import "./BasePoolAuthorization.sol"; import "./RecoveryMode.sol"; // solhint-disable max-states-count /** * @notice Reference implementation for the base layer of a Pool contract. * @dev Reference implementation for the base layer of a Pool contract that manages a single Pool with optional * Asset Managers, an admin-controlled swap fee percentage, and an emergency pause mechanism. * * This Pool pays protocol fees by minting BPT directly to the ProtocolFeeCollector instead of using the * `dueProtocolFees` return value. This results in the underlying tokens continuing to provide liquidity * for traders, while still keeping gas usage to a minimum since only a single token (the BPT) is transferred. * * Note that neither swap fees nor the pause mechanism are used by this contract. They are passed through so that * derived contracts can use them via the `_addSwapFeeAmount` and `_subtractSwapFeeAmount` functions, and the * `whenNotPaused` modifier. * * No admin permissions are checked here: instead, this contract delegates that to the Vault's own Authorizer. * * Because this contract doesn't implement the swap hooks, derived contracts should generally inherit from * BaseGeneralPool or BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool. Otherwise, subclasses must inherit from the corresponding interfaces * and implement the swap callbacks themselves. */ abstract contract BasePool is IBasePool, IControlledPool, BasePoolAuthorization, BalancerPoolToken, TemporarilyPausable, RecoveryMode { using WordCodec for bytes32; using FixedPoint for uint256; using BasePoolUserData for bytes; uint256 private constant _MIN_TOKENS = 2; uint256 private constant _DEFAULT_MINIMUM_BPT = 1e6; // 1e18 corresponds to 1.0, or a 100% fee uint256 private constant _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e12; // 0.0001% uint256 private constant _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e17; // 10% - this fits in 64 bits // `_miscData` is a storage slot that can be used to store unrelated pieces of information. All pools store the // recovery mode flag and swap fee percentage, but `miscData` can be extended to store more pieces of information. // The most signficant bit is reserved for the recovery mode flag, and the swap fee percentage is stored in // the next most significant 63 bits, leaving the remaining 192 bits free to store any other information derived // pools might need. // // This slot is preferred for gas-sensitive operations as it is read in all joins, swaps and exits, // and therefore warm. // [ recovery | swap fee | available ] // [ 1 bit | 63 bits | 192 bits ] // [ MSB LSB ] bytes32 private _miscData; uint256 private constant _SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_OFFSET = 192; uint256 private constant _RECOVERY_MODE_BIT_OFFSET = 255; // A fee can never be larger than FixedPoint.ONE, which fits in 60 bits, so 63 is more than enough. uint256 private constant _SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_BIT_LENGTH = 63; bytes32 private immutable _poolId; // Note that this value is immutable in the Vault, so we can make it immutable here and save gas IProtocolFeesCollector private immutable _protocolFeesCollector; event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 swapFeePercentage); constructor( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, string memory name, string memory symbol, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers, uint256 swapFeePercentage, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration, address owner ) // Base Pools are expected to be deployed using factories. By using the factory address as the action // disambiguator, we make all Pools deployed by the same factory share action identifiers. This allows for // simpler management of permissions (such as being able to manage granting the 'set fee percentage' action in // any Pool created by the same factory), while still making action identifiers unique among different factories // if the selectors match, preventing accidental errors. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(msg.sender))) BalancerPoolToken(name, symbol, vault) BasePoolAuthorization(owner) TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration) RecoveryMode(vault) { _require(tokens.length >= _MIN_TOKENS, Errors.MIN_TOKENS); _require(tokens.length <= _getMaxTokens(), Errors.MAX_TOKENS); _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage); bytes32 poolId = PoolRegistrationLib.registerPoolWithAssetManagers( vault, specialization, tokens, assetManagers ); // Set immutable state variables - these cannot be read from during construction _poolId = poolId; _protocolFeesCollector = vault.getProtocolFeesCollector(); } // Getters / Setters /** * @notice Return the pool id. */ function getPoolId() public view override returns (bytes32) { return _poolId; } function _getTotalTokens() internal view virtual returns (uint256); function _getMaxTokens() internal pure virtual returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the minimum BPT supply. This amount is minted to the zero address during initialization, effectively * locking it. * * This is useful to make sure Pool initialization happens only once, but derived Pools can change this value (even * to zero) by overriding this function. */ function _getMinimumBpt() internal pure virtual returns (uint256) { return _DEFAULT_MINIMUM_BPT; } /** * @notice Return the current value of the swap fee percentage. * @dev This is stored in `_miscData`. */ function getSwapFeePercentage() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _miscData.decodeUint(_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_OFFSET, _SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_BIT_LENGTH); } /** * @notice Return the ProtocolFeesCollector contract. * @dev This is immutable, and retrieved from the Vault on construction. (It is also immutable in the Vault.) */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() public view returns (IProtocolFeesCollector) { return _protocolFeesCollector; } /** * @notice Set the swap fee percentage. * @dev This is a permissioned function, and disabled if the pool is paused. The swap fee must be within the * bounds set by MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE/MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE. Emits the SwapFeePercentageChanged event. */ function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) public virtual override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage); } function _setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) internal virtual { _require(swapFeePercentage >= _getMinSwapFeePercentage(), Errors.MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE); _require(swapFeePercentage <= _getMaxSwapFeePercentage(), Errors.MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE); _miscData = _miscData.insertUint( swapFeePercentage, _SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_OFFSET, _SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_BIT_LENGTH ); emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(swapFeePercentage); } function _getMinSwapFeePercentage() internal pure virtual returns (uint256) { return _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE; } function _getMaxSwapFeePercentage() internal pure virtual returns (uint256) { return _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE; } /** * @notice Returns whether the pool is in Recovery Mode. */ function inRecoveryMode() public view override returns (bool) { return _miscData.decodeBool(_RECOVERY_MODE_BIT_OFFSET); } /** * @dev Sets the recoveryMode state, and emits the corresponding event. */ function _setRecoveryMode(bool enabled) internal virtual override { _miscData = _miscData.insertBool(enabled, _RECOVERY_MODE_BIT_OFFSET); emit RecoveryModeStateChanged(enabled); // Some pools need to update their state when leaving recovery mode to ensure proper functioning of the Pool. // We do not allow an `_onEnableRecoveryMode()` hook as this may jeopardize the ability to enable Recovery mode. if (!enabled) _onDisableRecoveryMode(); } /** * @dev Performs any necessary actions on the disabling of Recovery Mode. * This is usually to reset any fee collection mechanisms to ensure that they operate correctly going forward. */ function _onDisableRecoveryMode() internal virtual { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } /** * @notice Pause the pool: an emergency action which disables all pool functions. * @dev This is a permissioned function that will only work during the Pause Window set during pool factory * deployment (see `TemporarilyPausable`). */ function pause() external authenticate { _setPaused(true); } /** * @notice Reverse a `pause` operation, and restore a pool to normal functionality. * @dev This is a permissioned function that will only work on a paused pool within the Buffer Period set during * pool factory deployment (see `TemporarilyPausable`). Note that any paused pools will automatically unpause * after the Buffer Period expires. */ function unpause() external authenticate { _setPaused(false); } function _isOwnerOnlyAction(bytes32 actionId) internal view virtual override returns (bool) { return (actionId == getActionId(this.setSwapFeePercentage.selector)) || super._isOwnerOnlyAction(actionId); } function _getMiscData() internal view returns (bytes32) { return _miscData; } /** * @dev Inserts data into the least-significant 192 bits of the misc data storage slot. * Note that the remaining 64 bits are used for the swap fee percentage and cannot be overloaded. */ function _setMiscData(bytes32 newData) internal { _miscData = _miscData.insertBits192(newData, 0); } // Join / Exit Hooks modifier onlyVault(bytes32 poolId) { _require(msg.sender == address(getVault()), Errors.CALLER_NOT_VAULT); _require(poolId == getPoolId(), Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); _; } /** * @notice Vault hook for adding liquidity to a pool (including the first time, "initializing" the pool). * @dev This function can only be called from the Vault, from `joinPool`. */ function onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) { _beforeSwapJoinExit(); uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); if (totalSupply() == 0) { (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _onInitializePool( poolId, sender, recipient, scalingFactors, userData ); // On initialization, we lock _getMinimumBpt() by minting it for the zero address. This BPT acts as a // minimum as it will never be burned, which reduces potential issues with rounding, and also prevents the // Pool from ever being fully drained. _require(bptAmountOut >= _getMinimumBpt(), Errors.MINIMUM_BPT); _mintPoolTokens(address(0), _getMinimumBpt()); _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut - _getMinimumBpt()); // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up. _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors); return (amountsIn, new uint256[](balances.length)); } else { _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _onJoinPool( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, inRecoveryMode() ? 0 : protocolSwapFeePercentage, // Protocol fees are disabled while in recovery mode scalingFactors, userData ); // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onJoinPool`, which may mutate it. _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut); // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up. _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors); // This Pool ignores the `dueProtocolFees` return value, so we simply return a zeroed-out array. return (amountsIn, new uint256[](balances.length)); } } /** * @notice Vault hook for removing liquidity from a pool. * @dev This function can only be called from the Vault, from `exitPool`. */ function onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) { uint256[] memory amountsOut; uint256 bptAmountIn; // When a user calls `exitPool`, this is the first point of entry from the Vault. // We first check whether this is a Recovery Mode exit - if so, we proceed using this special lightweight exit // mechanism which avoids computing any complex values, interacting with external contracts, etc., and generally // should always work, even if the Pool's mathematics or a dependency break down. if (userData.isRecoveryModeExitKind()) { // This exit kind is only available in Recovery Mode. _ensureInRecoveryMode(); // Note that we don't upscale balances nor downscale amountsOut - we don't care about scaling factors during // a recovery mode exit. (bptAmountIn, amountsOut) = _doRecoveryModeExit(balances, totalSupply(), userData); } else { // Note that we only call this if we're not in a recovery mode exit. _beforeSwapJoinExit(); uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (bptAmountIn, amountsOut) = _onExitPool( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, inRecoveryMode() ? 0 : protocolSwapFeePercentage, // Protocol fees are disabled while in recovery mode scalingFactors, userData ); // amountsOut are amounts exiting the Pool, so we round down. _downscaleDownArray(amountsOut, scalingFactors); } // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onExitPool`, which may mutate it. _burnPoolTokens(sender, bptAmountIn); // This Pool ignores the `dueProtocolFees` return value, so we simply return a zeroed-out array. return (amountsOut, new uint256[](balances.length)); } // Query functions /** * @notice "Dry run" `onJoinPool`. * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be granted to `recipient` if the `onJoinPool` hook were called by the * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `sender` would have to supply. * * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances. * * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryJoin( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external override returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens()); _queryAction( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData, _onJoinPool, _downscaleUpArray ); // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement, // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings. return (bptOut, amountsIn); } /** * @notice "Dry run" `onExitPool`. * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be burned from `sender` if the `onExitPool` hook were called by the * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `recipient` would receive. * * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances. * * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryExit( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData ) external override returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens()); _queryAction( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, userData, _onExitPool, _downscaleDownArray ); // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement, // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings. return (bptIn, amountsOut); } // Internal hooks to be overridden by derived contracts - all token amounts (except BPT) in these interfaces are // upscaled. /** * @dev Called when the Pool is joined for the first time; that is, when the BPT total supply is zero. * * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, and the token amounts the Pool will receive in return. * * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`, except for _getMinimumBpt(), which will be deducted from this amount and * sent to the zero address instead. This will cause that BPT to remain forever locked there, preventing total BTP * from ever dropping below that value, and ensuring `_onInitializePool` can only be called once in the entire * Pool's lifetime. * * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onInitializePool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn); /** * @dev Called whenever the Pool is joined after the first initialization join (see `_onInitializePool`). * * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, the token amounts that the Pool will receive in return, and the number of * tokens to pay in protocol swap fees. * * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely. * * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`. * * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault. * * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onJoinPool`). These * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onJoinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, uint256[] memory scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn); /** * @dev Called whenever the Pool is exited. * * Returns the amount of BPT to burn, the token amounts for each Pool token that the Pool will grant in return, and * the number of tokens to pay in protocol swap fees. * * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely. * * BPT will be burnt from `sender`. * * The Pool will grant tokens to `recipient`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled * (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. * * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onExitPool`). These * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault. */ function _onExitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, uint256[] memory scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut); /** * @dev Called at the very beginning of swaps, joins and exits, even before the scaling factors are read. Derived * contracts can extend this implementation to perform any state-changing operations they might need (including e.g. * updating the scaling factors), * * The only scenario in which this function is not called is during a recovery mode exit. This makes it safe to * perform non-trivial computations or interact with external dependencies here, as recovery mode will not be * affected. * * Since this contract does not implement swaps, derived contracts must also make sure this function is called on * swap handlers. */ function _beforeSwapJoinExit() internal virtual { // All joins, exits and swaps are disabled (except recovery mode exits). _ensureNotPaused(); } // Internal functions /** * @dev Pays protocol fees by minting `bptAmount` to the Protocol Fee Collector. */ function _payProtocolFees(uint256 bptAmount) internal { if (bptAmount > 0) { _mintPoolTokens(address(getProtocolFeesCollector()), bptAmount); } } /** * @dev Adds swap fee amount to `amount`, returning a higher value. */ function _addSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // This returns amount + fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount). return amount.divUp(getSwapFeePercentage().complement()); } /** * @dev Subtracts swap fee amount from `amount`, returning a lower value. */ function _subtractSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) { // This returns amount - fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount). uint256 feeAmount = amount.mulUp(getSwapFeePercentage()); return amount.sub(feeAmount); } // Scaling /** * @dev Returns a scaling factor that, when multiplied to a token amount for `token`, normalizes its balance as if * it had 18 decimals. */ function _computeScalingFactor(IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) { if (address(token) == address(this)) { return FixedPoint.ONE; } // Tokens that don't implement the `decimals` method are not supported. uint256 tokenDecimals = ERC20(address(token)).decimals(); // Tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported. uint256 decimalsDifference = Math.sub(18, tokenDecimals); return FixedPoint.ONE * 10**decimalsDifference; } /** * @dev Returns the scaling factor for one of the Pool's tokens. Reverts if `token` is not a token registered by the * Pool. * * All scaling factors are fixed-point values with 18 decimals, to allow for this function to be overridden by * derived contracts that need to apply further scaling, making these factors potentially non-integer. * * The largest 'base' scaling factor (i.e. in tokens with less than 18 decimals) is 10**18, which in fixed-point is * 10**36. This value can be multiplied with a 112 bit Vault balance with no overflow by a factor of ~1e7, making * even relatively 'large' factors safe to use. * * The 1e7 figure is the result of 2**256 / (1e18 * 1e18 * 2**112). */ function _scalingFactor(IERC20 token) internal view virtual returns (uint256); /** * @dev Same as `_scalingFactor()`, except for all registered tokens (in the same order as registered). The Vault * will always pass balances in this order when calling any of the Pool hooks. */ function _scalingFactors() internal view virtual returns (uint256[] memory); function getScalingFactors() external view override returns (uint256[] memory) { return _scalingFactors(); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view override returns (IAuthorizer) { // Access control management is delegated to the Vault's Authorizer. This lets Balancer Governance manage which // accounts can call permissioned functions: for example, to perform emergency pauses. // If the owner is delegated, then *all* permissioned functions, including `setSwapFeePercentage`, will be under // Governance control. return getVault().getAuthorizer(); } function _queryAction( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock, uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage, bytes memory userData, function(bytes32, address, address, uint256[] memory, uint256, uint256, uint256[] memory, bytes memory) internal returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) _action, function(uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) internal view _downscaleArray ) private { // This uses the same technique used by the Vault in queryBatchSwap. Refer to that function for a detailed // explanation. if (msg.sender != address(this)) { // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of // the preceding if statement will be executed instead. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // This call should always revert to decode the bpt and token amounts from the revert reason switch success case 0 { // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return. // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise // there was another revert reason and we should forward it. returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04) let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason. if eq(eq(error, 0x43adbafb00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of the // `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` (array: length + data). We need to return an ABI-encoded // representation of these. // An ABI-encoded response will include one additional field to indicate the starting offset of // the `tokenAmounts` array. The `bptAmount` will be laid out in the first word of the // returndata. // // In returndata: // [ signature ][ bptAmount ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ] // [ 4 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ (32 * length) bytes ] // // We now need to return (ABI-encoded values): // [ bptAmount ][ tokeAmounts offset ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ] // [ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ 32 bytes ][ (32 * length) bytes ] // We copy 32 bytes for the `bptAmount` from returndata into memory. // Note that we skip the first 4 bytes for the error signature returndatacopy(0, 0x04, 32) // The offsets are 32-bytes long, so the array of `tokenAmounts` will start after // the initial 64 bytes. mstore(0x20, 64) // We now copy the raw memory array for the `tokenAmounts` from returndata into memory. // Since bpt amount and offset take up 64 bytes, we start copying at address 0x40. We also // skip the first 36 bytes from returndata, which correspond to the signature plus bpt amount. returndatacopy(0x40, 0x24, sub(returndatasize(), 36)) // We finally return the ABI-encoded uint256 and the array, which has a total length equal to // the size of returndata, plus the 32 bytes of the offset but without the 4 bytes of the // error signature. return(0, add(returndatasize(), 28)) } default { // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen invalid() } } } else { // This imitates the relevant parts of the bodies of onJoin and onExit. Since they're not virtual, we know // that their implementations will match this regardless of what derived contracts might do. _beforeSwapJoinExit(); uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors(); _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors); (uint256 bptAmount, uint256[] memory tokenAmounts) = _action( poolId, sender, recipient, balances, lastChangeBlock, protocolSwapFeePercentage, scalingFactors, userData ); _downscaleArray(tokenAmounts, scalingFactors); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { // We will return a raw representation of `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` in memory, which is composed of // a 32-byte uint256, followed by a 32-byte for the array length, and finally the 32-byte uint256 values // Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array length (stored at `tokenAmounts`) by 32 let size := mul(mload(tokenAmounts), 32) // We store the `bptAmount` in the previous slot to the `tokenAmounts` array. We can make sure there // will be at least one available slot due to how the memory scratch space works. // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that. let start := sub(tokenAmounts, 0x20) mstore(start, bptAmount) // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(uint256,uint256[])" which is 0x43adbafb // We use the previous slot to `bptAmount`. mstore(sub(start, 0x20), 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000043adbafb) start := sub(start, 0x04) // When copying from `tokenAmounts` into returndata, we copy the additional 68 bytes to also return // the `bptAmount`, the array 's length, and the error signature. revert(start, add(size, 68)) } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IAuthorizer.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/Authentication.sol"; /** * @dev Base authorization layer implementation for Pools. * * The owner account can call some of the permissioned functions - access control of the rest is delegated to the * Authorizer. Note that this owner is immutable: more sophisticated permission schemes, such as multiple ownership, * granular roles, etc., could be built on top of this by making the owner a smart contract. * * Access control of all other permissioned functions is delegated to an Authorizer. It is also possible to delegate * control of *all* permissioned functions to the Authorizer by setting the owner address to `_DELEGATE_OWNER`. */ abstract contract BasePoolAuthorization is Authentication { address private immutable _owner; address internal constant _DELEGATE_OWNER = 0xBA1BA1ba1BA1bA1bA1Ba1BA1ba1BA1bA1ba1ba1B; constructor(address owner) { _owner = owner; } function getOwner() public view returns (address) { return _owner; } function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { if ((getOwner() != _DELEGATE_OWNER) && _isOwnerOnlyAction(actionId)) { // Only the owner can perform "owner only" actions, unless the owner is delegated. return msg.sender == getOwner(); } else { // Non-owner actions are always processed via the Authorizer, as "owner only" ones are when delegated. return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } } function _isOwnerOnlyAction(bytes32) internal view virtual returns (bool) { return false; } function _getAuthorizer() internal view virtual returns (IAuthorizer); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; library BasePoolMath { using FixedPoint for uint256; function computeProportionalAmountsIn( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 bptAmountOut ) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn) { /************************************************************************************ // computeProportionalAmountsIn // // (per token) // // aI = amountIn / bptOut \\ // // b = balance aI = b * | ----------------- | // // bptOut = bptAmountOut \\ bptTotalSupply / // // bpt = bptTotalSupply // ************************************************************************************/ // Since we're computing amounts in, we round up overall. This means rounding up on both the // multiplication and division. uint256 bptRatio = bptAmountOut.divUp(bptTotalSupply); amountsIn = new uint256[](balances.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { amountsIn[i] = balances[i].mulUp(bptRatio); } } function computeProportionalAmountsOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 bptTotalSupply, uint256 bptAmountIn ) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut) { /********************************************************************************************** // computeProportionalAmountsOut // // (per token) // // aO = tokenAmountOut / bptIn \\ // // b = tokenBalance a0 = b * | --------------------- | // // bptIn = bptAmountIn \\ bptTotalSupply / // // bpt = bptTotalSupply // **********************************************************************************************/ // Since we're computing an amount out, we round down overall. This means rounding down on both the // multiplication and division. uint256 bptRatio = bptAmountIn.divDown(bptTotalSupply); amountsOut = new uint256[](balances.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) { amountsOut[i] = balances[i].mulDown(bptRatio); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; library PoolRegistrationLib { function registerPool( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20[] memory tokens ) internal returns (bytes32) { return registerPoolWithAssetManagers(vault, specialization, tokens, new address[](tokens.length)); } function registerPoolWithAssetManagers( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) internal returns (bytes32) { // The Vault only requires the token list to be ordered for the Two Token Pools specialization. However, // to make the developer experience consistent, we are requiring this condition for all the native pools. // // Note that for Pools which can register and deregister tokens after deployment, this property may not hold // as tokens which are added to the Pool after deployment are always added to the end of the array. InputHelpers.ensureArrayIsSorted(tokens); return _registerPool(vault, specialization, tokens, assetManagers); } function registerComposablePool( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) internal returns (bytes32) { // The Vault only requires the token list to be ordered for the Two Token Pools specialization. However, // to make the developer experience consistent, we are requiring this condition for all the native pools. // // Note that for Pools which can register and deregister tokens after deployment, this property may not hold // as tokens which are added to the Pool after deployment are always added to the end of the array. InputHelpers.ensureArrayIsSorted(tokens); IERC20[] memory composableTokens = new IERC20[](tokens.length + 1); // We insert the Pool's BPT address into the first position. // This allows us to know the position of the BPT token in the tokens array without explicitly tracking it. // When deregistering a token, the token at the end of the array is moved into the index of the deregistered // token, changing its index. By placing BPT at the beginning of the tokens array we can be sure that its index // will never change unless it is deregistered itself (something which composable pools must prevent anyway). composableTokens[0] = IERC20(address(this)); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) { composableTokens[i + 1] = tokens[i]; } address[] memory composableAssetManagers = new address[](assetManagers.length + 1); // We do not allow an asset manager for the Pool's BPT. composableAssetManagers[0] = address(0); for (uint256 i = 0; i < assetManagers.length; i++) { composableAssetManagers[i + 1] = assetManagers[i]; } return _registerPool(vault, specialization, composableTokens, composableAssetManagers); } function _registerPool( IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) private returns (bytes32) { bytes32 poolId = vault.registerPool(specialization); // We don't need to check that tokens and assetManagers have the same length, since the Vault already performs // that check. vault.registerTokens(poolId, tokens, assetManagers); return poolId; } function registerToken( IVault vault, bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token, address assetManager ) internal { IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](1); tokens[0] = token; address[] memory assetManagers = new address[](1); assetManagers[0] = assetManager; vault.registerTokens(poolId, tokens, assetManagers); } function deregisterToken( IVault vault, bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token ) internal { IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](1); tokens[0] = token; vault.deregisterTokens(poolId, tokens); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/pool-utils/BasePoolUserData.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/pool-utils/IRecoveryMode.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "./BasePoolAuthorization.sol"; /** * @notice Handle storage and state changes for pools that support "Recovery Mode". * * @dev This is intended to provide a safe way to exit any pool during some kind of emergency, to avoid locking funds * in the event the pool enters a non-functional state (i.e., some code that normally runs during exits is causing * them to revert). * * Recovery Mode is *not* the same as pausing the pool. The pause function is only available during a short window * after factory deployment. Pausing can only be intentionally reversed during a buffer period, and the contract * will permanently unpause itself thereafter. Paused pools are completely disabled, in a kind of suspended animation, * until they are voluntarily or involuntarily unpaused. * * By contrast, a privileged account - typically a governance multisig - can place a pool in Recovery Mode at any * time, and it is always reversible. The pool is *not* disabled while in this mode: though of course whatever * condition prompted the transition to Recovery Mode has likely effectively disabled some functions. Rather, * a special "clean" exit is enabled, which runs the absolute minimum code necessary to exit proportionally. * In particular, stable pools do not attempt to compute the invariant (which is a complex, iterative calculation * that can fail in extreme circumstances), and no protocol fees are collected. * * It is critical to ensure that turning on Recovery Mode would do no harm, if activated maliciously or in error. */ abstract contract RecoveryMode is IRecoveryMode, BasePoolAuthorization { using FixedPoint for uint256; using BasePoolUserData for bytes; IVault private immutable _vault; /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is in Recovery Mode. */ modifier whenNotInRecoveryMode() { _ensureNotInRecoveryMode(); _; } constructor(IVault vault) { _vault = vault; } /** * @notice Enable recovery mode, which enables a special safe exit path for LPs. * @dev Does not otherwise affect pool operations (beyond deferring payment of protocol fees), though some pools may * perform certain operations in a "safer" manner that is less likely to fail, in an attempt to keep the pool * running, even in a pathological state. Unlike the Pause operation, which is only available during a short window * after factory deployment, Recovery Mode can always be enabled. */ function enableRecoveryMode() external override authenticate { // Unlike when recovery mode is disabled, derived contracts should *not* do anything when it is enabled. // We do not want to make any calls that could fail and prevent the pool from entering recovery mode. // Accordingly, this should have no effect, but for consistency with `disableRecoveryMode`, revert if // recovery mode was already enabled. _ensureNotInRecoveryMode(); _setRecoveryMode(true); emit RecoveryModeStateChanged(true); } /** * @notice Disable recovery mode, which disables the special safe exit path for LPs. * @dev Protocol fees are not paid while in Recovery Mode, so it should only remain active for as long as strictly * necessary. */ function disableRecoveryMode() external override authenticate { // Some derived contracts respond to disabling recovery mode with state changes (e.g., related to protocol fees, // or otherwise ensuring that enabling and disabling recovery mode has no ill effects on LPs). When called // outside of recovery mode, these state changes might lead to unexpected behavior. _ensureInRecoveryMode(); _setRecoveryMode(false); emit RecoveryModeStateChanged(false); } // Defer implementation for functions that require storage /** * @notice Override to check storage and return whether the pool is in Recovery Mode */ function inRecoveryMode() public view virtual override returns (bool); /** * @dev Override to update storage and emit the event * * No complex code or external calls that could fail should be placed in the implementations, * which could jeopardize the ability to enable and disable Recovery Mode. */ function _setRecoveryMode(bool enabled) internal virtual; /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is not in Recovery Mode. */ function _ensureInRecoveryMode() internal view { _require(inRecoveryMode(), Errors.NOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is in Recovery Mode. */ function _ensureNotInRecoveryMode() internal view { _require(!inRecoveryMode(), Errors.IN_RECOVERY_MODE); } /** * @dev A minimal proportional exit, suitable as is for most pools: though not for pools with preminted BPT * or other special considerations. Designed to be overridden if a pool needs to do extra processing, * such as scaling a stored invariant, or caching the new total supply. * * No complex code or external calls should be made in derived contracts that override this! */ function _doRecoveryModeExit( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 totalSupply, bytes memory userData ) internal virtual returns (uint256, uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Keep a reference to the Vault, for use in reentrancy protection function calls that require it. */ function _getVault() internal view returns (IVault) { return _vault; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; /** * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions. * * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic. */ abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication { bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator; /** * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in * multi contract systems. * * There are two main uses for it: * - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers * unique. The contract's own address is a good option. * - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier * shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead. */ constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) { _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticate() { _authenticateCaller(); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function. */ function _authenticateCaller() internal view { bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig); _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED); } function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) { // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of // multiple contracts. return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector)); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../openzeppelin/EIP712.sol"; /** * @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls. */ abstract contract EOASignaturesValidator is ISignaturesValidator, EIP712 { // Replay attack prevention for each account. mapping(address => uint256) internal _nextNonce; function getDomainSeparator() public view override returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparatorV4(); } function getNextNonce(address account) public view override returns (uint256) { return _nextNonce[account]; } function _ensureValidSignature( address account, bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 errorCode ) internal { return _ensureValidSignature(account, structHash, signature, type(uint256).max, errorCode); } function _ensureValidSignature( address account, bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 deadline, uint256 errorCode ) internal { bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); _require(_isValidSignature(account, digest, signature), errorCode); // We could check for the deadline before validating the signature, but this leads to saner error processing (as // we only care about expired deadlines if the signature is correct) and only affects the gas cost of the revert // scenario, which will only occur infrequently, if ever. // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(deadline >= block.timestamp, Errors.EXPIRED_SIGNATURE); // We only advance the nonce after validating the signature. This is irrelevant for this module, but it can be // important in derived contracts that override _isValidSignature (e.g. SignaturesValidator), as we want for // the observable state to still have the current nonce as the next valid one. _nextNonce[account] += 1; } function _isValidSignature( address account, bytes32 digest, bytes memory signature ) internal view virtual returns (bool) { _require(signature.length == 65, Errors.MALFORMED_SIGNATURE); bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint8 v; // ecrecover takes the r, s and v signature parameters, and the only way to get them is to use assembly. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) s := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60))) } address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s); // ecrecover returns the zero address on recover failure, so we need to handle that explicitly. return (recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == account); } function _toArraySignature( uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) { bytes memory signature = new bytes(65); // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { mstore(add(signature, 32), r) mstore(add(signature, 64), s) mstore8(add(signature, 96), v) } return signature; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; library InputHelpers { function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure { _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureInputLengthMatch( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 c ) internal pure { _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure { if (array.length < 2) { return; } address previous = array[0]; for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) { address current = array[i]; _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY); previous = current; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "../math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "../math/Math.sol"; import "../openzeppelin/ERC20.sol"; import "./InputHelpers.sol"; // solhint-disable // To simplify Pool logic, all token balances and amounts are normalized to behave as if the token had 18 decimals. // e.g. When comparing DAI (18 decimals) and USDC (6 decimals), 1 USDC and 1 DAI would both be represented as 1e18, // whereas without scaling 1 USDC would be represented as 1e6. // This allows us to not consider differences in token decimals in the internal Pool maths, simplifying it greatly. // Single Value /** * @dev Applies `scalingFactor` to `amount`, resulting in a larger or equal value depending on whether it needed * scaling or not. */ function _upscale(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) pure returns (uint256) { // Upscale rounding wouldn't necessarily always go in the same direction: in a swap for example the balance of // token in should be rounded up, and that of token out rounded down. This is the only place where we round in // the same direction for all amounts, as the impact of this rounding is expected to be minimal. return FixedPoint.mulDown(amount, scalingFactor); } /** * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded down. */ function _downscaleDown(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) pure returns (uint256) { return FixedPoint.divDown(amount, scalingFactor); } /** * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded up. */ function _downscaleUp(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) pure returns (uint256) { return FixedPoint.divUp(amount, scalingFactor); } // Array /** * @dev Same as `_upscale`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead *mutates* * the `amounts` array. */ function _upscaleArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) pure { uint256 length = amounts.length; InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(length, scalingFactors.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < length; ++i) { amounts[i] = FixedPoint.mulDown(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } /** * @dev Same as `_downscaleDown`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead * *mutates* the `amounts` array. */ function _downscaleDownArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) pure { uint256 length = amounts.length; InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(length, scalingFactors.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < length; ++i) { amounts[i] = FixedPoint.divDown(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } /** * @dev Same as `_downscaleUp`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead * *mutates* the `amounts` array. */ function _downscaleUpArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) pure { uint256 length = amounts.length; InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(length, scalingFactors.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < length; ++i) { amounts[i] = FixedPoint.divUp(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]); } } function _computeScalingFactor(IERC20 token) view returns (uint256) { // Tokens that don't implement the `decimals` method are not supported. uint256 tokenDecimals = ERC20(address(token)).decimals(); // Tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported. uint256 decimalsDifference = Math.sub(18, tokenDecimals); return FixedPoint.ONE * 10**decimalsDifference; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; /** * @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be * used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified. * * The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be * unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets * system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful * analysis later determines there was a false alarm. * * If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional * Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time * to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires. * * Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is * irreversible. */ abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable { // The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime; uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime; bool private _paused; constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) { _require(pauseWindowDuration <= PausableConstants.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION); _require( bufferPeriodDuration <= PausableConstants.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION ); uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration; _pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime; _bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration; } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ modifier whenNotPaused() { _ensureNotPaused(); _; } /** * @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer * Period. */ function getPausedState() external view override returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ) { paused = !_isNotPaused(); pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime(); bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime(); } /** * @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and * unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally. */ function _setPaused(bool paused) internal { if (paused) { _require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED); } else { _require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED); } _paused = paused; emit PausedStateChanged(paused); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused. */ function _ensureNotPaused() internal view { _require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED); } /** * @dev Reverts if the contract is not paused. */ function _ensurePaused() internal view { _require(!_isNotPaused(), Errors.NOT_PAUSED); } /** * @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused. * * Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no * longer accessed. */ function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) { // After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access. return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused; } // These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place. function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _pauseWindowEndTime; } function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) { return _bufferPeriodEndTime; } } /** * @dev Keep the maximum durations in a single place. */ library PausableConstants { uint256 public constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 270 days; uint256 public constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 90 days; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "../math/Math.sol"; /** * @dev Library for encoding and decoding values stored inside a 256 bit word. Typically used to pack multiple values in * a single storage slot, saving gas by performing less storage accesses. * * Each value is defined by its size and the least significant bit in the word, also known as offset. For example, two * 128 bit values may be encoded in a word by assigning one an offset of 0, and the other an offset of 128. * * We could use Solidity structs to pack values together in a single storage slot instead of relying on a custom and * error-prone library, but unfortunately Solidity only allows for structs to live in either storage, calldata or * memory. Because a memory struct uses not just memory but also a slot in the stack (to store its memory location), * using memory for word-sized values (i.e. of 256 bits or less) is strictly less gas performant, and doesn't even * prevent stack-too-deep issues. This is compounded by the fact that Balancer contracts typically are memory-intensive, * and the cost of accesing memory increases quadratically with the number of allocated words. Manual packing and * unpacking is therefore the preferred approach. */ library WordCodec { // solhint-disable no-inline-assembly // Masks are values with the least significant N bits set. They can be used to extract an encoded value from a word, // or to insert a new one replacing the old. uint256 private constant _MASK_1 = 2**(1) - 1; uint256 private constant _MASK_192 = 2**(192) - 1; // In-place insertion /** * @dev Inserts an unsigned integer of bitLength, shifted by an offset, into a 256 bit word, * replacing the old value. Returns the new word. */ function insertUint( bytes32 word, uint256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { _validateEncodingParams(value, offset, bitLength); // Equivalent to: // uint256 mask = (1 << bitLength) - 1; // bytes32 clearedWord = bytes32(uint256(word) & ~(mask << offset)); // result = clearedWord | bytes32(value << offset); assembly { let mask := sub(shl(bitLength, 1), 1) let clearedWord := and(word, not(shl(offset, mask))) result := or(clearedWord, shl(offset, value)) } } /** * @dev Inserts a signed integer shifted by an offset into a 256 bit word, replacing the old value. Returns * the new word. * * Assumes `value` can be represented using `bitLength` bits. */ function insertInt( bytes32 word, int256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { _validateEncodingParams(value, offset, bitLength); uint256 mask = (1 << bitLength) - 1; bytes32 clearedWord = bytes32(uint256(word) & ~(mask << offset)); // Integer values need masking to remove the upper bits of negative values. return clearedWord | bytes32((uint256(value) & mask) << offset); } // Encoding /** * @dev Encodes an unsigned integer shifted by an offset. Ensures value fits within * `bitLength` bits. * * The return value can be ORed bitwise with other encoded values to form a 256 bit word. */ function encodeUint( uint256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { _validateEncodingParams(value, offset, bitLength); return bytes32(value << offset); } /** * @dev Encodes a signed integer shifted by an offset. * * The return value can be ORed bitwise with other encoded values to form a 256 bit word. */ function encodeInt( int256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { _validateEncodingParams(value, offset, bitLength); uint256 mask = (1 << bitLength) - 1; // Integer values need masking to remove the upper bits of negative values. return bytes32((uint256(value) & mask) << offset); } // Decoding /** * @dev Decodes and returns an unsigned integer with `bitLength` bits, shifted by an offset, from a 256 bit word. */ function decodeUint( bytes32 word, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = uint256(word >> offset) & ((1 << bitLength) - 1); assembly { result := and(shr(offset, word), sub(shl(bitLength, 1), 1)) } } /** * @dev Decodes and returns a signed integer with `bitLength` bits, shifted by an offset, from a 256 bit word. */ function decodeInt( bytes32 word, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) internal pure returns (int256 result) { int256 maxInt = int256((1 << (bitLength - 1)) - 1); uint256 mask = (1 << bitLength) - 1; int256 value = int256(uint256(word >> offset) & mask); // In case the decoded value is greater than the max positive integer that can be represented with bitLength // bits, we know it was originally a negative integer. Therefore, we mask it to restore the sign in the 256 bit // representation. // // Equivalent to: // result = value > maxInt ? (value | int256(~mask)) : value; assembly { result := or(mul(gt(value, maxInt), not(mask)), value) } } // Special cases /** * @dev Decodes and returns a boolean shifted by an offset from a 256 bit word. */ function decodeBool(bytes32 word, uint256 offset) internal pure returns (bool result) { // Equivalent to: // result = (uint256(word >> offset) & 1) == 1; assembly { result := and(shr(offset, word), 1) } } /** * @dev Inserts a 192 bit value shifted by an offset into a 256 bit word, replacing the old value. * Returns the new word. * * Assumes `value` can be represented using 192 bits. */ function insertBits192( bytes32 word, bytes32 value, uint256 offset ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { bytes32 clearedWord = bytes32(uint256(word) & ~(_MASK_192 << offset)); return clearedWord | bytes32((uint256(value) & _MASK_192) << offset); } /** * @dev Inserts a boolean value shifted by an offset into a 256 bit word, replacing the old value. Returns the new * word. */ function insertBool( bytes32 word, bool value, uint256 offset ) internal pure returns (bytes32 result) { // Equivalent to: // bytes32 clearedWord = bytes32(uint256(word) & ~(1 << offset)); // bytes32 referenceInsertBool = clearedWord | bytes32(uint256(value ? 1 : 0) << offset); assembly { let clearedWord := and(word, not(shl(offset, 1))) result := or(clearedWord, shl(offset, value)) } } // Helpers function _validateEncodingParams( uint256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) private pure { _require(offset < 256, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); // We never accept 256 bit values (which would make the codec pointless), and the larger the offset the smaller // the maximum bit length. _require(bitLength >= 1 && bitLength <= Math.min(255, 256 - offset), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); // Testing unsigned values for size is straightforward: their upper bits must be cleared. _require(value >> bitLength == 0, Errors.CODEC_OVERFLOW); } function _validateEncodingParams( int256 value, uint256 offset, uint256 bitLength ) private pure { _require(offset < 256, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); // We never accept 256 bit values (which would make the codec pointless), and the larger the offset the smaller // the maximum bit length. _require(bitLength >= 1 && bitLength <= Math.min(255, 256 - offset), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); // Testing signed values for size is a bit more involved. if (value >= 0) { // For positive values, we can simply check that the upper bits are clear. Notice we remove one bit from the // length for the sign bit. _require(value >> (bitLength - 1) == 0, Errors.CODEC_OVERFLOW); } else { // Negative values can receive the same treatment by making them positive, with the caveat that the range // for negative values in two's complement supports one more value than for the positive case. _require(Math.abs(value + 1) >> (bitLength - 1) == 0, Errors.CODEC_OVERFLOW); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "./LogExpMath.sol"; /* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */ library FixedPoint { // solhint-disable no-inline-assembly uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places uint256 internal constant TWO = 2 * ONE; uint256 internal constant FOUR = 4 * ONE; uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14) // Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE). uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18; function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return product / ONE; } function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { uint256 product = a * b; _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, if x == 0 then the result is zero // // Equivalent to: // result = product == 0 ? 0 : ((product - 1) / FixedPoint.ONE) + 1; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(product)), add(div(sub(product, 1), ONE), 1)) } } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(a == 0 || aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow return aInflated / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); uint256 aInflated = a * ONE; _require(a == 0 || aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow // The traditional divUp formula is: // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get: // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1 // Note that this requires x != 0, if x == 0 then the result is zero // // Equivalent to: // result = a == 0 ? 0 : (a * FixedPoint.ONE - 1) / b + 1; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(aInflated)), add(div(sub(aInflated, 1), b), 1)) } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive). */ function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Optimize for when y equals 1.0, 2.0 or 4.0, as those are very simple to implement and occur often in 50/50 // and 80/20 Weighted Pools if (y == ONE) { return x; } else if (y == TWO) { return mulDown(x, x); } else if (y == FOUR) { uint256 square = mulDown(x, x); return mulDown(square, square); } else { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); if (raw < maxError) { return 0; } else { return sub(raw, maxError); } } } /** * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative). */ function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Optimize for when y equals 1.0, 2.0 or 4.0, as those are very simple to implement and occur often in 50/50 // and 80/20 Weighted Pools if (y == ONE) { return x; } else if (y == TWO) { return mulUp(x, x); } else if (y == FOUR) { uint256 square = mulUp(x, x); return mulUp(square, square); } else { uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y); uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1); return add(raw, maxError); } } /** * @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1. * * Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and * prevents intermediate negative values. */ function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0; assembly { result := mul(lt(x, ONE), sub(ONE, x)) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated // documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the // rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to // permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: // The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the // Software. // THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE // WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR // COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR // OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /* solhint-disable */ /** * @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument). * * Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural * exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number). * * @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli * @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman * @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z */ library LogExpMath { // All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying // two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them. // All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers. int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18; // Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the // case of ln36, 36 decimals. int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20; int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36; // The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used. // // Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is // (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221. // The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument // ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312. // We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin. int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18; int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18; // Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point // 256 bit integer. int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17; int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17; uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20); // 18 decimal constants int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7 int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals) int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6 int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals) // 20 decimal constants int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5 int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2) int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4 int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3) int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3 int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4) int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2 int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5) int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1 int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6) int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0 int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7) int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1 int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8) int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2 int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9) int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3 int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10) int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4 int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11) /** * @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent. * * Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (y == 0) { // We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one. return uint256(ONE_18); } if (x == 0) { return 0; } // Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to // arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means // x^y = exp(y * ln(x)). // The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(x >> 255 == 0, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 x_int256 = int256(x); // We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In // both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end. // This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range. _require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS); int256 y_int256 = int256(y); int256 logx_times_y; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { int256 ln_36_x = _ln_36(x_int256); // ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just // bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal // multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the // (downscaled) last 18 decimals. logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18); } else { logx_times_y = _ln(x_int256) * y_int256; } logx_times_y /= ONE_18; // Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y _require( MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS ); return uint256(exp(logx_times_y)); } /** * @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent. * * Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`. */ function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT); if (x < 0) { // We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it // fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT). // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x)); } // First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n, // where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 // because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the // decomposition. // At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n. // exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause // intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals. // Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the // decomposition. // For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct // it and compute the accumulated product. int256 firstAN; if (x >= x0) { x -= x0; firstAN = a0; } else if (x >= x1) { x -= x1; firstAN = a1; } else { firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places } // We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the // smaller terms. x *= 100; // `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point // one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20. int256 product = ONE_20; if (x >= x2) { x -= x2; product = (product * a2) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x3) { x -= x3; product = (product * a3) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x4) { x -= x4; product = (product * a4) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x5) { x -= x5; product = (product * a5) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x6) { x -= x6; product = (product * a6) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x7) { x -= x7; product = (product * a7) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x8) { x -= x8; product = (product * a8) / ONE_20; } if (x >= x9) { x -= x9; product = (product * a9) / ONE_20; } // x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already. // Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series // expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!). int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places. int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!). // The first term is simply x. term = x; seriesSum += term; // Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number, // multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not. term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11; seriesSum += term; term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12; seriesSum += term; // 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision. // We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor // approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply // all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication), // and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value. return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100; } /** * @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument. */ function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) { // This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base). // Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by // upscaling. int256 logBase; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logBase = _ln_36(base); } else { logBase = _ln(base) * ONE_18; } int256 logArg; if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { logArg = _ln_36(arg); } else { logArg = _ln(arg) * ONE_18; } // When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase; } /** * @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) { // The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero. _require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS); if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < a && a < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) { return _ln_36(a) / ONE_18; } else { return _ln(a); } } /** * @dev Internal natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument. */ function _ln(int256 a) private pure returns (int256) { if (a < ONE_18) { // Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less // than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call. // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18. return (-_ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a)); } // First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which // we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is, // ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot // be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a. // At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n. // ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1. // We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition. // For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point // numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by // ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point. // For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide // by it and compute the accumulated sum. int256 sum = 0; if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) { a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x0; } if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) { a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division sum += x1; } // All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format. sum *= 100; a *= 100; // Because further a_n are 20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them. if (a >= a2) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a2; sum += x2; } if (a >= a3) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a3; sum += x3; } if (a >= a4) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a4; sum += x4; } if (a >= a5) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a5; sum += x5; } if (a >= a6) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a6; sum += x6; } if (a >= a7) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a7; sum += x7; } if (a >= a8) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a8; sum += x8; } if (a >= a9) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a9; sum += x9; } if (a >= a10) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a10; sum += x10; } if (a >= a11) { a = (a * ONE_20) / a11; sum += x11; } // a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series // that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36. // Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1). // ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_20. int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20; seriesSum += num / 11; // 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder) seriesSum *= 2; // We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both // with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal // value. return (sum + seriesSum) / 100; } /** * @dev Intrnal high precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument, * for x close to one. * * Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND. */ function _ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) { // Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits // worthwhile. // First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value. x *= ONE_18; // We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1). // ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1)) // Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires // division by ONE_36. int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36); int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36; // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term int256 num = z; // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z int256 seriesSum = num; // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2 num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 3; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 5; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 7; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 9; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 11; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 13; num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36; seriesSum += num / 15; // 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision. // All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point). return seriesSum * 2; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks. * Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library. */ library Math { // solhint-disable no-inline-assembly /** * @dev Returns the absolute value of a signed integer. */ function abs(int256 a) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = a > 0 ? uint256(a) : uint256(-a) assembly { let s := sar(255, a) result := sub(xor(a, s), s) } } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a + b; _require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow. */ function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) { int256 c = a - b; _require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to: // result = (a < b) ? b : a; assembly { result := sub(a, mul(sub(a, b), lt(a, b))) } } /** * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits. */ function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { // Equivalent to `result = (a < b) ? a : b` assembly { result := sub(a, mul(sub(a, b), gt(a, b))) } } function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a * b; _require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW); return c; } function div( uint256 a, uint256 b, bool roundUp ) internal pure returns (uint256) { return roundUp ? divUp(a, b) : divDown(a, b); } function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); return a / b; } function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256 result) { _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION); // Equivalent to: // result = a == 0 ? 0 : 1 + (a - 1) / b; assembly { result := mul(iszero(iszero(a)), add(1, div(sub(a, 1), b))) } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; /** * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data. * * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible, * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`. * * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA * ({_hashTypedDataV4}). * * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain. * * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask]. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract EIP712 { /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */ bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME; bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION; bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH; /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */ /** * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches. * * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]: * * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol. * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain. * * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart * contract upgrade]. */ constructor(string memory name, string memory version) { _HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name)); _HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version)); _TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)"); } /** * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain. */ function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this))); } /** * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain. * * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example: * * ```solidity * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode( * keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"), * mailTo, * keccak256(bytes(mailContents)) * ))); * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature); * ``` */ function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash)); } // solc-ignore-next-line func-mutability function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { chainId := chainid() } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./SafeMath.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the {IERC20} interface. * * This implementation is agnostic to the way tokens are created. This means * that a supply mechanism has to be added in a derived contract using {_mint}. * For a generic mechanism see {ERC20PresetMinterPauser}. * * TIP: For a detailed writeup see our guide * https://forum.zeppelin.solutions/t/how-to-implement-erc20-supply-mechanisms/226[How * to implement supply mechanisms]. * * We have followed general OpenZeppelin guidelines: functions revert instead * of returning `false` on failure. This behavior is nonetheless conventional * and does not conflict with the expectations of ERC20 applications. * * Additionally, an {Approval} event is emitted on calls to {transferFrom}. * This allows applications to reconstruct the allowance for all accounts just * by listening to said events. Other implementations of the EIP may not emit * these events, as it isn't required by the specification. * * Finally, the non-standard {decreaseAllowance} and {increaseAllowance} * functions have been added to mitigate the well-known issues around setting * allowances. See {IERC20-approve}. */ contract ERC20 is IERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; mapping(address => uint256) private _balances; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowances; uint256 private _totalSupply; string private _name; string private _symbol; uint8 private _decimals; /** * @dev Sets the values for {name} and {symbol}, initializes {decimals} with * a default value of 18. * * To select a different value for {decimals}, use {_setupDecimals}. * * All three of these values are immutable: they can only be set once during * construction. */ constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) { _name = name_; _symbol = symbol_; _decimals = 18; } /** * @dev Returns the name of the token. */ function name() public view returns (string memory) { return _name; } /** * @dev Returns the symbol of the token, usually a shorter version of the * name. */ function symbol() public view returns (string memory) { return _symbol; } /** * @dev Returns the number of decimals used to get its user representation. * For example, if `decimals` equals `2`, a balance of `505` tokens should * be displayed to a user as `5,05` (`505 / 10 ** 2`). * * Tokens usually opt for a value of 18, imitating the relationship between * Ether and Wei. This is the value {ERC20} uses, unless {_setupDecimals} is * called. * * NOTE: This information is only used for _display_ purposes: it in * no way affects any of the arithmetic of the contract, including * {IERC20-balanceOf} and {IERC20-transfer}. */ function decimals() public view returns (uint8) { return _decimals; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-totalSupply}. The total supply should only be read using this function * * Can be overridden by derived contracts to store the total supply in a different way (e.g. packed with other * storage values). */ function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _totalSupply; } /** * @dev Sets a new value for the total supply. It should only be set using this function. * * * Can be overridden by derived contracts to store the total supply in a different way (e.g. packed with other * storage values). */ function _setTotalSupply(uint256 value) internal virtual { _totalSupply = value; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-balanceOf}. */ function balanceOf(address account) public view override returns (uint256) { return _balances[account]; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-transfer}. * * Requirements: * * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - the caller must have a balance of at least `amount`. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount); return true; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-allowance}. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) { return _allowances[owner][spender]; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-approve}. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount); return true; } /** * @dev See {IERC20-transferFrom}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. This is not * required by the EIP. See the note at the beginning of {ERC20}. * * Requirements: * * - `sender` and `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`. * - the caller must have allowance for ``sender``'s tokens of at least * `amount`. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) public virtual override returns (bool) { _transfer(sender, recipient, amount); _approve( sender, msg.sender, _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE) ); return true; } /** * @dev Atomically increases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller. * * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for * problems described in {IERC20-approve}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue)); return true; } /** * @dev Atomically decreases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller. * * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for * problems described in {IERC20-approve}. * * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. * * Requirements: * * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. * - `spender` must have allowance for the caller of at least * `subtractedValue`. */ function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) { _approve( msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, Errors.ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO) ); return true; } /** * @dev Moves tokens `amount` from `sender` to `recipient`. * * This is internal function is equivalent to {transfer}, and can be used to * e.g. implement automatic token fees, slashing mechanisms, etc. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. * * Requirements: * * - `sender` cannot be the zero address. * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address. * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`. */ function _transfer( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) internal virtual { _require(sender != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS); _require(recipient != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS); _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount); _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE); _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount); emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount); } /** @dev Creates `amount` tokens and assigns them to `account`, increasing * the total supply. * * Emits a {Transfer} event with `from` set to the zero address. * * Requirements: * * - `to` cannot be the zero address. */ function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount); _setTotalSupply(totalSupply().add(amount)); _balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount); emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount); } /** * @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, reducing the * total supply. * * Emits a {Transfer} event with `to` set to the zero address. * * Requirements: * * - `account` cannot be the zero address. * - `account` must have at least `amount` tokens. */ function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual { _require(account != address(0), Errors.ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS); _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount); _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_BALANCE); _setTotalSupply(totalSupply().sub(amount)); emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount); } /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the `owner` s tokens. * * This internal function is equivalent to `approve`, and can be used to * e.g. set automatic allowances for certain subsystems, etc. * * Emits an {Approval} event. * * Requirements: * * - `owner` cannot be the zero address. * - `spender` cannot be the zero address. */ function _approve( address owner, address spender, uint256 amount ) internal virtual { _allowances[owner][spender] = amount; emit Approval(owner, spender, amount); } /** * @dev Sets {decimals} to a value other than the default one of 18. * * WARNING: This function should only be called from the constructor. Most * applications that interact with token contracts will not expect * {decimals} to ever change, and may work incorrectly if it does. */ function _setupDecimals(uint8 decimals_) internal { _decimals = decimals_; } /** * @dev Hook that is called before any transfer of tokens. This includes * minting and burning. * * Calling conditions: * * - when `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens * will be to transferred to `to`. * - when `from` is zero, `amount` tokens will be minted for `to`. * - when `to` is zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens will be burned. * - `from` and `to` are never both zero. * * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks]. */ function _beforeTokenTransfer( address from, address to, uint256 amount ) internal virtual { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20Permit.sol"; import "./ERC20.sol"; import "../helpers/EOASignaturesValidator.sol"; /** * @dev Implementation of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612]. * * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ abstract contract ERC20Permit is ERC20, IERC20Permit, EOASignaturesValidator { // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase bytes32 private constant _PERMIT_TYPEHASH = keccak256( "Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)" ); /** * @dev Initializes the {EIP712} domain separator using the `name` parameter, and setting `version` to `"1"`. * * It's a good idea to use the same `name` that is defined as the ERC20 token name. */ constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-permit}. */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) public virtual override { bytes32 structHash = keccak256( abi.encode(_PERMIT_TYPEHASH, owner, spender, value, getNextNonce(owner), deadline) ); _ensureValidSignature(owner, structHash, _toArraySignature(v, r, s), deadline, Errors.INVALID_SIGNATURE); _approve(owner, spender, value); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-nonces}. */ function nonces(address owner) public view override returns (uint256) { return getNextNonce(owner); } /** * @dev See {IERC20Permit-DOMAIN_SEPARATOR}. */ // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view override returns (bytes32) { return getDomainSeparator(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size. // Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using // private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs, but reduced bytecode size. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function. * * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested * (reentrant) calls to them. * * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry * points to them. * * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways * to protect against it, check out our blog post * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul]. */ abstract contract ReentrancyGuard { // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled. // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive, // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect. uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1; uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2; uint256 private _status; constructor() { _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } /** * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly. * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant` * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a * `private` function that does the actual work. */ modifier nonReentrant() { _enterNonReentrant(); _; _exitNonReentrant(); } function _enterNonReentrant() private { // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY); // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail _status = _ENTERED; } function _exitNonReentrant() private { // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200) _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow * checks. * * Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can * easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually * assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by * reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. * * Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing * all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting. */ library SafeCast { /** * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256. * * Requirements: * * - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256. */ function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) { _require(value >> 255 == 0, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256); return int256(value); } /** * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into an unsigned uint64. * * Requirements: * * - input must be less than or equal to maxUint64. */ function toUint64(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint64) { _require(value <= type(uint64).max, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_UINT64); return uint64(value); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow * checks. * * Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result * in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an * error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages. * `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an * operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. */ library SafeMath { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Addition cannot overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { return sub(a, b, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW); } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 errorCode ) internal pure returns (uint256) { _require(b <= a, errorCode); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.7.0; interface AggregatorV3Interface { function decimals() external view returns (uint8); function description() external view returns (string memory); function version() external view returns (uint256); // getRoundData and latestRoundData should both raise "No data present" // if they do not have data to report, instead of returning unset values // which could be misinterpreted as actual reported values. function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); function latestRoundData() external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; library SwaapV2Errors { // Safeguard Pool uint256 internal constant EXCEEDED_SWAP_AMOUNT_IN = 0; uint256 internal constant EXCEEDED_SWAP_AMOUNT_OUT = 1; uint256 internal constant UNFAIR_PRICE = 2; uint256 internal constant LOW_PERFORMANCE = 3; uint256 internal constant MIN_BALANCE_OUT_NOT_MET = 4; uint256 internal constant NOT_ENOUGH_PT_OUT = 5; uint256 internal constant EXCEEDED_BURNED_PT = 6; uint256 internal constant SIGNER_CANNOT_BE_NULL_ADDRESS = 7; uint256 internal constant PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL_TOO_LOW = 8; uint256 internal constant PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL_TOO_HIGH = 9; uint256 internal constant MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEV_TOO_LOW = 10; uint256 internal constant MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEV_TOO_HIGH = 11; uint256 internal constant MAX_TARGET_DEV_TOO_LOW = 12; uint256 internal constant MAX_TARGET_DEV_TOO_LARGE = 13; uint256 internal constant MAX_PRICE_DEV_TOO_LOW = 14; uint256 internal constant MAX_PRICE_DEV_TOO_LARGE = 15; uint256 internal constant PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_TOO_SOON = 16; uint256 internal constant BITMAP_SIGNATURE_NOT_VALID = 17; uint256 internal constant QUOTE_ALREADY_USED = 18; uint256 internal constant REPLAYABLE_SIGNATURE_NOT_VALID = 19; uint256 internal constant QUOTE_BALANCE_NO_LONGER_VALID = 20; uint256 internal constant WRONG_TOKEN_IN_IN_EXCESS = 21; uint256 internal constant WRONG_TOKEN_OUT_IN_EXCESS = 22; uint256 internal constant EXCEEDS_TIMEOUT = 23; uint256 internal constant NON_POSITIVE_PRICE = 24; uint256 internal constant FEES_TOO_HIGH = 25; uint256 internal constant LOW_INITIAL_BALANCE = 26; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_TIMEOUT_TOO_HIGH = 27; uint256 internal constant OUTDATED_ORACLE_ROUND_ID = 28; uint256 internal constant LOW_SWAP_AMOUNT_IN = 29; uint256 internal constant LOW_SWAP_AMOUNT_OUT = 30; } /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 99 are * supported. */ function _srequire(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _srevert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 99 are supported. */ function _srevert(uint256 errorCode) pure { // We're going to dynamically create a revert uint256 based on the error code, with the following format: // 'SWAAP#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to two digits (so they range from 00 to 99). // // We don't have revert uint256s embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual uint256 characters. // // The dynamic uint256 creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-99 // range, so we only need to convert two digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full uint256. The SWAAP# part is a known constant // (0x535741415023): we simply shift this by 16 (to provide space for the 2 bytes of the error code), and add // the characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 192 bits (256 minus the length of the uint256, 8 characters * 8 // bits per character = 64) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let revertReason := shl(192, add(0x5357414150230000, add(units, shl(8, tenths)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ uint256 location offset ] [ uint256 length ] [ uint256 contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(uint256) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 29 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the uint256, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The uint256 length is fixed: 8 characters. mstore(0x24, 8) // Finally, the uint256 itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the uint256 is only 8 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@chainlink/contracts/src/v0.7/interfaces/AggregatorV3Interface.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IBasePool.sol"; import "./ISignatureSafeguard.sol"; interface ISafeguardPool is IBasePool, ISignatureSafeguard { event PegStatesUpdated(bool isPegged0, bool isPegged1); event FlexibleOracleStatesUpdated(bool isFlexibleOracle0, bool isFlexibleOracle1); event SignerChanged(address indexed signer); event MustAllowlistLPsSet(bool mustAllowlistLPs); event PerfUpdateIntervalChanged(uint256 perfUpdateInterval); event MaxPerfDevChanged(uint256 maxPerfDev); event MaxTargetDevChanged(uint256 maxTargetDev); event MaxPriceDevChanged(uint256 maxPriceDev); event ManagementFeesUpdated(uint256 yearlyFees); /// @dev the amountIn and amountOut are denominated in 18-decimals, /// irrespective of the specific decimal precision utilized by each token. event Quote(bytes32 indexed digest, uint256 amountIn18Decimals, uint256 amountOut18Decimals); /// @dev The target balances are denominated in 18-decimals, /// irrespective of the specific decimal precision utilized by each token. event InitialTargetBalancesSet(uint256 targetBalancePerPT0, uint256 targetBalancePerPT1); /// @param feesClaimed corresponds to the minted pool tokens /// @param totalSupply corresponds to the total supply before minting the pool tokens event ManagementFeesClaimed(uint256 feesClaimed, uint256 totalSupply, uint256 yearlyRate, uint256 time); /// @dev The target balances are denominated in 18-decimals, /// irrespective of the specific decimal precision utilized by each token. event PerformanceUpdated( uint256 targetBalancePerPT0, uint256 targetBalancePerPT1, uint256 performance, uint256 amount0Per1, uint256 time ); struct InitialSafeguardParams { address signer; // address that signs the quotes uint256 maxPerfDev; // maximum performance deviation uint256 maxTargetDev; // maximum balance deviation from hodl benchmark uint256 maxPriceDev; // maximum price deviation uint256 perfUpdateInterval; // performance update interval uint256 yearlyFees; // management fees in yearly % bool mustAllowlistLPs; // must use allowlist flag } struct InitialOracleParams { AggregatorV3Interface oracle; uint256 maxTimeout; bool isStable; bool isFlexibleOracle; } struct OracleParams { AggregatorV3Interface oracle; uint256 maxTimeout; bool isStable; bool isFlexibleOracle; bool isPegged; uint256 priceScalingFactor; } /* * Setters */ /// @dev sets or removes flexible oracles function setFlexibleOracleStates(bool isFlexibleOracle0, bool isFlexibleOracle1) external; /// @dev sets or removes allowlist function setMustAllowlistLPs(bool mustAllowlistLPs) external; /// @dev sets the quote signer function setSigner(address signer) external; /// @dev sets the performance update interval function setPerfUpdateInterval(uint256 perfUpdateInterval) external; /// @dev sets the max performance deviation function setMaxPerfDev(uint256 maxPerfDev) external; /// @dev sets the maximum deviation from target balances function setMaxTargetDev(uint256 maxTargetDev) external; /// @dev sets the maximum quote price deviation from the oracles function setMaxPriceDev(uint256 maxPriceDev) external; /// @dev sets yearly management fees function setManagementFees(uint256 yearlyFees) external; /// @dev updates the performance and the hodl balances (should be permissionless) function updatePerformance() external; /// @dev unpegs or repegs oracles based on the latest prices (should be permissionless) function evaluateStablesPegStates() external; /// @dev claims accumulated management fees (can be permissionless) function claimManagementFees() external; /* * Getters */ /// @dev returns the current pool's performance function getPoolPerformance() external view returns(uint256); /// @dev returns if the pool function isAllowlistEnabled() external view returns(bool); /// @dev returns the current target balances of the pool based on the hodl strategy and latest performance function getHodlBalancesPerPT() external view returns(uint256, uint256); /// @dev returns the on-chain oracle price of tokenIn such that price = amountIn / amountOut function getOnChainAmountInPerOut(address tokenIn) external view returns(uint256); /// @dev returns the current pool's safeguard parameters function getPoolParameters() external view returns( uint256 maxPerfDev, uint256 maxTargetDev, uint256 maxPriceDev, uint256 lastPerfUpdate, uint256 perfUpdateInterval ); /// @dev returns the current pool oracle parameters function getOracleParams() external view returns(OracleParams[] memory); /// @dev returns the yearly fees, yearly rate and the latest fee claim time function getManagementFeesParams() external view returns(uint256, uint256, uint256); }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; interface ISignatureSafeguard { event AllowlistJoinSignatureValidated(bytes32 indexed digest); /// @dev returns quote signer's address function signer() external returns(address); /// @dev returns the bitmap word value given the word's index (= index / 256) function getQuoteBitmapWord(uint256 wordIndex) external view returns(uint); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./ISafeguardPool.sol"; library SafeguardPoolUserData { // In order to preserve backwards compatibility, make sure new join and exit kinds are added at the end of the enum. enum JoinKind { INIT, ALL_TOKENS_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT, EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT } enum ExitKind { EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT, BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT } uint256 private constant _MASK_128_BITS = 0x00000000000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF; uint256 private constant _OFFSET_128_BITS = 128; function joinKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (JoinKind) { return abi.decode(self, (JoinKind)); } function exitKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (ExitKind) { return abi.decode(self, (ExitKind)); } // Swaps function pricingParameters(bytes memory self) internal pure returns( address expectedOrigin, uint256 originBasedSlippage, bytes32 priceBasedParams, bytes32 quoteBalances, uint256 quoteTotalSupply, bytes32 balanceBasedParams, bytes32 timeBasedParams ) { return abi.decode(self, (address, uint256, bytes32, bytes32, uint256, bytes32, bytes32)); } function decodeSignedSwapData(bytes calldata self) internal pure returns(bytes memory swapData, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline) { ( swapData, signature, quoteIndex, deadline ) = abi.decode(self, (bytes, bytes, uint256, uint256)); } function unpackPairedUints(bytes32 packedUint) internal pure returns(uint256 a, uint256 b) { assembly{ a := shr(_OFFSET_128_BITS, packedUint) b := and(_MASK_128_BITS, packedUint) } } // Joins function allowlistData(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 deadline, bytes memory signature, bytes memory joinData) { (deadline, signature, joinData) = abi.decode(self, (uint256, bytes, bytes)); } function initJoin(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (JoinKind kind, uint256[] memory amountsIn) { (kind, amountsIn) = abi.decode(self, (JoinKind, uint256[])); } function allTokensInForExactBptOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountOut) { (, bptAmountOut) = abi.decode(self, (JoinKind, uint256)); } // Exits function exactBptInForTokensOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn) { (, bptAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (ExitKind, uint256)); } function decodeSignedExitData(bytes memory self) internal pure returns(ExitKind kind, uint256 deadline, bytes memory exitData, bytes memory signature){ ( kind, deadline, exitData, signature ) = abi.decode(self, (ExitKind, uint256, bytes, bytes)); } // Join/Exit + Swap function exactJoinExitSwapData(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (bool swapTokenIn, bytes memory swapData, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline){ ( , // corresponds to join or exit kind , // minBptAmountOut or maxBptAmountIn , // join amountsIn or exit amounts Out swapTokenIn, // excess token in or limit token in swapData, // swap pricing data signature, // the signature based on swapData & other quote pricing information quoteIndex, // the index of the quote deadline // swap deadline ) = abi.decode(self, (uint8, uint, uint[], bool, bytes, bytes, uint256, uint256)); } // Join/Exit + Swap function exactJoinExitAmountsData(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 limitBptAmount, uint256[] memory joinExitAmounts) { ( , // corresponds to join or exit kind limitBptAmount, // minBptAmountOut or maxBptAmountIn joinExitAmounts // join amountsIn or exit amounts Out ) = abi.decode(self, (uint8, uint, uint[])); } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU Affero General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU Affero General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU Affero General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity =0.7.6; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@chainlink/contracts/src/v0.7/interfaces/AggregatorV3Interface.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-errors/contracts/SwaapV2Errors.sol"; library ChainlinkUtils { function getLatestPrice(AggregatorV3Interface oracle, uint256 maxTimeout) internal view returns (uint256) { ( uint80 roundId, int256 latestPrice, , uint256 latestTimestamp, uint80 answeredInRound ) = AggregatorV3Interface(oracle).latestRoundData(); // we assume that block.timestamp >= maxTimeout _srequire(latestTimestamp >= block.timestamp - maxTimeout, SwaapV2Errors.EXCEEDS_TIMEOUT); _srequire(latestPrice > 0, SwaapV2Errors.NON_POSITIVE_PRICE); _srequire(roundId == answeredInRound, SwaapV2Errors.OUTDATED_ORACLE_ROUND_ID); return uint256(latestPrice); } function computePriceScalingFactor(AggregatorV3Interface oracle) internal view returns (uint256) { // Oracles that don't implement the `decimals` method are not supported. uint256 oracleDecimals = oracle.decimals(); // Oracles with more than 18 decimals are not supported. uint256 decimalsDifference = Math.sub(18, oracleDecimals); return FixedPoint.ONE * 10**decimalsDifference; } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity =0.7.6; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/FixedPoint.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/Math.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/math/LogExpMath.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-errors/contracts/SwaapV2Errors.sol"; library SafeguardMath { using FixedPoint for uint256; using SafeCast for uint256; uint256 private constant _ONE_YEAR = 365 days; /** * @notice slippage based on the lag between quotation and execution time */ function calcTimeBasedPenalty( uint256 currentTimestamp, uint256 startTime, uint256 timeBasedSlippage ) internal pure returns(uint256) { if(currentTimestamp <= startTime) { return 0; } return Math.mul(timeBasedSlippage, (currentTimestamp - startTime)); } /** * @notice slippage based on the change of the pool's balance between quotation and execution time * @param balanceTokenIn actual balance of the token in before the swap * @param balanceTokenOut actual balance of the token out before the swap * @param totalSupply total supply of the pool during swap time * @param quoteBalanceIn expected balance of the token in at the time of the quote * @param quoteBalanceOut expected balance of the token out at the time of the quote * @param quoteTotalSupply expected total supply of the pool at the time of the quote * @param balanceChangeTolerance max percentage change of the pool's balance between quotation and execution * @param balanceBasedSlippage slope based on the change of the pool's balance between quotation and execution */ function calcBalanceBasedPenalty( uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut, uint256 totalSupply, uint256 quoteBalanceIn, uint256 quoteBalanceOut, uint256 quoteTotalSupply, uint256 balanceChangeTolerance, uint256 balanceBasedSlippage ) internal pure returns (uint256) { // if the expected balance of the token in is lower than the actual balance, we apply a penalty uint256 balanceDevIn = Math.max( calcBalanceDeviation(balanceTokenIn, quoteBalanceIn), calcBalanceDeviation(balanceTokenIn.divDown(totalSupply), quoteBalanceIn.divDown(quoteTotalSupply)) ); // if the expected balance of the token out is lower than the actual balance, we apply a penalty uint256 balanceDevOut = Math.max( calcBalanceDeviation(balanceTokenOut, quoteBalanceOut), calcBalanceDeviation(balanceTokenOut.divDown(totalSupply), quoteBalanceOut.divDown(quoteTotalSupply)) ); uint256 maxDeviation = Math.max(balanceDevIn, balanceDevOut); _srequire(maxDeviation <= balanceChangeTolerance, SwaapV2Errors.QUOTE_BALANCE_NO_LONGER_VALID); return balanceBasedSlippage.mulUp(maxDeviation); } function calcBalanceDeviation(uint256 currentBalance, uint256 quoteBalance) internal pure returns(uint256) { return currentBalance >= quoteBalance ? 0 : (quoteBalance - currentBalance).divDown(quoteBalance); } /** * @notice slippage based on the transaction origin */ function calcOriginBasedPenalty( address expectedOrigin, uint256 originBasedSlippage ) internal view returns(uint256) { if(expectedOrigin != tx.origin) { return originBasedSlippage; } return 0; } /********************************************************************************************** // aE = amountIn in excess // // aL = limiting amountIn // // bE = current balance of excess token / aE * bL - aL * bE \\ // // bL = current balance of limiting token sIn = | ------------------------------- | // // sIn = swap amount in needed before the join \\ bL + aL + (1/p) * ( bE + aE ) / // // sOut = swap amount out needed before the join // // p = relative price such that: sIn = p * sOut // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcJoinSwapAmounts( uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 limitTokenBalance, uint256 excessTokenAmountIn, uint256 limitTokenAmountIn, uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut ) internal pure returns (uint256, uint256) { uint256 foo = excessTokenAmountIn.mulDown(limitTokenBalance); uint256 bar = limitTokenAmountIn.mulDown(excessTokenBalance); _srequire(foo >= bar, SwaapV2Errors.WRONG_TOKEN_IN_IN_EXCESS); uint256 num = foo - bar; uint256 denom = limitTokenBalance.add(limitTokenAmountIn); denom = denom.add((excessTokenBalance.add(excessTokenAmountIn)).divDown(quoteAmountInPerOut)); uint256 swapAmountIn = num.divDown(denom); uint256 swapAmountOut = swapAmountIn.divDown(quoteAmountInPerOut); return (swapAmountIn, swapAmountOut); } /********************************************************************************************** // aE = amountIn in excess // // bE = current balance of excess token / aE - sIn \\ // // sIn = swap amount in needed before the join rOpt = | ----------- | // // rOpt = amountIn TV / current pool TVL \\ bE + sIn / // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcJoinSwapROpt( uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 excessTokenAmountIn, uint256 swapAmountIn ) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 num = excessTokenAmountIn.sub(swapAmountIn); uint256 denom = excessTokenBalance.add(swapAmountIn); // removing 1wei from the numerator and adding 1wei to the denominator to make up for rounding errors // that may have accumulated in previous calculations return (num.sub(1)).divDown(denom.add(1)); } /********************************************************************************************** // aE = amountOut in excess // // aL = limiting amountOut // // bE = current balance of excess token / aE * bL - aL * bE \\ // // bL = current balance of limiting token sOut = | --------------------------- | // // sIn = swap amount in needed before the exit \\ bL - aL + p * ( bE - aE ) / // // sOut = swap amount out needed before the exit // // p = relative price such that: sIn = p * sOut // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcExitSwapAmounts( uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 limitTokenBalance, uint256 excessTokenAmountOut, uint256 limitTokenAmountOut, uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut ) internal pure returns (uint256, uint256) { uint256 foo = excessTokenAmountOut.mulDown(limitTokenBalance); uint256 bar = limitTokenAmountOut.mulDown(excessTokenBalance); _srequire(foo >= bar, SwaapV2Errors.WRONG_TOKEN_OUT_IN_EXCESS); uint256 num = foo - bar; uint256 denom = limitTokenBalance.sub(limitTokenAmountOut); denom = denom.add((excessTokenBalance.sub(excessTokenAmountOut)).mulDown(quoteAmountInPerOut)); uint256 swapAmountOut = num.divDown(denom); uint256 swapAmountIn = quoteAmountInPerOut.mulDown(swapAmountOut); return (swapAmountIn, swapAmountOut); } /********************************************************************************************** // aE = amountOut in excess // // bE = current balance of excess token / aE - sOut \\ // // sOut = swap amount out needed before the exit rOpt = | ----------- | // // rOpt = amountOut TV / current pool TVL \\ bE - sOut / // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcExitSwapROpt( uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 excessTokenAmountOut, uint256 swapAmountOut ) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 num = excessTokenAmountOut.sub(swapAmountOut); uint256 denom = excessTokenBalance.sub(swapAmountOut); // adding 1wei to the numerator and removing 1wei from the denominator to make up for rounding errors // that may have accumulated in previous calculations return (num.add(1)).divDown(denom.sub(1)); } /********************************************************************************************** // f = yearly management fees percentage / ln(1 - f) \\ // // 1y = 1 year a = - | ------------ | // // a = yearly rate constant \\ 1y / // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcYearlyRate(uint256 yearlyFees) internal pure returns(uint256) { uint256 logInput = FixedPoint.ONE.sub(yearlyFees); // Since 0 < logInput <= 1 => logResult <= 0 int256 logResult = LogExpMath.ln(int256(logInput)); return(uint256(-logResult) / _ONE_YEAR); } /********************************************************************************************** // bptOut = bpt tokens to be minted as fees // // TS = total supply bptOut = TS * (e^(a*dT) -1) // // a = yearly rate constant // // dT = elapsed time between the previous and current claim // **********************************************************************************************/ function calcAccumulatedManagementFees( uint256 elapsedTime, uint256 yearlyRate, uint256 currentSupply ) internal pure returns(uint256) { uint256 expInput = Math.mul(yearlyRate, elapsedTime); uint256 expResult = uint256(LogExpMath.exp(expInput.toInt256())); return (currentSupply.mulDown(expResult.sub(FixedPoint.ONE))); } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. /* s███ ██████ @██████ ,s███` ,██████████████ █████████^@█████_ ██████████_ 7@███_ "██████████M @██████████_ `_ "@█████b ^^^^^^^^^^" ^"` ████████████████████p _█████████████████████ @████████████████████ @███████████WT@██████b ████████████████████ @███████████ ,██████ @███████████████████ @███████████████████b @██████████████████ @██████████████████b "█████████████████ @█████████████████b @███████████████ @████████████████ %█████████████ @██████████████` ^%██████████ @███████████" ████████ @██████W"` 1███████ "@█████ 7W@█ */ pragma solidity =0.7.6; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "./ChainlinkUtils.sol"; import "./SafeguardMath.sol"; import "./SignatureSafeguard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-pool-utils/contracts/BasePool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/EOASignaturesValidator.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-pool-utils/contracts/lib/BasePoolMath.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/safeguard-pool/SafeguardPoolUserData.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/safeguard-pool/ISafeguardPool.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-errors/contracts/SwaapV2Errors.sol"; /** * @title Safeguard Pool * @author Swaap-labs (https://github.com/swaap-labs/swaap-v2-monorepo) * @notice Main contract that allows the use of a non-custodial RfQ market-making infrastructure that * implements safety measures (i.e "safeguards") to prevent potential value extraction from the pool. * For more details: https://www.swaap.finance/v2-whitepaper.pdf. * @dev This contract is built on top of Balancer V2's infrastructure but is meant to be deployed with * a modified version of Balancer V2 Vault. (refer to the comments in the `updatePerformance` function * for more details). */ contract SafeguardPool is ISafeguardPool, SignatureSafeguard, BasePool, IMinimalSwapInfoPool, ReentrancyGuard { using FixedPoint for uint256; using WordCodec for bytes32; using BasePoolUserData for bytes; using SafeguardPoolUserData for bytes32; using SafeguardPoolUserData for bytes; uint256 private constant _NUM_TOKENS = 2; // initial BPT minted at the initialization of the pool uint256 private constant _INITIAL_BPT = 100 ether; // minimum acceptable balance at the initialization of the pool (balance upscaled to 18 decimals) uint256 private constant _MIN_INITIAL_BALANCE = 1e8; // Pool parameters constants uint256 private constant _MIN_SWAP_AMOUNT_PERCENTAGE = 10e16; // 10% min swap amount uint256 private constant _MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEVIATION = 95e16; // 5% max tolerance uint256 private constant _MAX_TARGET_DEVIATION = 80e16; // 20% max tolerance uint256 private constant _MAX_PRICE_DEVIATION = 97e16; // 3% max tolerance uint256 private constant _MIN_PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL = 0.5 days; uint256 private constant _MAX_PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL = 1.5 days; uint256 private constant _MAX_ORACLE_TIMEOUT = 1.5 days; // NB Max yearly fee should fit in a 32 bits slot uint256 private constant _MAX_YEARLY_FEES = 5e16; // corresponds to 5% fees IERC20 internal immutable _token0; IERC20 internal immutable _token1; AggregatorV3Interface internal immutable _oracle0; AggregatorV3Interface internal immutable _oracle1; uint256 internal immutable _maxOracleTimeout0; uint256 internal immutable _maxOracleTimeout1; bool internal immutable _isStable0; bool internal immutable _isStable1; uint256 internal constant _REPEG_PRICE_BOUND = 0.002e18; // repegs at 0.2% uint256 internal constant _UNPEG_PRICE_BOUND = 0.005e18; // unpegs at 0.5% // tokens scale factor uint256 internal immutable _scaleFactor0; uint256 internal immutable _scaleFactor1; // oracle price scale factor uint256 internal immutable _priceScaleFactor0; uint256 internal immutable _priceScaleFactor1; // quote signer address private _signer; // Allowlist enabled / disabled bool private _mustAllowlistLPs; // Management fees related variables uint32 private _previousClaimTime; // NB For a max yearly fee of 10% it is safe to use 32 bits for the yearlyRate. // For higher fees more bits should be allocated. uint32 private _yearlyRate; // yearly management fees uint64 private _yearlyFees; // solhint-disable max-line-length // [ isPegged0 | isPegged1 | flexibleOracle0 | flexibleOracle1 | max performance dev | max hodl dev | max price dev | perf update interval | last perf update ] // [ 1 bit | 1 bit | 1 bit | 1 bit | 60 bits | 64 bits | 64 bits | 32 bits | 32 bits ] // [ MSB LSB ] bytes32 private _packedPoolParams; // solhint-enable max-line-length // used to determine if stable coin is holding the peg uint256 private constant _TOKEN_0_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET = 255; uint256 private constant _TOKEN_1_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET = 254; // used to determine if the oracle can be pegged to a fixed value uint256 private constant _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_0_BIT_OFFSET = 253; uint256 private constant _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_1_BIT_OFFSET = 252; // used to determine if the pool is underperforming compared to the last performance update uint256 private constant _MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_OFFSET = 192; uint256 private constant _MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_LENGTH = 60; // used to determine if the pool balances deviated from the hodl reference uint256 private constant _MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_OFFSET = 128; uint256 private constant _MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_LENGTH = 64; // used to determine if the quote's price is too low compared to the oracle's price uint256 private constant _MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_OFFSET = 64; uint256 private constant _MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_LENGTH = 64; // used to determine if a performance update is needed before a swap / one-asset-join / one-asset-exit uint256 private constant _PERF_UPDATE_INTERVAL_BIT_OFFSET = 32; uint256 private constant _PERF_LAST_UPDATE_BIT_OFFSET = 0; uint256 private constant _PERF_TIME_BIT_LENGTH = 32; // [ min balance 0 per PT | min balance 1 per PT ] // [ 128 bits | 128 bits ] // [ MSB LSB ] bytes32 private _hodlBalancesPerPT; // benchmark target reserves based on performance uint256 private constant _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_0 = 128; uint256 private constant _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_1 = 0; uint256 private constant _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_LENGTH = 128; constructor( IVault vault, string memory name, string memory symbol, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers, uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration, address owner, InitialOracleParams[] memory oracleParams, InitialSafeguardParams memory safeguardParameters ) BasePool( vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN, name, symbol, tokens, assetManagers, _getMinSwapFeePercentage(), pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration, owner ) { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, _NUM_TOKENS); InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(oracleParams.length, _NUM_TOKENS); // token related parameters _token0 = IERC20(address(tokens[0])); _token1 = IERC20(address(tokens[1])); _scaleFactor0 = _computeScalingFactor(tokens[0]); _scaleFactor1 = _computeScalingFactor(tokens[1]); // oracle related parameters _oracle0 = oracleParams[0].oracle; _oracle1 = oracleParams[1].oracle; // oracles max price timeouts must be lower than 1.5 days _srequire( oracleParams[0].maxTimeout <= _MAX_ORACLE_TIMEOUT && oracleParams[1].maxTimeout <= _MAX_ORACLE_TIMEOUT, SwaapV2Errors.ORACLE_TIMEOUT_TOO_HIGH ); // setting oracles price max timeouts _maxOracleTimeout0 = oracleParams[0].maxTimeout; _maxOracleTimeout1 = oracleParams[1].maxTimeout; // setting oracles price scale factors _priceScaleFactor0 = ChainlinkUtils.computePriceScalingFactor(oracleParams[0].oracle); _priceScaleFactor1 = ChainlinkUtils.computePriceScalingFactor(oracleParams[1].oracle); _isStable0 = oracleParams[0].isStable; _isStable1 = oracleParams[1].isStable; if(oracleParams[0].isStable && oracleParams[0].isFlexibleOracle) { _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertBool(true, _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_0_BIT_OFFSET); } if(oracleParams[1].isStable && oracleParams[1].isFlexibleOracle) { _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertBool(true, _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_1_BIT_OFFSET); } // pool related parameters _setSigner(safeguardParameters.signer); _setMaxPerfDev(safeguardParameters.maxPerfDev); _setMaxTargetDev(safeguardParameters.maxTargetDev); _setMaxPriceDev(safeguardParameters.maxPriceDev); _setPerfUpdateInterval(safeguardParameters.perfUpdateInterval); _previousClaimTime = uint32(block.timestamp); // _previousClaimTime is not updated in _setYearlyRate _setYearlyRate(safeguardParameters.yearlyFees); _setMustAllowlistLPs(safeguardParameters.mustAllowlistLPs); } function onSwap( SwapRequest calldata request, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut ) external override onlyVault(request.poolId) returns (uint256) { _beforeSwapJoinExit(); bool isTokenInToken0 = request.tokenIn == _token0; (bytes memory swapData, bytes32 digest) = _swapSignatureSafeguard( request.kind, isTokenInToken0, request.from, request.to, request.userData ); (uint256 scalingFactorTokenIn, uint256 scalingFactorTokenOut) = _scalingFactorsInAndOut(isTokenInToken0); balanceTokenIn = _upscale(balanceTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); balanceTokenOut = _upscale(balanceTokenOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); (uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount) = _getQuoteAmountInPerOut(swapData, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut); if (request.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) { uint256 amountIn = request.amount; return _onSwapGivenIn( digest, isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, amountIn, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount, scalingFactorTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenOut ); } else { uint256 amountOut = request.amount; return _onSwapGivenOut( digest, isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, amountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount, scalingFactorTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenOut ); } } /// @dev amountInPerOut = baseAmountInPerOut * (1 + slippagePenalty) function _getQuoteAmountInPerOut( bytes memory swapData, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut ) internal view returns (uint256, uint256) { ( address expectedOrigin, uint256 originBasedSlippage, bytes32 priceBasedParams, bytes32 quoteBalances, uint256 quoteTotalSupply, bytes32 balanceBasedParams, bytes32 timeBasedParams ) = swapData.pricingParameters(); uint256 penalty = _getBalanceBasedPenalty( balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, quoteBalances, quoteTotalSupply, balanceBasedParams ); penalty = penalty.add(_getTimeBasedPenalty(timeBasedParams)); penalty = penalty.add(SafeguardMath.calcOriginBasedPenalty(expectedOrigin, originBasedSlippage)); (uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount) = priceBasedParams.unpackPairedUints(); penalty = penalty.add(FixedPoint.ONE); return (quoteAmountInPerOut.mulUp(penalty), maxSwapAmount); } function _getBalanceBasedPenalty( uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut, bytes32 quoteBalances, uint256 quoteTotalSupply, bytes32 balanceBasedParams ) internal view returns(uint256) { (uint256 quoteBalanceIn, uint256 quoteBalanceOut) = quoteBalances.unpackPairedUints(); (uint256 balanceChangeTolerance, uint256 balanceBasedSlippage) = balanceBasedParams.unpackPairedUints(); return SafeguardMath.calcBalanceBasedPenalty( balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, totalSupply(), quoteBalanceIn, quoteBalanceOut, quoteTotalSupply, balanceChangeTolerance, balanceBasedSlippage ); } function _getTimeBasedPenalty(bytes32 timeBasedParams) internal view returns(uint256) { (uint256 startTime, uint256 timeBasedSlippage) = timeBasedParams.unpackPairedUints(); return SafeguardMath.calcTimeBasedPenalty(block.timestamp, startTime, timeBasedSlippage); } function _onSwapGivenIn( bytes32 digest, bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount, uint256 scalingFactorTokenIn, uint256 scalingFactorTokenOut ) internal returns(uint256) { amountIn = _upscale(amountIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); uint256 amountOut = amountIn.divDown(quoteAmountInPerOut); _validateSwap( digest, IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN, isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, amountIn, amountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount ); return _downscaleDown(amountOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); } function _onSwapGivenOut( bytes32 digest, bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut, uint256 amountOut, uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount, uint256 scalingFactorTokenIn, uint256 scalingFactorTokenOut ) internal returns(uint256) { amountOut = _upscale(amountOut, scalingFactorTokenOut); uint256 amountIn = amountOut.mulUp(quoteAmountInPerOut); _validateSwap( digest, IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_OUT, isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, amountIn, amountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount ); return _downscaleUp(amountIn, scalingFactorTokenIn); } /** * @dev all the inputs should be normalized to 18 decimals regardless of token decimals */ function _validateSwap( bytes32 digest, IVault.SwapKind kind, bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 balanceTokenIn, uint256 balanceTokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut, uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount ) internal { if(kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) { _srequire(amountIn <= maxSwapAmount, SwaapV2Errors.EXCEEDED_SWAP_AMOUNT_IN); _srequire(amountIn >= maxSwapAmount.mulDown(_MIN_SWAP_AMOUNT_PERCENTAGE), SwaapV2Errors.LOW_SWAP_AMOUNT_IN); } else { _srequire(amountOut <= maxSwapAmount, SwaapV2Errors.EXCEEDED_SWAP_AMOUNT_OUT); _srequire(amountOut >= maxSwapAmount.mulDown(_MIN_SWAP_AMOUNT_PERCENTAGE), SwaapV2Errors.LOW_SWAP_AMOUNT_OUT); } bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut = _getOnChainAmountInPerOut(packedPoolParams, isTokenInToken0); _fairPricingSafeguard(quoteAmountInPerOut, onChainAmountInPerOut, packedPoolParams); uint256 totalSupply = totalSupply(); _updatePerformanceIfDue( isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut, onChainAmountInPerOut, totalSupply, packedPoolParams ); _balancesSafeguard( isTokenInToken0, balanceTokenIn.add(amountIn), balanceTokenOut.sub(amountOut), onChainAmountInPerOut, totalSupply, packedPoolParams ); Quote(digest, amountIn, amountOut); } // ensures that the quote has a fair price compared to the on-chain price function _fairPricingSafeguard( uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut, bytes32 packedPoolParams ) internal pure { _srequire(quoteAmountInPerOut.divDown(onChainAmountInPerOut) >= _getMaxPriceDev(packedPoolParams), SwaapV2Errors.UNFAIR_PRICE); } // updates the pool target balances based on performance if needed function _updatePerformanceIfDue( bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 currentBalanceIn, uint256 currentBalanceOut, uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut, uint256 totalSupply, bytes32 packedPoolParams ) internal { (uint256 lastPerfUpdate, uint256 perfUpdateInterval) = _getPerformanceTimeParams(packedPoolParams); // lastPerfUpdate & perfUpdateInterval are stored in 32 bits so they cannot overflow if(block.timestamp > lastPerfUpdate + perfUpdateInterval){ if(isTokenInToken0){ _updatePerformance(currentBalanceIn, currentBalanceOut, onChainAmountInPerOut, totalSupply); } else { _updatePerformance( currentBalanceOut, currentBalanceIn, FixedPoint.ONE.divDown(onChainAmountInPerOut), totalSupply ); } } } function _balancesSafeguard( bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 newBalanceIn, uint256 newBalanceOut, uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut, uint256 totalSupply, bytes32 packedPoolParams ) internal view { (uint256 newBalancePerPTIn, uint256 newBalancePerPTOut, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTIn, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTOut) = _getBalancesPerPT(isTokenInToken0, newBalanceIn, newBalanceOut, totalSupply); // we check for performance only if the pool is not being rebalanced by the current swap if (newBalancePerPTOut < hodlBalancePerPTOut || newBalancePerPTIn > hodlBalancePerPTIn) { _srequire( _getPerfFromBalancesPerPT( newBalancePerPTIn, newBalancePerPTOut, hodlBalancePerPTIn, hodlBalancePerPTOut, onChainAmountInPerOut ) >= _getMaxPerfDev(packedPoolParams), SwaapV2Errors.LOW_PERFORMANCE ); } _srequire( newBalancePerPTOut.divDown(hodlBalancePerPTOut) >= _getMaxTargetDev(packedPoolParams), SwaapV2Errors.MIN_BALANCE_OUT_NOT_MET ); } function _onInitializePool( bytes32, // poolId, address sender, address, // recipient, uint256[] memory scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal override returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { if(isAllowlistEnabled()) { userData = _isLPAllowed(sender, userData); } (SafeguardPoolUserData.JoinKind kind, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = userData.initJoin(); _require(kind == SafeguardPoolUserData.JoinKind.INIT, Errors.UNINITIALIZED); _require(amountsIn.length == _NUM_TOKENS, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2); _upscaleArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors); // prevents the pool from being initialized with a low balance (i.e. amountIn = 1 wei) // which will result in an usuable pool at initialization since hodlBalancePerPT will be equal to 0 // and targeDeviation = currentBalancePerPT / hodlBalancePerPT (illegal division by 0) _srequire( amountsIn[0] >= _MIN_INITIAL_BALANCE && amountsIn[1] >= _MIN_INITIAL_BALANCE, SwaapV2Errors.LOW_INITIAL_BALANCE ); // sets initial target balances uint256 initHodlBalancePerPT0 = amountsIn[0].divDown(_INITIAL_BPT); uint256 initHodlBalancePerPT1 = amountsIn[1].divDown(_INITIAL_BPT); _setHodlBalancesPerPT(initHodlBalancePerPT0, initHodlBalancePerPT1); emit InitialTargetBalancesSet(initHodlBalancePerPT0, initHodlBalancePerPT1); return (_INITIAL_BPT, amountsIn); } function _onJoinPool( bytes32, // poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256, // lastChangeBlock, uint256, // protocolSwapFeePercentage, uint256[] memory, // scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal override returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) { _beforeJoinExit(); if(isAllowlistEnabled()) { userData = _isLPAllowed(sender, userData); } SafeguardPoolUserData.JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind(); if(kind == SafeguardPoolUserData.JoinKind.ALL_TOKENS_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT) { return _joinAllTokensInForExactBPTOut(balances, totalSupply(), userData); } else if (kind == SafeguardPoolUserData.JoinKind.EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT) { return _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(sender, recipient, balances, userData); } else { _revert(Errors.UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND); } } function _isLPAllowed(address sender, bytes memory userData) internal returns(bytes memory) { // we subtiture userData by the joinData return _validateAllowlistSignature(sender, userData); } function _joinAllTokensInForExactBPTOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 totalSupply, bytes memory userData ) private pure returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { uint256 bptAmountOut = userData.allTokensInForExactBptOut(); // Note that there is no maximum amountsIn parameter: this is handled by `IVault.joinPool`. uint256[] memory amountsIn = BasePoolMath.computeProportionalAmountsIn(balances, totalSupply, bptAmountOut); return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn); } function _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut( address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData ) internal returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { ( uint256 minBptAmountOut, uint256[] memory joinAmounts, bool isExcessToken0, ValidatedQuoteData memory validatedQuoteData ) = _joinExitSwapSignatureSafeguard(sender, recipient, userData); (uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 limitTokenBalance) = isExcessToken0? (balances[0], balances[1]) : (balances[1], balances[0]); (uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount) = _getQuoteAmountInPerOut(validatedQuoteData.swapData, excessTokenBalance, limitTokenBalance); (uint256 excessTokenAmountIn, uint256 limitTokenAmountIn) = isExcessToken0? (joinAmounts[0], joinAmounts[1]) : (joinAmounts[1], joinAmounts[0]); ( uint256 swapAmountIn, uint256 swapAmountOut ) = SafeguardMath.calcJoinSwapAmounts( excessTokenBalance, limitTokenBalance, excessTokenAmountIn, limitTokenAmountIn, quoteAmountInPerOut ); _validateSwap( validatedQuoteData.digest, IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN, isExcessToken0, excessTokenBalance, limitTokenBalance, swapAmountIn, swapAmountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount ); uint256 rOpt = SafeguardMath.calcJoinSwapROpt(excessTokenBalance, excessTokenAmountIn, swapAmountIn); uint256 bptAmountOut = totalSupply().mulDown(rOpt); _srequire(bptAmountOut >= minBptAmountOut, SwaapV2Errors.NOT_ENOUGH_PT_OUT); return (bptAmountOut, joinAmounts); } function _doRecoveryModeExit( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 totalSupply, bytes memory userData ) internal pure override returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) { bptAmountIn = userData.recoveryModeExit(); amountsOut = BasePoolMath.computeProportionalAmountsOut(balances, totalSupply, bptAmountIn); } function _onExitPool( bytes32, // poolId, address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, uint256, // lastChangeBlock, uint256, // protocolSwapFeePercentage, uint256[] memory, // scalingFactors, bytes memory userData ) internal override returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) { _beforeJoinExit(); (SafeguardPoolUserData.ExitKind kind) = userData.exitKind(); if(kind == SafeguardPoolUserData.ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT) { return _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(balances, totalSupply(), userData); } else if (kind == SafeguardPoolUserData.ExitKind.BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT) { return _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(sender, recipient, balances, userData); } else { _revert(Errors.UNHANDLED_EXIT_KIND); } } function _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut( uint256[] memory balances, uint256 totalSupply, bytes memory userData ) private returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { // updates pool performance if necessary try this.updatePerformance() {} catch {} uint256 bptAmountIn = userData.exactBptInForTokensOut(); // Note that there is no minimum amountOut parameter: this is handled by `IVault.exitPool`. uint256[] memory amountsOut = BasePoolMath.computeProportionalAmountsOut(balances, totalSupply, bptAmountIn); return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut); } function _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut( address sender, address recipient, uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData ) internal returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) { ( uint256 maxBptAmountIn, uint256[] memory exitAmounts, bool isLimitToken0, ValidatedQuoteData memory validatedQuoteData ) = _joinExitSwapSignatureSafeguard(sender, recipient, userData); (uint256 excessTokenBalance, uint256 limitTokenBalance) = isLimitToken0? (balances[1], balances[0]) : (balances[0], balances[1]); (uint256 quoteAmountInPerOut, uint256 maxSwapAmount) = _getQuoteAmountInPerOut(validatedQuoteData.swapData, limitTokenBalance, excessTokenBalance); (uint256 excessTokenAmountOut, uint256 limitTokenAmountOut) = isLimitToken0? (exitAmounts[1], exitAmounts[0]) : (exitAmounts[0], exitAmounts[1]); ( uint256 swapAmountIn, uint256 swapAmountOut ) = SafeguardMath.calcExitSwapAmounts( excessTokenBalance, limitTokenBalance, excessTokenAmountOut, limitTokenAmountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut ); _validateSwap( validatedQuoteData.digest, IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN, isLimitToken0, limitTokenBalance, excessTokenBalance, swapAmountIn, swapAmountOut, quoteAmountInPerOut, maxSwapAmount ); uint256 rOpt = SafeguardMath.calcExitSwapROpt(excessTokenBalance, excessTokenAmountOut, swapAmountOut); uint256 bptAmountOut = totalSupply().mulUp(rOpt); _srequire(bptAmountOut <= maxBptAmountIn, SwaapV2Errors.EXCEEDED_BURNED_PT); return (bptAmountOut, exitAmounts); } /** * Setters */ /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setFlexibleOracleStates( bool isFlexibleOracle0, bool isFlexibleOracle1 ) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; if(_isStable0) { if(!isFlexibleOracle0) { // if the oracle is no longer flexible we need to reset the peg state packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(false, _TOKEN_0_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(isFlexibleOracle0, _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_0_BIT_OFFSET); } if(_isStable1) { if(!isFlexibleOracle1) { // if the oracle is no longer flexible we need to reset the peg state packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(false, _TOKEN_1_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(isFlexibleOracle1, _FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_1_BIT_OFFSET); } _packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams; // we do not use the inputs of the function because they may not me update the state if the token isn't stable emit FlexibleOracleStatesUpdated(_isFlexibleOracle0(packedPoolParams), _isFlexibleOracle1(packedPoolParams)); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setMustAllowlistLPs(bool mustAllowlistLPs) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setMustAllowlistLPs(mustAllowlistLPs); } function _setMustAllowlistLPs(bool mustAllowlistLPs) private { _mustAllowlistLPs = mustAllowlistLPs; emit MustAllowlistLPsSet(mustAllowlistLPs); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setSigner(address signer_) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setSigner(signer_); } function _setSigner(address signer_) internal { _srequire(signer_ != address(0), SwaapV2Errors.SIGNER_CANNOT_BE_NULL_ADDRESS); _signer = signer_; emit SignerChanged(signer_); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setPerfUpdateInterval(uint256 perfUpdateInterval) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setPerfUpdateInterval(perfUpdateInterval); } function _setPerfUpdateInterval(uint256 perfUpdateInterval) internal { _srequire(perfUpdateInterval >= _MIN_PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL, SwaapV2Errors.PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL_TOO_LOW); _srequire(perfUpdateInterval <= _MAX_PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL, SwaapV2Errors.PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_INTERVAL_TOO_HIGH); _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertUint( perfUpdateInterval, _PERF_UPDATE_INTERVAL_BIT_OFFSET, _PERF_TIME_BIT_LENGTH ); emit PerfUpdateIntervalChanged(perfUpdateInterval); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setMaxPerfDev(uint256 maxPerfDev) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setMaxPerfDev(maxPerfDev); } /// @dev for gas optimization purposes we store (1 - max tolerance) function _setMaxPerfDev(uint256 maxPerfDev) internal { // the lower maxPerfDev value is, the less strict the performance check is (more permitted deviation) _srequire(maxPerfDev <= FixedPoint.ONE, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEV_TOO_LOW); _srequire(maxPerfDev >= _MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEVIATION, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_PERFORMANCE_DEV_TOO_HIGH); _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertUint( maxPerfDev, _MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_LENGTH ); emit MaxPerfDevChanged(maxPerfDev); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setMaxTargetDev(uint256 maxTargetDev) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setMaxTargetDev(maxTargetDev); } /// @dev for gas optimization purposes we store (1 - max tolerance) function _setMaxTargetDev(uint256 maxTargetDev) internal { // the lower maxTargetDev value is, the less strict the balances check is (more permitted deviation) _srequire(maxTargetDev <= FixedPoint.ONE, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_TARGET_DEV_TOO_LOW); _srequire(maxTargetDev >= _MAX_TARGET_DEVIATION, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_TARGET_DEV_TOO_LARGE); _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertUint( maxTargetDev, _MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_LENGTH ); emit MaxTargetDevChanged(maxTargetDev); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setMaxPriceDev(uint256 maxPriceDev) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setMaxPriceDev(maxPriceDev); } /// @dev for gas optimization purposes we store (1 - max tolerance) function _setMaxPriceDev(uint256 maxPriceDev) internal { // the lower maxPriceDev value is, the less strict the price check is (more permitted deviation) _srequire(maxPriceDev <= FixedPoint.ONE, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_PRICE_DEV_TOO_LOW); _srequire(maxPriceDev >= _MAX_PRICE_DEVIATION, SwaapV2Errors.MAX_PRICE_DEV_TOO_LARGE); _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertUint( maxPriceDev, _MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_LENGTH ); emit MaxPriceDevChanged(maxPriceDev); } /** * @dev This function assumes that the pool is deployed with a modified version of the vault * that addresses a known reentrancy issue described here: * https://forum.balancer.fi/t/reentrancy-vulnerability-scope-expanded/4345. * The modified version of the vault is available here: * https://github.com/swaap-labs/swaap-v2-monorepo/commit/85e0ef66b460995129f196be42762186b3d3727d * If you're using an old version of the vault, you should add _ensureNotInVaultContext function * https://github.com/balancer/balancer-v2-monorepo/pull/2418/files * */ /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function updatePerformance() external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; (uint256 lastPerfUpdate, uint256 perfUpdateInterval) = _getPerformanceTimeParams(packedPoolParams); _srequire(block.timestamp > lastPerfUpdate + perfUpdateInterval, SwaapV2Errors.PERFORMANCE_UPDATE_TOO_SOON); (, uint256[] memory balances, ) = getVault().getPoolTokens(getPoolId()); _upscaleArray(balances, _scalingFactors()); uint256 amount0Per1 = _getOnChainAmountInPerOut(packedPoolParams, true); _updatePerformance(balances[0], balances[1], amount0Per1, totalSupply()); } function _updatePerformance( uint256 balance0, uint256 balance1, uint256 amount0Per1, uint256 totalSupply ) private { uint256 currentTVLPerPT = (balance0.add(balance1.mulDown(amount0Per1))).divDown(totalSupply); (uint256 hodlBalancePerPT0, uint256 hodlBalancePerPT1) = getHodlBalancesPerPT(); uint256 oldTVLPerPT = hodlBalancePerPT0.add(hodlBalancePerPT1.mulDown(amount0Per1)); uint256 currentPerformance = currentTVLPerPT.divDown(oldTVLPerPT); hodlBalancePerPT0 = hodlBalancePerPT0.mulDown(currentPerformance); hodlBalancePerPT1 = hodlBalancePerPT1.mulDown(currentPerformance); _setHodlBalancesPerPT(hodlBalancePerPT0, hodlBalancePerPT1); emit PerformanceUpdated(hodlBalancePerPT0, hodlBalancePerPT1, currentPerformance, amount0Per1, block.timestamp); } function _setHodlBalancesPerPT(uint256 hodlBalancePerPT0, uint256 hodlBalancePerPT1) private { bytes32 hodlBalancesPerPT = WordCodec.encodeUint( hodlBalancePerPT0, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_0, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_LENGTH ); hodlBalancesPerPT = hodlBalancesPerPT.insertUint( hodlBalancePerPT1, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_1, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_LENGTH ); _hodlBalancesPerPT = hodlBalancesPerPT; _packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams.insertUint( block.timestamp, _PERF_LAST_UPDATE_BIT_OFFSET, _PERF_TIME_BIT_LENGTH ); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function evaluateStablesPegStates() external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused { bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; if(_isStable0 && _isFlexibleOracle0(packedPoolParams)) { bool newPegState = _canBePegged(_isTokenPegged0(packedPoolParams), _oracle0, _maxOracleTimeout0, _priceScaleFactor0); packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(newPegState, _TOKEN_0_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } if(_isStable1 && _isFlexibleOracle1(packedPoolParams)) { bool newPegState = _canBePegged(_isTokenPegged1(packedPoolParams), _oracle1, _maxOracleTimeout1, _priceScaleFactor1); packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams.insertBool(newPegState, _TOKEN_1_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } _packedPoolParams = packedPoolParams; emit PegStatesUpdated(_isTokenPegged0(packedPoolParams), _isTokenPegged1(packedPoolParams)); } /** * Getters */ /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getPoolPerformance() external view override returns(uint256 performance){ (, uint256[] memory balances, ) = getVault().getPoolTokens(getPoolId()); _upscaleArray(balances, _scalingFactors()); uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut = _getOnChainAmountInPerOut(_packedPoolParams, true); performance = _getPerf(true, balances[0], balances[1], onChainAmountInPerOut, totalSupply()); } function _getPerf( bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 newBalanceIn, uint256 newBalanceOut, uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut, uint256 totalSupply ) internal view returns (uint256) { (uint256 newBalancePerPTIn, uint256 newBalancePerPTOut, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTIn, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTOut) = _getBalancesPerPT(isTokenInToken0, newBalanceIn, newBalanceOut, totalSupply); return _getPerfFromBalancesPerPT( newBalancePerPTIn, newBalancePerPTOut, hodlBalancePerPTIn, hodlBalancePerPTOut, onChainAmountInPerOut ); } function _getPerfFromBalancesPerPT( uint256 newBalancePerPTIn, uint256 newBalancePerPTOut, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTIn, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTOut, uint256 onChainAmountInPerOut ) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 newTVLPerPT = (newBalancePerPTIn.divDown(onChainAmountInPerOut)).add(newBalancePerPTOut); uint256 oldTVLPerPT = (hodlBalancePerPTIn.divDown(onChainAmountInPerOut)).add(hodlBalancePerPTOut); return newTVLPerPT.divDown(oldTVLPerPT); } function _getBalancesPerPT( bool isTokenInToken0, uint256 newBalanceIn, uint256 newBalanceOut, uint256 totalSupply ) internal view returns (uint256, uint256, uint256, uint256) { (uint256 hodlBalancePerPT0, uint256 hodlBalancePerPT1) = getHodlBalancesPerPT(); (uint256 hodlBalancePerPTIn, uint256 hodlBalancePerPTOut) = isTokenInToken0? (hodlBalancePerPT0, hodlBalancePerPT1) : (hodlBalancePerPT1, hodlBalancePerPT0); uint256 newBalancePerPTIn = newBalanceIn.divDown(totalSupply); uint256 newBalancePerPTOut = newBalanceOut.divDown(totalSupply); return(newBalancePerPTIn, newBalancePerPTOut, hodlBalancePerPTIn, hodlBalancePerPTOut); } function _isTokenPegged0(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns(bool){ return packedPoolParams.decodeBool(_TOKEN_0_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } function _isTokenPegged1(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns(bool){ return packedPoolParams.decodeBool(_TOKEN_1_PEGGED_BIT_OFFSET); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function isAllowlistEnabled() public view override returns(bool) { return _mustAllowlistLPs; } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getHodlBalancesPerPT() public view override returns(uint256 hodlBalancePerPT0, uint256 hodlBalancePerPT1) { bytes32 hodlBalancesPerPT = _hodlBalancesPerPT; hodlBalancePerPT0 = hodlBalancesPerPT.decodeUint( _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_0, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_LENGTH ); hodlBalancePerPT1 = hodlBalancesPerPT.decodeUint( _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_OFFSET_1, _HODL_BALANCE_BIT_LENGTH ); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getOnChainAmountInPerOut(address tokenIn) external view override returns(uint256) { return _getOnChainAmountInPerOut(_packedPoolParams, IERC20(tokenIn) == _token0); } /** * @notice returns the relative price such as: amountIn = relativePrice * amountOut */ function _getOnChainAmountInPerOut(bytes32 packedPoolParams, bool isTokenInToken0) internal view returns(uint256) { uint256 price0; if(_isStable0 && _isFlexibleOracle0(packedPoolParams) && _isTokenPegged0(packedPoolParams)) { price0 = FixedPoint.ONE; } else { price0 = _getPriceFromOracle(_oracle0, _maxOracleTimeout0, _priceScaleFactor0); } uint256 price1; if(_isStable1 && _isFlexibleOracle1(packedPoolParams) && _isTokenPegged1(packedPoolParams)) { price1 = FixedPoint.ONE; } else { price1 = _getPriceFromOracle(_oracle1, _maxOracleTimeout1, _priceScaleFactor1); } return isTokenInToken0? price1.divDown(price0) : price0.divDown(price1); } function _getPriceFromOracle( AggregatorV3Interface oracle, uint256 maxTimeout, uint256 priceScaleFactor ) internal view returns(uint256){ return _upscale(ChainlinkUtils.getLatestPrice(oracle, maxTimeout), priceScaleFactor); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getPoolParameters() external view override returns ( uint256 maxPerfDev, uint256 maxTargetDev, uint256 maxPriceDev, uint256 lastPerfUpdate, uint256 perfUpdateInterval ) { bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; maxPerfDev = _getMaxPerfDev(packedPoolParams); maxTargetDev = _getMaxTargetDev(packedPoolParams); maxPriceDev = _getMaxPriceDev(packedPoolParams); (lastPerfUpdate, perfUpdateInterval) = _getPerformanceTimeParams(packedPoolParams); } function _isFlexibleOracle0(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns(bool) { return packedPoolParams.decodeBool(_FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_0_BIT_OFFSET); } function _isFlexibleOracle1(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns(bool) { return packedPoolParams.decodeBool(_FLEXIBLE_ORACLE_1_BIT_OFFSET); } function _getMaxPerfDev(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns (uint256 maxPerfDev) { maxPerfDev = packedPoolParams.decodeUint(_MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_PERF_DEV_BIT_LENGTH); } function _getMaxTargetDev(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns (uint256 maxTargetDev) { maxTargetDev = packedPoolParams.decodeUint(_MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_TARGET_DEV_BIT_LENGTH); } function _getMaxPriceDev(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns (uint256 maxPriceDev) { maxPriceDev = packedPoolParams.decodeUint(_MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_OFFSET, _MAX_PRICE_DEV_BIT_LENGTH); } function _getPerformanceTimeParams(bytes32 packedPoolParams) internal pure returns(uint256 lastPerfUpdate, uint256 perfUpdateInterval) { lastPerfUpdate = packedPoolParams.decodeUint(_PERF_LAST_UPDATE_BIT_OFFSET, _PERF_TIME_BIT_LENGTH); perfUpdateInterval = packedPoolParams.decodeUint(_PERF_UPDATE_INTERVAL_BIT_OFFSET, _PERF_TIME_BIT_LENGTH); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getOracleParams() external view override returns(OracleParams[] memory) { OracleParams[] memory oracleParams = new OracleParams[](2); bytes32 packedPoolParams = _packedPoolParams; oracleParams[0] = OracleParams({ oracle: _oracle0, maxTimeout: _maxOracleTimeout0, isStable: _isStable0, isFlexibleOracle: _isFlexibleOracle0(packedPoolParams), isPegged: _isTokenPegged0(packedPoolParams), priceScalingFactor: _priceScaleFactor0 }); oracleParams[1] = OracleParams({ oracle: _oracle1, maxTimeout: _maxOracleTimeout1, isStable: _isStable1, isFlexibleOracle: _isFlexibleOracle1(packedPoolParams), isPegged: _isTokenPegged1(packedPoolParams), priceScalingFactor: _priceScaleFactor1 }); return oracleParams; } function _canBePegged( bool isTokenPegged, AggregatorV3Interface oracle, uint256 maxOracleTimeout, uint256 priceScaleFactor ) internal view returns(bool) { uint256 currentPrice = _getPriceFromOracle(oracle, maxOracleTimeout, priceScaleFactor); (uint256 priceMin, uint256 priceMax) = currentPrice < FixedPoint.ONE? (currentPrice, FixedPoint.ONE) : (FixedPoint.ONE, currentPrice); uint256 relativePriceDifference = (priceMax - priceMin); if(!isTokenPegged && relativePriceDifference <= _REPEG_PRICE_BOUND) { return true; // token should gain back peg } else if (isTokenPegged && relativePriceDifference >= _UNPEG_PRICE_BOUND) { return false; // token should be unpegged } return isTokenPegged; } /// @inheritdoc ISignatureSafeguard function signer() public view override(ISignatureSafeguard, SignatureSafeguard) returns(address){ return _signer; } function _getTotalTokens() internal pure override returns (uint256) { return _NUM_TOKENS; } function _getMaxTokens() internal pure override returns (uint256) { return _NUM_TOKENS; } function _scalingFactors() internal view override returns (uint256[] memory) { uint256[] memory scalingFactors = new uint256[](_NUM_TOKENS); scalingFactors[0] = _scaleFactor0; scalingFactors[1] = _scaleFactor1; return scalingFactors; } function _scalingFactor(IERC20 token) internal view override returns (uint256) { if (token == _token0) { return _scaleFactor0; } return _scaleFactor1; } function _scalingFactorsInAndOut(bool isToken0) internal view returns (uint256, uint256) { if (isToken0) { return (_scaleFactor0, _scaleFactor1); } return (_scaleFactor1, _scaleFactor0); } /** * @dev Safeguard pool does not support on-chain swap fees. They should be included in the pricing * of the signed quotes. The following functions are overriden to reduce contract size and disable * on-chain swap fees. */ // Safeguard pool does not support on-chain swap fees. function _setSwapFeePercentage(uint256) internal pure override { return; } // Safeguard pool does not support on-chain swap fees. function getSwapFeePercentage() public pure override(BasePool, IBasePool) returns (uint256) { return 0; } // Safeguard pool does not support on-chain swap fees. function _getMinSwapFeePercentage() internal override pure returns (uint256) { return 0; } // Safeguard pool does not support on-chain swap fees. function _getMaxSwapFeePercentage() internal override pure returns (uint256) { return 0; } /* * Management fees */ function _onDisableRecoveryMode() internal override { // resets last claim time to the current time in order to prevent claiming fees accrued // when the pool was in recovery mode _previousClaimTime = uint32(block.timestamp); } function _beforeJoinExit() private { _claimManagementFees(); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function claimManagementFees() external override whenNotPaused { _claimManagementFees(); } function _claimManagementFees() internal { uint256 currentTime = block.timestamp; uint256 elapsedTime = currentTime.sub(uint256(_previousClaimTime)); if(elapsedTime > 0) { // update last claim time _previousClaimTime = uint32(currentTime); uint256 yearlyRate = uint256(_yearlyRate); uint256 previousTotalSupply = totalSupply(); if(yearlyRate > 0) { // returns bpt that needs to be minted uint256 protocolFees = SafeguardMath.calcAccumulatedManagementFees( elapsedTime, yearlyRate, previousTotalSupply ); _payProtocolFees(protocolFees); emit ManagementFeesClaimed(protocolFees, previousTotalSupply, yearlyRate, currentTime); } } } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function setManagementFees(uint256 yearlyFees) external override authenticate whenNotPaused { _setManagementFees(yearlyFees); } function _setManagementFees(uint256 yearlyFees) private { // claim previous manag _claimManagementFees(); _setYearlyRate(yearlyFees); } function _setYearlyRate(uint256 yearlyFees) private { _srequire(yearlyFees <= _MAX_YEARLY_FEES, SwaapV2Errors.FEES_TOO_HIGH); _yearlyFees = uint64(yearlyFees); _yearlyRate = uint32(SafeguardMath.calcYearlyRate(yearlyFees)); emit ManagementFeesUpdated(yearlyFees); } /// @inheritdoc ISafeguardPool function getManagementFeesParams() public view override returns(uint256, uint256, uint256) { return (_yearlyFees, _yearlyRate, _previousClaimTime); } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity =0.7.6; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/EOASignaturesValidator.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IVault.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/safeguard-pool/SafeguardPoolUserData.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/safeguard-pool/ISignatureSafeguard.sol"; import "@swaap-labs/v2-errors/contracts/SwaapV2Errors.sol"; /** * @dev Utility for verifying signed quotes and whitelisted lps. This module should only * be used with pools with a fixed two token order that are similar to that in the vault. */ abstract contract SignatureSafeguard is EOASignaturesValidator, ISignatureSafeguard { struct ValidatedQuoteData { bytes swapData; bytes32 digest; } using SafeguardPoolUserData for bytes; // solhint-disable max-line-length bytes32 public constant SWAP_STRUCT_TYPEHASH = keccak256( "SwapStruct(uint8 kind,bool isTokenInToken0,address sender,address recipient,bytes swapData,uint256 quoteIndex,uint256 deadline)" ); // solhint-enable max-line-length bytes32 public constant ALLOWLIST_STRUCT_TYPEHASH = keccak256("AllowlistStruct(address sender,uint256 deadline)"); // NB Do not assign a high value (e.g. max(uint256)) or else it will overflow when adding it to the block.timestamp uint256 private constant _MAX_REMAINING_SIGNATURE_VALIDITY = 5 minutes; mapping(uint256 => uint256) internal _usedQuoteBitMap; /** * @dev The inheriting pool contract must have one and immutable poolId and must * interact with one and immutable vault's address. Otherwise, it is unsafe to rely solely * on the pool's address as a domain seperator assuming that a quote is based on the pool's state. */ function _swapSignatureSafeguard( IVault.SwapKind kind, bool isTokenInToken0, address sender, address recipient, bytes calldata userData ) internal returns (bytes memory, bytes32) { (bytes memory swapData, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline) = userData.decodeSignedSwapData(); bytes32 digest = _validateSwapSignature(kind, isTokenInToken0, sender, recipient, swapData, signature, quoteIndex, deadline); return (swapData, digest); } /** * @dev The inheriting pool contract must have one and immutable poolId and must * interact with one and immutable vault's address. Otherwise, it is unsafe to rely solely * on the pool's address as a domain seperator assuming that a quote is based on the pool's state. */ function _joinExitSwapSignatureSafeguard( address sender, address recipient, bytes memory userData ) internal returns (uint256, uint256[] memory, bool, ValidatedQuoteData memory) { ( bool isTokenInToken0, // excess token in or limit token in bytes memory swapData, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline // swap deadline ) = userData.exactJoinExitSwapData(); bytes32 digest = _validateSwapSignature( IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN, isTokenInToken0, sender, recipient, swapData, signature, quoteIndex, deadline ); (uint256 limitBptAmountOut, uint256[] memory joinExitAmounts) = userData.exactJoinExitAmountsData(); return (limitBptAmountOut, joinExitAmounts, isTokenInToken0, ValidatedQuoteData(swapData, digest)); } function _validateSwapSignature( IVault.SwapKind kind, bool isTokenInToken0, address sender, address recipient, bytes memory swapData, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline ) internal returns (bytes32) { // For a two token pool,we can only include the tokenIn in the signature. For pools that has more than // two tokens the tokenOut must be specified to ensure the correctness of the trade. bytes32 structHash = keccak256( abi.encode( SWAP_STRUCT_TYPEHASH, kind, isTokenInToken0, sender, recipient,keccak256(swapData), quoteIndex, deadline ) ); bytes32 digest = _ensureValidBitmapSignature( structHash, signature, quoteIndex, deadline ); return digest; } function _ensureValidBitmapSignature( bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 quoteIndex, uint256 deadline ) internal returns (bytes32) { bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); _srequire(_isValidSignature(signer(), digest, signature), SwaapV2Errors.BITMAP_SIGNATURE_NOT_VALID); // We could check for the deadline & quote index before validating the signature, but this leads to saner // error processing (as we only care about expired deadlines & quote if the signature is correct) and only // affects the gas cost of the revert scenario, which will only occur infrequently, if ever. // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(deadline >= block.timestamp, Errors.EXPIRED_SIGNATURE); _srequire(!_isQuoteUsed(quoteIndex), SwaapV2Errors.QUOTE_ALREADY_USED); _registerUsedQuote(quoteIndex); return digest; } function _isQuoteUsed(uint256 index) internal view returns (bool) { uint256 usedQuoteWordIndex = index / 256; uint256 usedQuoteBitIndex = index % 256; uint256 usedQuoteWord = _usedQuoteBitMap[usedQuoteWordIndex]; uint256 mask = (1 << usedQuoteBitIndex); return usedQuoteWord & mask == mask; } function _registerUsedQuote(uint256 index) private { uint256 usedQuoteWordIndex = index / 256; uint256 usedQuoteBitIndex = index % 256; _usedQuoteBitMap[usedQuoteWordIndex] = _usedQuoteBitMap[usedQuoteWordIndex] | (1 << usedQuoteBitIndex); } function _validateAllowlistSignature(address sender, bytes memory userData) internal returns (bytes memory) { (uint256 deadline, bytes memory signature, bytes memory joinData) = userData.allowlistData(); bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(ALLOWLIST_STRUCT_TYPEHASH, sender, deadline)); bytes32 digest = _ensureValidReplayableSignature( structHash, signature, deadline ); emit AllowlistJoinSignatureValidated(digest); return joinData; } function _ensureValidReplayableSignature( bytes32 structHash, bytes memory signature, uint256 deadline ) internal view returns (bytes32) { bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash); _srequire(_isValidSignature(signer(), digest, signature), SwaapV2Errors.REPLAYABLE_SIGNATURE_NOT_VALID); // We could check for the deadline before validating the signature, but this leads to saner error processing (as // we only care about expired deadlines if the signature is correct) and only affects the gas cost of the revert // scenario, which will only occur infrequently, if ever. // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy. // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time _require(deadline >= block.timestamp, Errors.EXPIRED_SIGNATURE); _require(deadline <= block.timestamp + _MAX_REMAINING_SIGNATURE_VALIDITY, Errors.EXPIRED_SIGNATURE); return digest; } /// @inheritdoc ISignatureSafeguard function getQuoteBitmapWord(uint256 wordIndex) external view override returns(uint){ return _usedQuoteBitMap[wordIndex]; } /// @inheritdoc ISignatureSafeguard function signer() public view override virtual returns (address); }
File 3 of 8: FiatTokenProxy
pragma solidity ^0.4.24; // File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/Proxy.sol /** * @title Proxy * @dev Implements delegation of calls to other contracts, with proper * forwarding of return values and bubbling of failures. * It defines a fallback function that delegates all calls to the address * returned by the abstract _implementation() internal function. */ contract Proxy { /** * @dev Fallback function. * Implemented entirely in `_fallback`. */ function () payable external { _fallback(); } /** * @return The Address of the implementation. */ function _implementation() internal view returns (address); /** * @dev Delegates execution to an implementation contract. * This is a low level function that doesn't return to its internal call site. * It will return to the external caller whatever the implementation returns. * @param implementation Address to delegate. */ function _delegate(address implementation) internal { assembly { // Copy msg.data. We take full control of memory in this inline assembly // block because it will not return to Solidity code. We overwrite the // Solidity scratch pad at memory position 0. calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize) // Call the implementation. // out and outsize are 0 because we don't know the size yet. let result := delegatecall(gas, implementation, 0, calldatasize, 0, 0) // Copy the returned data. returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize) switch result // delegatecall returns 0 on error. case 0 { revert(0, returndatasize) } default { return(0, returndatasize) } } } /** * @dev Function that is run as the first thing in the fallback function. * Can be redefined in derived contracts to add functionality. * Redefinitions must call super._willFallback(). */ function _willFallback() internal { } /** * @dev fallback implementation. * Extracted to enable manual triggering. */ function _fallback() internal { _willFallback(); _delegate(_implementation()); } } // File: openzeppelin-solidity/contracts/AddressUtils.sol /** * Utility library of inline functions on addresses */ library AddressUtils { /** * Returns whether the target address is a contract * @dev This function will return false if invoked during the constructor of a contract, * as the code is not actually created until after the constructor finishes. * @param addr address to check * @return whether the target address is a contract */ function isContract(address addr) internal view returns (bool) { uint256 size; // XXX Currently there is no better way to check if there is a contract in an address // than to check the size of the code at that address. // See https://ethereum.stackexchange.com/a/14016/36603 // for more details about how this works. // TODO Check this again before the Serenity release, because all addresses will be // contracts then. // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(addr) } return size > 0; } } // File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/UpgradeabilityProxy.sol /** * @title UpgradeabilityProxy * @dev This contract implements a proxy that allows to change the * implementation address to which it will delegate. * Such a change is called an implementation upgrade. */ contract UpgradeabilityProxy is Proxy { /** * @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded. * @param implementation Address of the new implementation. */ event Upgraded(address implementation); /** * @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation. * This is the keccak-256 hash of "org.zeppelinos.proxy.implementation", and is * validated in the constructor. */ bytes32 private constant IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x7050c9e0f4ca769c69bd3a8ef740bc37934f8e2c036e5a723fd8ee048ed3f8c3; /** * @dev Contract constructor. * @param _implementation Address of the initial implementation. */ constructor(address _implementation) public { assert(IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT == keccak256("org.zeppelinos.proxy.implementation")); _setImplementation(_implementation); } /** * @dev Returns the current implementation. * @return Address of the current implementation */ function _implementation() internal view returns (address impl) { bytes32 slot = IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT; assembly { impl := sload(slot) } } /** * @dev Upgrades the proxy to a new implementation. * @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation. */ function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal { _setImplementation(newImplementation); emit Upgraded(newImplementation); } /** * @dev Sets the implementation address of the proxy. * @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation. */ function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private { require(AddressUtils.isContract(newImplementation), "Cannot set a proxy implementation to a non-contract address"); bytes32 slot = IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT; assembly { sstore(slot, newImplementation) } } } // File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/AdminUpgradeabilityProxy.sol /** * @title AdminUpgradeabilityProxy * @dev This contract combines an upgradeability proxy with an authorization * mechanism for administrative tasks. * All external functions in this contract must be guarded by the * `ifAdmin` modifier. See ethereum/solidity#3864 for a Solidity * feature proposal that would enable this to be done automatically. */ contract AdminUpgradeabilityProxy is UpgradeabilityProxy { /** * @dev Emitted when the administration has been transferred. * @param previousAdmin Address of the previous admin. * @param newAdmin Address of the new admin. */ event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin); /** * @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract. * This is the keccak-256 hash of "org.zeppelinos.proxy.admin", and is * validated in the constructor. */ bytes32 private constant ADMIN_SLOT = 0x10d6a54a4754c8869d6886b5f5d7fbfa5b4522237ea5c60d11bc4e7a1ff9390b; /** * @dev Modifier to check whether the `msg.sender` is the admin. * If it is, it will run the function. Otherwise, it will delegate the call * to the implementation. */ modifier ifAdmin() { if (msg.sender == _admin()) { _; } else { _fallback(); } } /** * Contract constructor. * It sets the `msg.sender` as the proxy administrator. * @param _implementation address of the initial implementation. */ constructor(address _implementation) UpgradeabilityProxy(_implementation) public { assert(ADMIN_SLOT == keccak256("org.zeppelinos.proxy.admin")); _setAdmin(msg.sender); } /** * @return The address of the proxy admin. */ function admin() external view ifAdmin returns (address) { return _admin(); } /** * @return The address of the implementation. */ function implementation() external view ifAdmin returns (address) { return _implementation(); } /** * @dev Changes the admin of the proxy. * Only the current admin can call this function. * @param newAdmin Address to transfer proxy administration to. */ function changeAdmin(address newAdmin) external ifAdmin { require(newAdmin != address(0), "Cannot change the admin of a proxy to the zero address"); emit AdminChanged(_admin(), newAdmin); _setAdmin(newAdmin); } /** * @dev Upgrade the backing implementation of the proxy. * Only the admin can call this function. * @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation. */ function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external ifAdmin { _upgradeTo(newImplementation); } /** * @dev Upgrade the backing implementation of the proxy and call a function * on the new implementation. * This is useful to initialize the proxied contract. * @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation. * @param data Data to send as msg.data in the low level call. * It should include the signature and the parameters of the function to be * called, as described in * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/develop/abi-spec.html#function-selector-and-argument-encoding. */ function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes data) payable external ifAdmin { _upgradeTo(newImplementation); require(address(this).call.value(msg.value)(data)); } /** * @return The admin slot. */ function _admin() internal view returns (address adm) { bytes32 slot = ADMIN_SLOT; assembly { adm := sload(slot) } } /** * @dev Sets the address of the proxy admin. * @param newAdmin Address of the new proxy admin. */ function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) internal { bytes32 slot = ADMIN_SLOT; assembly { sstore(slot, newAdmin) } } /** * @dev Only fall back when the sender is not the admin. */ function _willFallback() internal { require(msg.sender != _admin(), "Cannot call fallback function from the proxy admin"); super._willFallback(); } } // File: contracts/FiatTokenProxy.sol /** * Copyright CENTRE SECZ 2018 * * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy * of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal * in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights * to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell * copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to * do so, subject to the following conditions: * * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all * copies or substantial portions of the Software. * * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE * AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, * WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN * CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. */ pragma solidity ^0.4.24; /** * @title FiatTokenProxy * @dev This contract proxies FiatToken calls and enables FiatToken upgrades */ contract FiatTokenProxy is AdminUpgradeabilityProxy { constructor(address _implementation) public AdminUpgradeabilityProxy(_implementation) { } }
File 4 of 8: WETH9
// Copyright (C) 2015, 2016, 2017 Dapphub // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.4.18; contract WETH9 { string public name = "Wrapped Ether"; string public symbol = "WETH"; uint8 public decimals = 18; event Approval(address indexed src, address indexed guy, uint wad); event Transfer(address indexed src, address indexed dst, uint wad); event Deposit(address indexed dst, uint wad); event Withdrawal(address indexed src, uint wad); mapping (address => uint) public balanceOf; mapping (address => mapping (address => uint)) public allowance; function() public payable { deposit(); } function deposit() public payable { balanceOf[msg.sender] += msg.value; Deposit(msg.sender, msg.value); } function withdraw(uint wad) public { require(balanceOf[msg.sender] >= wad); balanceOf[msg.sender] -= wad; msg.sender.transfer(wad); Withdrawal(msg.sender, wad); } function totalSupply() public view returns (uint) { return this.balance; } function approve(address guy, uint wad) public returns (bool) { allowance[msg.sender][guy] = wad; Approval(msg.sender, guy, wad); return true; } function transfer(address dst, uint wad) public returns (bool) { return transferFrom(msg.sender, dst, wad); } function transferFrom(address src, address dst, uint wad) public returns (bool) { require(balanceOf[src] >= wad); if (src != msg.sender && allowance[src][msg.sender] != uint(-1)) { require(allowance[src][msg.sender] >= wad); allowance[src][msg.sender] -= wad; } balanceOf[src] -= wad; balanceOf[dst] += wad; Transfer(src, dst, wad); return true; } } /* GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 3, 29 June 2007 Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/> Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. Preamble The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other kinds of works. The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your programs, too. When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs, and that you know you can do these things. To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others. For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: (1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it. For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to authors of previous versions. Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users. Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that patents cannot be used to render the program non-free. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. TERMS AND CONDITIONS 0. Definitions. "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License. "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of works, such as semiconductor masks. "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and "recipients" may be individuals or organizations. To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work. A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based on the Program. To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying, distribution (with or without modification), making available to the public, and in some countries other activities as well. To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying. An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices" to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion. 1. Source Code. The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source form of a work. A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that is widely used among developers working in that language. The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an implementation is available to the public in source code form. A "Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component (kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it. The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not include the work's System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source includes interface definition files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms and other parts of the work. The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding Source. The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work. 2. Basic Permissions. All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law. You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you. Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary. 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law. No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such measures. When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of technological measures. 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies. You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this License and any non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License along with the Program. You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee. 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions. You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a relevant date. b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this License and any conditions added under section 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to "keep intact all notices". c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have separately received it. d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so. A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate. 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms. You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, in one of these ways: a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange. b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge. c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord with subsection 6b. d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements. e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d. A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the object code work. A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent the only significant mode of use of the product. "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods, procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because modification has been made. If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has been installed in ROM). The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and protocols for communication across the network. Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an implementation available to the public in source code form), and must require no special password or key for unpacking, reading or copying. 7. Additional Terms. "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard to the additional permissions. When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission. Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms: a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing it; or c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the original version; or d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the material; or e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on those licensors and authors. All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a further restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying. If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating where to find the applicable terms. Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either way. 8. Termination. You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third paragraph of section 11). However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same material under section 10. 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies. You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so. 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients. Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts. You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it. 11. Patents. A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version". A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License. Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version. In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a patent against the party. If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that you have reason to believe are valid. If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it. A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in connection with specific products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007. Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law. 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom. If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program. 13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License. Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such. 14. Revised Versions of this License. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program. Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a later version. 15. Disclaimer of Warranty. THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. 16. Limitation of Liability. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16. If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the Program in return for a fee. END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: <program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author> This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box". You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary. For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this License. But first, please read <http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>. */
File 5 of 8: ProtocolFeesCollector
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // solhint-disable /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode); } /** * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are * supported. */ function _require( bool condition, uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix ) pure { if (!condition) _revert(errorCode, prefix); } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. * Uses the default 'BAL' prefix for the error code */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure { _revert(errorCode, 0x42414c); // This is the raw byte representation of "BAL" } /** * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported. */ function _revert(uint256 errorCode, bytes3 prefix) pure { uint256 prefixUint = uint256(uint24(prefix)); // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format: // 'BAL#{errorCode}' // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999). // // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters. // // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents. assembly { // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999 // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for // the '0' character. let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) errorCode := div(errorCode, 10) let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30) // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. // We first append the '#' character (0x23) to the prefix. In the case of 'BAL', it results in 0x42414c23 ('BAL#') // Then, we shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8. // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte // array). let formattedPrefix := shl(24, add(0x23, shl(8, prefixUint))) let revertReason := shl(200, add(formattedPrefix, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds)))) // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded // message will have the following layout: // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ] // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten. mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away). mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020) // The string length is fixed: 7 characters. mstore(0x24, 7) // Finally, the string itself is stored. mstore(0x44, revertReason) // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100. revert(0, 100) } } library Errors { // Math uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0; uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1; uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2; uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3; uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4; uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5; uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6; uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7; uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8; uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9; // Input uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101; uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102; uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103; uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_DATA = 105; // Shared pools uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200; uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201; uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202; uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203; uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206; uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207; uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209; uint256 internal constant NOT_TWO_TOKENS = 210; uint256 internal constant DISABLED = 211; // Pools uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300; uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301; uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302; uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303; uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305; uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306; uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307; uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308; uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310; uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_SECONDS_QUERY = 312; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_NOT_INITIALIZED = 313; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_QUERY_TOO_OLD = 314; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_INVALID_INDEX = 315; uint256 internal constant ORACLE_BAD_SECS = 316; uint256 internal constant AMP_END_TIME_TOO_CLOSE = 317; uint256 internal constant AMP_ONGOING_UPDATE = 318; uint256 internal constant AMP_RATE_TOO_HIGH = 319; uint256 internal constant AMP_NO_ONGOING_UPDATE = 320; uint256 internal constant STABLE_INVARIANT_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 321; uint256 internal constant STABLE_GET_BALANCE_DIDNT_CONVERGE = 322; uint256 internal constant RELAYER_NOT_CONTRACT = 323; uint256 internal constant BASE_POOL_RELAYER_NOT_CALLED = 324; uint256 internal constant REBALANCING_RELAYER_REENTERED = 325; uint256 internal constant GRADUAL_UPDATE_TIME_TRAVEL = 326; uint256 internal constant SWAPS_DISABLED = 327; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_LBP_OWNER = 328; uint256 internal constant PRICE_RATE_OVERFLOW = 329; uint256 internal constant INVALID_JOIN_EXIT_KIND_WHILE_SWAPS_DISABLED = 330; uint256 internal constant WEIGHT_CHANGE_TOO_FAST = 331; uint256 internal constant LOWER_GREATER_THAN_UPPER_TARGET = 332; uint256 internal constant UPPER_TARGET_TOO_HIGH = 333; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_LINEAR_POOL = 334; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_TARGET_RANGE = 335; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_EXIT_KIND = 336; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_EXIT = 337; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 338; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_MANAGED_POOL = 339; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_BY_PHANTOM_POOL = 340; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_DOES_NOT_HAVE_RATE_PROVIDER = 341; uint256 internal constant INVALID_INITIALIZATION = 342; uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_NEW_TARGET_RANGE = 343; uint256 internal constant FEATURE_DISABLED = 344; uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED_POOL_CONTROLLER = 345; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_DURING_FEE_CHANGE = 346; uint256 internal constant SET_SWAP_FEE_PENDING_FEE_CHANGE = 347; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_DURING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 348; uint256 internal constant CHANGE_TOKENS_PENDING_WEIGHT_CHANGE = 349; uint256 internal constant MAX_WEIGHT = 350; uint256 internal constant UNAUTHORIZED_JOIN = 351; uint256 internal constant MAX_MANAGEMENT_AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 352; uint256 internal constant FRACTIONAL_TARGET = 353; uint256 internal constant ADD_OR_REMOVE_BPT = 354; uint256 internal constant INVALID_CIRCUIT_BREAKER_BOUNDS = 355; uint256 internal constant CIRCUIT_BREAKER_TRIPPED = 356; uint256 internal constant MALICIOUS_QUERY_REVERT = 357; uint256 internal constant JOINS_EXITS_DISABLED = 358; // Lib uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401; uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402; uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403; uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404; uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409; uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412; uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414; uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415; uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417; uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421; uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422; uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423; uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424; uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425; uint256 internal constant CALLER_IS_NOT_OWNER = 426; uint256 internal constant NEW_OWNER_IS_ZERO = 427; uint256 internal constant CODE_DEPLOYMENT_FAILED = 428; uint256 internal constant CALL_TO_NON_CONTRACT = 429; uint256 internal constant LOW_LEVEL_CALL_FAILED = 430; uint256 internal constant NOT_PAUSED = 431; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_ALREADY_ALLOWLISTED = 432; uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_NOT_ALLOWLISTED = 433; uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 434; uint256 internal constant INVALID_OPERATION = 435; uint256 internal constant CODEC_OVERFLOW = 436; uint256 internal constant IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 437; uint256 internal constant NOT_IN_RECOVERY_MODE = 438; uint256 internal constant INDUCED_FAILURE = 439; uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_SIGNATURE = 440; uint256 internal constant MALFORMED_SIGNATURE = 441; uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_UINT64 = 442; uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_FEE_TYPE = 443; uint256 internal constant BURN_FROM_ZERO = 444; // Vault uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500; uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501; uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502; uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503; uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504; uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505; uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506; uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507; uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509; uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510; uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511; uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513; uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514; uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516; uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517; uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518; uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521; uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523; uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524; uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525; uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526; uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528; // Fees uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600; uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601; uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602; uint256 internal constant AUM_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 603; // FeeSplitter uint256 internal constant SPLITTER_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 700; // Misc uint256 internal constant UNIMPLEMENTED = 998; uint256 internal constant SHOULD_NOT_HAPPEN = 999; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthentication { /** * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`. */ function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions. */ interface ISignaturesValidator { /** * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator. */ function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages. */ function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper. */ interface ITemporarilyPausable { /** * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`. */ event PausedStateChanged(bool paused); /** * @dev Returns the current paused state. */ function getPausedState() external view returns ( bool paused, uint256 pauseWindowEndTime, uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @dev Interface for WETH9. * See https://github.com/gnosis/canonical-weth/blob/0dd1ea3e295eef916d0c6223ec63141137d22d67/contracts/WETH9.sol */ interface IWETH is IERC20 { function deposit() external payable; function withdraw(uint256 amount) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom( address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount ) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like * types. * * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers. */ interface IAsset { // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; interface IAuthorizer { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`. */ function canPerform( bytes32 actionId, address account, address where ) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; // Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver. import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; interface IFlashLoanRecipient { /** * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient. * * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert. * * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call. */ function receiveFlashLoan( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory feeAmounts, bytes memory userData ) external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "./IVault.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; interface IProtocolFeesCollector { event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage); event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage); function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external; function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external; function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external; function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256); function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts); function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); function vault() external view returns (IVault); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "../solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol"; import "../solidity-utils/misc/IWETH.sol"; import "./IAsset.sol"; import "./IAuthorizer.sol"; import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol"; import "./IProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; pragma solidity >=0.7.0 <0.9.0; /** * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that * don't override one of these declarations. */ interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable, IAuthentication { // Generalities about the Vault: // // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful. // // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g. // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results. // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered. // // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools. // Authorizer // // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller // can perform a given action. /** * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer. */ function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer); /** * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this. * * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event. */ function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`. */ event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer); // Relayers // // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions, // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield // this power, two things must occur: // - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This // means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended // functions. // - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf. // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user. /** * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them. */ function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool); /** * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise. * * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event. */ function setRelayerApproval( address sender, address relayer, bool approved ) external; /** * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`. */ event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved); // Internal Balance // // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users. // // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once. /** * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens. */ function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory); /** * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer) * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance. * * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. */ function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable; /** * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping. */ struct UserBalanceOp { UserBalanceOpKind kind; IAsset asset; uint256 amount; address sender; address payable recipient; } // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`: // // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is // relevant for relayers). // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`. // // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send // it to the recipient as ETH. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. // // // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance. // // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed. // // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event. enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL } /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance. * * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH * address. */ event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta); /** * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account. */ event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount); // Pools // // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced // functionality: // // - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads), // which increase with the number of registered tokens. // // - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are // independent of the number of registered tokens. // // - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool. enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN } /** * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be * changed. * * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`, * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract. * * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words, * multiple Pools may share the same contract. * * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event. */ function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32); /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`. */ event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting. */ function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization); /** * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens, * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens. * * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in * ascending order. * * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`, * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an * Asset Manager should not be made lightly. * * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a * different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event. */ function registerTokens( bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers ) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`. */ event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers); /** * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract. * * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call. * * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager. * * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event. */ function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external; /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`. */ event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens); /** * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token. * * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token` * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`. * * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`, * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1. * * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`. * * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager. */ function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) external view returns ( uint256 cash, uint256 managed, uint256 lastChangeBlock, address assetManager ); /** * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of * the tokens' `balances` changed. * * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order. * * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same * order as passed to `registerTokens`. * * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo` * instead. */ function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns ( IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock ); /** * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized * Pool shares. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces * these maximums. * * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers). * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function joinPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address recipient, JoinPoolRequest memory request ) external payable; struct JoinPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] maxAmountsIn; bytes userData; bool fromInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see * `getPoolTokenInfo`). * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: * it just enforces these minimums. * * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit. * * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise, * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to * do so will trigger a revert. * * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens. * * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and * passed directly to the Pool's contract. * * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event. */ function exitPool( bytes32 poolId, address sender, address payable recipient, ExitPoolRequest memory request ) external; struct ExitPoolRequest { IAsset[] assets; uint256[] minAmountsOut; bytes userData; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively. */ event PoolBalanceChanged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed liquidityProvider, IERC20[] tokens, int256[] deltas, uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts ); enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT } // Swaps // // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this, // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote. // // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence. // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'), // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out'). // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together // individual swaps. // // There are two swap kinds: // - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient). // - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender). // // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at // the final intended token. // // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost // much less gas than they would otherwise. // // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only // updating the Pool's internal accounting). // // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified. // // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly). // // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers). // // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens. enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT } /** * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool. * * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`. * * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`. * * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. * * Emits a `Swap` event. */ function swap( SingleSwap memory singleSwap, FundManagement memory funds, uint256 limit, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (uint256); /** * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on * the `kind` value. * * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct SingleSwap { bytes32 poolId; SwapKind kind; IAsset assetIn; IAsset assetOut; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value. * * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at * the same index in the `assets` array. * * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind. * * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`. * * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses, * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault. * * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer. * * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the * equivalent `swap` call. * * Emits `Swap` events. */ function batchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds, int256[] memory limits, uint256 deadline ) external payable returns (int256[] memory); /** * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH. * * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind. * * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be * used to extend swap behavior. */ struct BatchSwapStep { bytes32 poolId; uint256 assetInIndex; uint256 assetOutIndex; uint256 amount; bytes userData; } /** * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`. */ event Swap( bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20 indexed tokenIn, IERC20 indexed tokenOut, uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut ); /** * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the * `recipient` account. * * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them. * * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20 * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender` * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of * `joinPool`. * * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`. * * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a * revert. */ struct FundManagement { address sender; bool fromInternalBalance; address payable recipient; bool toInternalBalance; } /** * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result. * * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH) * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive. * * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct. * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens, * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address. * * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction. */ function queryBatchSwap( SwapKind kind, BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps, IAsset[] memory assets, FundManagement memory funds ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas); // Flash Loans /** * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it, * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned. * * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order. * * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the * `receiveFlashLoan` call. * * Emits `FlashLoan` events. */ function flashLoan( IFlashLoanRecipient recipient, IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory amounts, bytes memory userData ) external; /** * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`. */ event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount); // Asset Management // // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings. // // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit, // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols. // // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface. /** * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates. * * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once. * * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`. */ function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external; struct PoolBalanceOp { PoolBalanceOpKind kind; bytes32 poolId; IERC20 token; uint256 amount; } /** * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged. * * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total. * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss). */ enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE } /** * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`. */ event PoolBalanceManaged( bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed assetManager, IERC20 indexed token, int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta ); // Protocol Fees // // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by // permissioned accounts. // // There are two kinds of protocol fees: // // - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent. // // - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather, // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share. /** * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module. */ function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (IProtocolFeesCollector); /** * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an * error in some part of the system. * * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled. * * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled: * - depositing and transferring internal balance * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance) * - swaps * - joining Pools * - Asset Manager interactions * * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited. */ function setPaused(bool paused) external; /** * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance. */ function WETH() external view returns (IWETH); // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/IAuthentication.sol"; /** * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions. * * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts. * * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic. */ abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication { bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator; /** * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in * multi contract systems. * * There are two main uses for it: * - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers * unique. The contract's own address is a good option. * - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier * shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead. */ constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) { _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions. */ modifier authenticate() { _authenticateCaller(); _; } /** * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function. */ function _authenticateCaller() internal view { bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig); _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED); } function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) { // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of // multiple contracts. return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector)); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; library InputHelpers { function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure { _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureInputLengthMatch( uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 c ) internal pure { _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure { address[] memory addressArray; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { addressArray := array } ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray); } function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure { if (array.length < 2) { return; } address previous = array[0]; for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) { address current = array[i]; _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY); previous = current; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size. // Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using // private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs, but reduced bytecode size. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; /** * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function. * * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested * (reentrant) calls to them. * * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry * points to them. * * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways * to protect against it, check out our blog post * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul]. */ abstract contract ReentrancyGuard { // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled. // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive, // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect. uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1; uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2; uint256 private _status; constructor() { _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } /** * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly. * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant` * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a * `private` function that does the actual work. */ modifier nonReentrant() { _enterNonReentrant(); _; _exitNonReentrant(); } function _enterNonReentrant() private { // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY); // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail _status = _ENTERED; } function _exitNonReentrant() private { // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200) _status = _NOT_ENTERED; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT // Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin Contracts, altered to reduce gas costs. // The `safeTransfer` and `safeTransferFrom` functions assume that `token` is a contract (an account with code), and // work differently from the OpenZeppelin version if it is not. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/solidity-utils/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol"; /** * @title SafeERC20 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be * successful. * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract, * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc. */ library SafeERC20 { function safeApprove( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { // Some contracts need their allowance reduced to 0 before setting it to an arbitrary amount. if (value != 0 && token.allowance(address(this), address(to)) != 0) { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, 0)); } _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransfer( IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransferFrom( IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal { _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)); } /** * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false). * * WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert. */ function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private { // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since // we're implementing it ourselves. // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data); // If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it. // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { if eq(success, 0) { returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) revert(0, returndatasize()) } } // Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs _require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later // This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by // the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or // (at your option) any later version. // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the // GNU General Public License for more details. // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License // along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. pragma solidity ^0.7.0; pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2; import "@balancer-labs/v2-interfaces/contracts/vault/IProtocolFeesCollector.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/InputHelpers.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/helpers/Authentication.sol"; import "@balancer-labs/v2-solidity-utils/contracts/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol"; /** * @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the * Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size. * * The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are * sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated * to the Vault's own authorizer. */ contract ProtocolFeesCollector is IProtocolFeesCollector, Authentication, ReentrancyGuard { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; // Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%). uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50% uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1% IVault public immutable override vault; // All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers. // The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not // actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due // when users join and exit them. uint256 private _swapFeePercentage; // The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent. uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage; constructor(IVault _vault) // The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action // identifiers. Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this)))) { vault = _vault; } function withdrawCollectedFees( IERC20[] calldata tokens, uint256[] calldata amounts, address recipient ) external override nonReentrant authenticate { InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { IERC20 token = tokens[i]; uint256 amount = amounts[i]; token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount); } } function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external override authenticate { _require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH); _swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage; emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage); } function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external override authenticate { _require( newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH ); _flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage; emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage); } function getSwapFeePercentage() external view override returns (uint256) { return _swapFeePercentage; } function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view override returns (uint256) { return _flashLoanFeePercentage; } function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view override returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) { feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length); for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) { feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this)); } } function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) { return _getAuthorizer(); } function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) { return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this)); } function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) { return vault.getAuthorizer(); } }
File 6 of 8: EACAggregatorProxy
pragma solidity 0.6.6; /** * @title The Owned contract * @notice A contract with helpers for basic contract ownership. */ contract Owned { address payable public owner; address private pendingOwner; event OwnershipTransferRequested( address indexed from, address indexed to ); event OwnershipTransferred( address indexed from, address indexed to ); constructor() public { owner = msg.sender; } /** * @dev Allows an owner to begin transferring ownership to a new address, * pending. */ function transferOwnership(address _to) external onlyOwner() { pendingOwner = _to; emit OwnershipTransferRequested(owner, _to); } /** * @dev Allows an ownership transfer to be completed by the recipient. */ function acceptOwnership() external { require(msg.sender == pendingOwner, "Must be proposed owner"); address oldOwner = owner; owner = msg.sender; pendingOwner = address(0); emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, msg.sender); } /** * @dev Reverts if called by anyone other than the contract owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { require(msg.sender == owner, "Only callable by owner"); _; } } interface AggregatorInterface { function latestAnswer() external view returns (int256); function latestTimestamp() external view returns (uint256); function latestRound() external view returns (uint256); function getAnswer(uint256 roundId) external view returns (int256); function getTimestamp(uint256 roundId) external view returns (uint256); event AnswerUpdated(int256 indexed current, uint256 indexed roundId, uint256 updatedAt); event NewRound(uint256 indexed roundId, address indexed startedBy, uint256 startedAt); } interface AggregatorV3Interface { function decimals() external view returns (uint8); function description() external view returns (string memory); function version() external view returns (uint256); // getRoundData and latestRoundData should both raise "No data present" // if they do not have data to report, instead of returning unset values // which could be misinterpreted as actual reported values. function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); function latestRoundData() external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); } interface AggregatorV2V3Interface is AggregatorInterface, AggregatorV3Interface { } /** * @title A trusted proxy for updating where current answers are read from * @notice This contract provides a consistent address for the * CurrentAnwerInterface but delegates where it reads from to the owner, who is * trusted to update it. */ contract AggregatorProxy is AggregatorV2V3Interface, Owned { struct Phase { uint16 id; AggregatorV2V3Interface aggregator; } Phase private currentPhase; AggregatorV2V3Interface public proposedAggregator; mapping(uint16 => AggregatorV2V3Interface) public phaseAggregators; uint256 constant private PHASE_OFFSET = 64; uint256 constant private PHASE_SIZE = 16; uint256 constant private MAX_ID = 2**(PHASE_OFFSET+PHASE_SIZE) - 1; constructor(address _aggregator) public Owned() { setAggregator(_aggregator); } /** * @notice Reads the current answer from aggregator delegated to. * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestAnswer() public view virtual override returns (int256 answer) { return currentPhase.aggregator.latestAnswer(); } /** * @notice Reads the last updated height from aggregator delegated to. * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestTimestamp() public view virtual override returns (uint256 updatedAt) { return currentPhase.aggregator.latestTimestamp(); } /** * @notice get past rounds answers * @param _roundId the answer number to retrieve the answer for * * @dev #[deprecated] Use getRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended getRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function getAnswer(uint256 _roundId) public view virtual override returns (int256 answer) { if (_roundId > MAX_ID) return 0; (uint16 phaseId, uint64 aggregatorRoundId) = parseIds(_roundId); AggregatorV2V3Interface aggregator = phaseAggregators[phaseId]; if (address(aggregator) == address(0)) return 0; return aggregator.getAnswer(aggregatorRoundId); } /** * @notice get block timestamp when an answer was last updated * @param _roundId the answer number to retrieve the updated timestamp for * * @dev #[deprecated] Use getRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended getRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function getTimestamp(uint256 _roundId) public view virtual override returns (uint256 updatedAt) { if (_roundId > MAX_ID) return 0; (uint16 phaseId, uint64 aggregatorRoundId) = parseIds(_roundId); AggregatorV2V3Interface aggregator = phaseAggregators[phaseId]; if (address(aggregator) == address(0)) return 0; return aggregator.getTimestamp(aggregatorRoundId); } /** * @notice get the latest completed round where the answer was updated. This * ID includes the proxy's phase, to make sure round IDs increase even when * switching to a newly deployed aggregator. * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestRound() public view virtual override returns (uint256 roundId) { Phase memory phase = currentPhase; // cache storage reads return addPhase(phase.id, uint64(phase.aggregator.latestRound())); } /** * @notice get data about a round. Consumers are encouraged to check * that they're receiving fresh data by inspecting the updatedAt and * answeredInRound return values. * Note that different underlying implementations of AggregatorV3Interface * have slightly different semantics for some of the return values. Consumers * should determine what implementations they expect to receive * data from and validate that they can properly handle return data from all * of them. * @param _roundId the requested round ID as presented through the proxy, this * is made up of the aggregator's round ID with the phase ID encoded in the * two highest order bytes * @return roundId is the round ID from the aggregator for which the data was * retrieved combined with an phase to ensure that round IDs get larger as * time moves forward. * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @dev Note that answer and updatedAt may change between queries. */ function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) public view virtual override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { (uint16 phaseId, uint64 aggregatorRoundId) = parseIds(_roundId); ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 ansIn ) = phaseAggregators[phaseId].getRoundData(aggregatorRoundId); return addPhaseIds(roundId, answer, startedAt, updatedAt, ansIn, phaseId); } /** * @notice get data about the latest round. Consumers are encouraged to check * that they're receiving fresh data by inspecting the updatedAt and * answeredInRound return values. * Note that different underlying implementations of AggregatorV3Interface * have slightly different semantics for some of the return values. Consumers * should determine what implementations they expect to receive * data from and validate that they can properly handle return data from all * of them. * @return roundId is the round ID from the aggregator for which the data was * retrieved combined with an phase to ensure that round IDs get larger as * time moves forward. * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @dev Note that answer and updatedAt may change between queries. */ function latestRoundData() public view virtual override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { Phase memory current = currentPhase; // cache storage reads ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 ansIn ) = current.aggregator.latestRoundData(); return addPhaseIds(roundId, answer, startedAt, updatedAt, ansIn, current.id); } /** * @notice Used if an aggregator contract has been proposed. * @param _roundId the round ID to retrieve the round data for * @return roundId is the round ID for which data was retrieved * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. */ function proposedGetRoundData(uint80 _roundId) public view virtual hasProposal() returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return proposedAggregator.getRoundData(_roundId); } /** * @notice Used if an aggregator contract has been proposed. * @return roundId is the round ID for which data was retrieved * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. */ function proposedLatestRoundData() public view virtual hasProposal() returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return proposedAggregator.latestRoundData(); } /** * @notice returns the current phase's aggregator address. */ function aggregator() external view returns (address) { return address(currentPhase.aggregator); } /** * @notice returns the current phase's ID. */ function phaseId() external view returns (uint16) { return currentPhase.id; } /** * @notice represents the number of decimals the aggregator responses represent. */ function decimals() external view override returns (uint8) { return currentPhase.aggregator.decimals(); } /** * @notice the version number representing the type of aggregator the proxy * points to. */ function version() external view override returns (uint256) { return currentPhase.aggregator.version(); } /** * @notice returns the description of the aggregator the proxy points to. */ function description() external view override returns (string memory) { return currentPhase.aggregator.description(); } /** * @notice Allows the owner to propose a new address for the aggregator * @param _aggregator The new address for the aggregator contract */ function proposeAggregator(address _aggregator) external onlyOwner() { proposedAggregator = AggregatorV2V3Interface(_aggregator); } /** * @notice Allows the owner to confirm and change the address * to the proposed aggregator * @dev Reverts if the given address doesn't match what was previously * proposed * @param _aggregator The new address for the aggregator contract */ function confirmAggregator(address _aggregator) external onlyOwner() { require(_aggregator == address(proposedAggregator), "Invalid proposed aggregator"); delete proposedAggregator; setAggregator(_aggregator); } /* * Internal */ function setAggregator(address _aggregator) internal { uint16 id = currentPhase.id + 1; currentPhase = Phase(id, AggregatorV2V3Interface(_aggregator)); phaseAggregators[id] = AggregatorV2V3Interface(_aggregator); } function addPhase( uint16 _phase, uint64 _originalId ) internal view returns (uint80) { return uint80(uint256(_phase) << PHASE_OFFSET | _originalId); } function parseIds( uint256 _roundId ) internal view returns (uint16, uint64) { uint16 phaseId = uint16(_roundId >> PHASE_OFFSET); uint64 aggregatorRoundId = uint64(_roundId); return (phaseId, aggregatorRoundId); } function addPhaseIds( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound, uint16 phaseId ) internal view returns (uint80, int256, uint256, uint256, uint80) { return ( addPhase(phaseId, uint64(roundId)), answer, startedAt, updatedAt, addPhase(phaseId, uint64(answeredInRound)) ); } /* * Modifiers */ modifier hasProposal() { require(address(proposedAggregator) != address(0), "No proposed aggregator present"); _; } } interface AccessControllerInterface { function hasAccess(address user, bytes calldata data) external view returns (bool); } /** * @title External Access Controlled Aggregator Proxy * @notice A trusted proxy for updating where current answers are read from * @notice This contract provides a consistent address for the * Aggregator and AggregatorV3Interface but delegates where it reads from to the owner, who is * trusted to update it. * @notice Only access enabled addresses are allowed to access getters for * aggregated answers and round information. */ contract EACAggregatorProxy is AggregatorProxy { AccessControllerInterface public accessController; constructor( address _aggregator, address _accessController ) public AggregatorProxy(_aggregator) { setController(_accessController); } /** * @notice Allows the owner to update the accessController contract address. * @param _accessController The new address for the accessController contract */ function setController(address _accessController) public onlyOwner() { accessController = AccessControllerInterface(_accessController); } /** * @notice Reads the current answer from aggregator delegated to. * @dev overridden function to add the checkAccess() modifier * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestAnswer() public view override checkAccess() returns (int256) { return super.latestAnswer(); } /** * @notice get the latest completed round where the answer was updated. This * ID includes the proxy's phase, to make sure round IDs increase even when * switching to a newly deployed aggregator. * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestTimestamp() public view override checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.latestTimestamp(); } /** * @notice get past rounds answers * @param _roundId the answer number to retrieve the answer for * @dev overridden function to add the checkAccess() modifier * * @dev #[deprecated] Use getRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended getRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function getAnswer(uint256 _roundId) public view override checkAccess() returns (int256) { return super.getAnswer(_roundId); } /** * @notice get block timestamp when an answer was last updated * @param _roundId the answer number to retrieve the updated timestamp for * @dev overridden function to add the checkAccess() modifier * * @dev #[deprecated] Use getRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended getRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function getTimestamp(uint256 _roundId) public view override checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.getTimestamp(_roundId); } /** * @notice get the latest completed round where the answer was updated * @dev overridden function to add the checkAccess() modifier * * @dev #[deprecated] Use latestRoundData instead. This does not error if no * answer has been reached, it will simply return 0. Either wait to point to * an already answered Aggregator or use the recommended latestRoundData * instead which includes better verification information. */ function latestRound() public view override checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.latestRound(); } /** * @notice get data about a round. Consumers are encouraged to check * that they're receiving fresh data by inspecting the updatedAt and * answeredInRound return values. * Note that different underlying implementations of AggregatorV3Interface * have slightly different semantics for some of the return values. Consumers * should determine what implementations they expect to receive * data from and validate that they can properly handle return data from all * of them. * @param _roundId the round ID to retrieve the round data for * @return roundId is the round ID from the aggregator for which the data was * retrieved combined with a phase to ensure that round IDs get larger as * time moves forward. * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @dev Note that answer and updatedAt may change between queries. */ function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) public view checkAccess() override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.getRoundData(_roundId); } /** * @notice get data about the latest round. Consumers are encouraged to check * that they're receiving fresh data by inspecting the updatedAt and * answeredInRound return values. * Note that different underlying implementations of AggregatorV3Interface * have slightly different semantics for some of the return values. Consumers * should determine what implementations they expect to receive * data from and validate that they can properly handle return data from all * of them. * @return roundId is the round ID from the aggregator for which the data was * retrieved combined with a phase to ensure that round IDs get larger as * time moves forward. * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @dev Note that answer and updatedAt may change between queries. */ function latestRoundData() public view checkAccess() override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.latestRoundData(); } /** * @notice Used if an aggregator contract has been proposed. * @param _roundId the round ID to retrieve the round data for * @return roundId is the round ID for which data was retrieved * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. */ function proposedGetRoundData(uint80 _roundId) public view checkAccess() hasProposal() override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.proposedGetRoundData(_roundId); } /** * @notice Used if an aggregator contract has been proposed. * @return roundId is the round ID for which data was retrieved * @return answer is the answer for the given round * @return startedAt is the timestamp when the round was started. * (Only some AggregatorV3Interface implementations return meaningful values) * @return updatedAt is the timestamp when the round last was updated (i.e. * answer was last computed) * @return answeredInRound is the round ID of the round in which the answer * was computed. */ function proposedLatestRoundData() public view checkAccess() hasProposal() override returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.proposedLatestRoundData(); } /** * @dev reverts if the caller does not have access by the accessController * contract or is the contract itself. */ modifier checkAccess() { AccessControllerInterface ac = accessController; require(address(ac) == address(0) || ac.hasAccess(msg.sender, msg.data), "No access"); _; } }
File 7 of 8: AccessControlledOCR2Aggregator
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity =0.8.19; import "./OCR2Aggregator.sol"; import "./SimpleReadAccessController.sol"; /** * @notice Wrapper of OCR2Aggregator which checks read access on Aggregator-interface methods */ contract AccessControlledOCR2Aggregator is OCR2Aggregator, SimpleReadAccessController { constructor( LinkTokenInterface _link, int192 _minAnswer, int192 _maxAnswer, AccessControllerInterface _billingAccessController, AccessControllerInterface _requesterAccessController, uint8 _decimals, string memory description ) OCR2Aggregator( _link, _minAnswer, _maxAnswer, _billingAccessController, _requesterAccessController, _decimals, description ) { } /* * Versioning */ function typeAndVersion() external override pure virtual returns (string memory) { return "AccessControlledOCR2Aggregator 1.0.0"; } /* * v2 Aggregator interface */ /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function latestAnswer() public override view checkAccess() returns (int256) { return super.latestAnswer(); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function latestTimestamp() public override view checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.latestTimestamp(); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function latestRound() public override view checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.latestRound(); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function getAnswer(uint256 _roundId) public override view checkAccess() returns (int256) { return super.getAnswer(_roundId); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function getTimestamp(uint256 _roundId) public override view checkAccess() returns (uint256) { return super.getTimestamp(_roundId); } /* * v3 Aggregator interface */ /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function description() public override view checkAccess() returns (string memory) { return super.description(); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) public override view checkAccess() returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.getRoundData(_roundId); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Aggregator function latestRoundData() public override view checkAccess() returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { return super.latestRoundData(); } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./ConfirmedOwnerWithProposal.sol"; /** * @title The ConfirmedOwner contract * @notice A contract with helpers for basic contract ownership. */ contract ConfirmedOwner is ConfirmedOwnerWithProposal { constructor( address newOwner ) ConfirmedOwnerWithProposal( newOwner, address(0) ) { } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./interfaces/OwnableInterface.sol"; /** * @title The ConfirmedOwner contract * @notice A contract with helpers for basic contract ownership. */ contract ConfirmedOwnerWithProposal is OwnableInterface { address private s_owner; address private s_pendingOwner; event OwnershipTransferRequested( address indexed from, address indexed to ); event OwnershipTransferred( address indexed from, address indexed to ); constructor( address newOwner, address pendingOwner ) { require(newOwner != address(0), "Cannot set owner to zero"); s_owner = newOwner; if (pendingOwner != address(0)) { _transferOwnership(pendingOwner); } } /** * @notice Allows an owner to begin transferring ownership to a new address, * pending. */ function transferOwnership( address to ) public override onlyOwner() { _transferOwnership(to); } /** * @notice Allows an ownership transfer to be completed by the recipient. */ function acceptOwnership() external override { require(msg.sender == s_pendingOwner, "Must be proposed owner"); address oldOwner = s_owner; s_owner = msg.sender; s_pendingOwner = address(0); emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, msg.sender); } /** * @notice Get the current owner */ function owner() public view override returns ( address ) { return s_owner; } /** * @notice validate, transfer ownership, and emit relevant events */ function _transferOwnership( address to ) private { require(to != msg.sender, "Cannot transfer to self"); s_pendingOwner = to; emit OwnershipTransferRequested(s_owner, to); } /** * @notice validate access */ function _validateOwnership() internal view { require(msg.sender == s_owner, "Only callable by owner"); } /** * @notice Reverts if called by anyone other than the contract owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { _validateOwnership(); _; } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./interfaces/TypeAndVersionInterface.sol"; abstract contract OCR2Abstract is TypeAndVersionInterface { // Maximum number of oracles the offchain reporting protocol is designed for uint256 constant internal maxNumOracles = 31; /** * @notice triggers a new run of the offchain reporting protocol * @param previousConfigBlockNumber block in which the previous config was set, to simplify historic analysis * @param configDigest configDigest of this configuration * @param configCount ordinal number of this config setting among all config settings over the life of this contract * @param signers ith element is address ith oracle uses to sign a report * @param transmitters ith element is address ith oracle uses to transmit a report via the transmit method * @param f maximum number of faulty/dishonest oracles the protocol can tolerate while still working correctly * @param onchainConfig serialized configuration used by the contract (and possibly oracles) * @param offchainConfigVersion version of the serialization format used for "offchainConfig" parameter * @param offchainConfig serialized configuration used by the oracles exclusively and only passed through the contract */ event ConfigSet( uint32 previousConfigBlockNumber, bytes32 configDigest, uint64 configCount, address[] signers, address[] transmitters, uint8 f, bytes onchainConfig, uint64 offchainConfigVersion, bytes offchainConfig ); /** * @notice sets offchain reporting protocol configuration incl. participating oracles * @param signers addresses with which oracles sign the reports * @param transmitters addresses oracles use to transmit the reports * @param f number of faulty oracles the system can tolerate * @param onchainConfig serialized configuration used by the contract (and possibly oracles) * @param offchainConfigVersion version number for offchainEncoding schema * @param offchainConfig serialized configuration used by the oracles exclusively and only passed through the contract */ function setConfig( address[] memory signers, address[] memory transmitters, uint8 f, bytes memory onchainConfig, uint64 offchainConfigVersion, bytes memory offchainConfig ) external virtual; /** * @notice information about current offchain reporting protocol configuration * @return configCount ordinal number of current config, out of all configs applied to this contract so far * @return blockNumber block at which this config was set * @return configDigest domain-separation tag for current config (see _configDigestFromConfigData) */ function latestConfigDetails() external view virtual returns ( uint32 configCount, uint32 blockNumber, bytes32 configDigest ); function _configDigestFromConfigData( uint256 chainId, address contractAddress, uint64 configCount, address[] memory signers, address[] memory transmitters, uint8 f, bytes memory onchainConfig, uint64 offchainConfigVersion, bytes memory offchainConfig ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 h = uint256(keccak256(abi.encode(chainId, contractAddress, configCount, signers, transmitters, f, onchainConfig, offchainConfigVersion, offchainConfig ))); uint256 prefixMask = type(uint256).max << (256-16); // 0xFFFF00..00 uint256 prefix = 0x0001 << (256-16); // 0x000100..00 return bytes32((prefix & prefixMask) | (h & ~prefixMask)); } /** * @notice optionally emitted to indicate the latest configDigest and epoch for which a report was successfully transmitted. Alternatively, the contract may use latestConfigDigestAndEpoch with scanLogs set to false. */ event Transmitted( bytes32 configDigest, uint32 epoch ); /** * @notice optionally returns the latest configDigest and epoch for which a report was successfully transmitted. Alternatively, the contract may return scanLogs set to true and use Transmitted events to provide this information to offchain watchers. * @return scanLogs indicates whether to rely on the configDigest and epoch returned or whether to scan logs for the Transmitted event instead. * @return configDigest * @return epoch */ function latestConfigDigestAndEpoch() external view virtual returns( bool scanLogs, bytes32 configDigest, uint32 epoch ); /** * @notice transmit is called to post a new report to the contract * @param reportContext serialized report context containing configDigest, epoch, round, extraHash * @param report serialized report, which the signatures are signing * @param rs ith element is the R components of the ith signature on report. Must have at most maxNumOracles entries * @param ss ith element is the S components of the ith signature on report. Must have at most maxNumOracles entries * @param rawVs ith element is the the V component of the ith signature */ function transmit( // NOTE: If these parameters are changed, expectedMsgDataLength and/or // TRANSMIT_MSGDATA_CONSTANT_LENGTH_COMPONENT need to be changed accordingly bytes32[3] calldata reportContext, bytes calldata report, bytes32[] calldata rs, bytes32[] calldata ss, bytes32 rawVs // signatures ) external virtual; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity =0.8.19; import "./interfaces/AccessControllerInterface.sol"; import "./interfaces/AggregatorV2V3Interface.sol"; import "./interfaces/AggregatorValidatorInterface.sol"; import "./interfaces/LinkTokenInterface.sol"; import "./interfaces/TypeAndVersionInterface.sol"; import "./OCR2Abstract.sol"; import "./OwnerIsCreator.sol"; /** * @notice OCR2Aggregator for numerical data with billing support. * @dev * If you read or change this, be sure to read or adjust the comments. They * track the units of the values under consideration, and are crucial to * the readability of the operations it specifies. * @notice * Billing Trust Model: * Nothing in this contract prevents a billing admin from setting insane * values for the billing parameters in setBilling. Oracles * participating in this contract should regularly check that the * parameters make sense. Similarly, the outstanding obligations of this * contract to the oracles can exceed the funds held by the contract. * Oracles participating in this contract should regularly check that it * holds sufficient funds and stop interacting with it if funding runs * out. * This still leaves oracles with some risk due to TOCTOU issues. * However, since the sums involved are pretty small (Ethereum * transactions aren't that expensive in the end) and an oracle would * likely stop participating in a contract it repeatedly lost money on, * this risk is deemed acceptable. Oracles should also regularly * withdraw any funds in the contract to prevent issues where the * contract becomes underfunded at a later time, and different oracles * are competing for the left-over funds. * Finally, note that any change to the set of oracles or to the billing * parameters will trigger payout of all oracles first (using the old * parameters), a billing admin cannot take away funds that are already * marked for payment. */ contract OCR2Aggregator is OCR2Abstract, OwnerIsCreator, AggregatorV2V3Interface { // This contract is divided into sections. Each section defines a set of // variables, events, and functions that belong together. /*************************************************************************** * Section: Variables used in multiple other sections **************************************************************************/ struct Transmitter { bool active; // Index of oracle in s_signersList/s_transmittersList uint8 index; // juels-denominated payment for transmitters, covering gas costs incurred // by the transmitter plus additional rewards. The entire LINK supply (1e9 // LINK = 1e27 Juels) will always fit into a uint96. uint96 paymentJuels; } mapping (address /* transmitter address */ => Transmitter) internal s_transmitters; struct Signer { bool active; // Index of oracle in s_signersList/s_transmittersList uint8 index; } mapping (address /* signer address */ => Signer) internal s_signers; // s_signersList contains the signing address of each oracle address[] internal s_signersList; // s_transmittersList contains the transmission address of each oracle, // i.e. the address the oracle actually sends transactions to the contract from address[] internal s_transmittersList; // We assume that all oracles contribute observations to all rounds. this // variable tracks (per-oracle) from what round an oracle should be rewarded, // i.e. the oracle gets (latestAggregatorRoundId - // rewardFromAggregatorRoundId) * reward uint32[maxNumOracles] internal s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId; bytes32 s_latestConfigDigest; // Storing these fields used on the hot path in a HotVars variable reduces the // retrieval of all of them to a single SLOAD. struct HotVars { // maximum number of faulty oracles uint8 f; // epoch and round from OCR protocol. // 32 most sig bits for epoch, 8 least sig bits for round uint40 latestEpochAndRound; // Chainlink Aggregators expose a roundId to consumers. The offchain reporting // protocol does not use this id anywhere. We increment it whenever a new // transmission is made to provide callers with contiguous ids for successive // reports. uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId; // Highest compensated gas price, in gwei uints uint32 maximumGasPriceGwei; // If gas price is less (in gwei units), transmitter gets half the savings uint32 reasonableGasPriceGwei; // Fixed LINK reward for each observer uint32 observationPaymentGjuels; // Fixed reward for transmitter uint32 transmissionPaymentGjuels; // Overhead incurred by accounting logic uint24 accountingGas; } HotVars internal s_hotVars; // Transmission records the median answer from the transmit transaction at // time timestamp struct Transmission { int192 answer; // 192 bits ought to be enough for anyone uint32 observationsTimestamp; // when were observations made offchain uint32 transmissionTimestamp; // when was report received onchain } mapping(uint32 /* aggregator round ID */ => Transmission) internal s_transmissions; // Lowest answer the system is allowed to report in response to transmissions int192 immutable public minAnswer; // Highest answer the system is allowed to report in response to transmissions int192 immutable public maxAnswer; /*************************************************************************** * Section: Constructor **************************************************************************/ /** * @param link address of the LINK contract * @param minAnswer_ lowest answer the median of a report is allowed to be * @param maxAnswer_ highest answer the median of a report is allowed to be * @param requesterAccessController access controller for requesting new rounds * @param decimals_ answers are stored in fixed-point format, with this many digits of precision * @param description_ short human-readable description of observable this contract's answers pertain to */ constructor( LinkTokenInterface link, int192 minAnswer_, int192 maxAnswer_, AccessControllerInterface billingAccessController, AccessControllerInterface requesterAccessController, uint8 decimals_, string memory description_ ) { s_linkToken = link; emit LinkTokenSet(LinkTokenInterface(address(0)), link); _setBillingAccessController(billingAccessController); decimals = decimals_; s_description = description_; setRequesterAccessController(requesterAccessController); setValidatorConfig(AggregatorValidatorInterface(address(0x0)), 0); minAnswer = minAnswer_; maxAnswer = maxAnswer_; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: OCR2Abstract Configuration **************************************************************************/ // incremented each time a new config is posted. This count is incorporated // into the config digest to prevent replay attacks. uint32 internal s_configCount; // makes it easier for offchain systems to extract config from logs uint32 internal s_latestConfigBlockNumber; // left as a function so this check can be disabled in derived contracts function _requirePositiveF ( uint256 f ) internal pure virtual { require(0 < f, "f must be positive"); } struct SetConfigArgs { address[] signers; address[] transmitters; uint8 f; bytes onchainConfig; uint64 offchainConfigVersion; bytes offchainConfig; } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Abstract function setConfig( address[] memory signers, address[] memory transmitters, uint8 f, bytes memory onchainConfig, uint64 offchainConfigVersion, bytes memory offchainConfig ) external override onlyOwner() { require(signers.length <= maxNumOracles, "too many oracles"); require(signers.length == transmitters.length, "oracle length mismatch"); require(3*f < signers.length, "faulty-oracle f too high"); _requirePositiveF(f); require(keccak256(onchainConfig) == keccak256(abi.encodePacked(uint8(1) /*version*/, minAnswer, maxAnswer)), "invalid onchainConfig"); SetConfigArgs memory args = SetConfigArgs({ signers: signers, transmitters: transmitters, f: f, onchainConfig: onchainConfig, offchainConfigVersion: offchainConfigVersion, offchainConfig: offchainConfig }); s_hotVars.latestEpochAndRound = 0; _payOracles(); // remove any old signer/transmitter addresses uint256 oldLength = s_signersList.length; for (uint256 i = 0; i < oldLength; i++) { address signer = s_signersList[i]; address transmitter = s_transmittersList[i]; delete s_signers[signer]; delete s_transmitters[transmitter]; } delete s_signersList; delete s_transmittersList; // add new signer/transmitter addresses for (uint i = 0; i < args.signers.length; i++) { require( !s_signers[args.signers[i]].active, "repeated signer address" ); s_signers[args.signers[i]] = Signer({ active: true, index: uint8(i) }); require( !s_transmitters[args.transmitters[i]].active, "repeated transmitter address" ); s_transmitters[args.transmitters[i]] = Transmitter({ active: true, index: uint8(i), paymentJuels: 0 }); } s_signersList = args.signers; s_transmittersList = args.transmitters; s_hotVars.f = args.f; uint32 previousConfigBlockNumber = s_latestConfigBlockNumber; s_latestConfigBlockNumber = uint32(block.number); s_configCount += 1; s_latestConfigDigest = _configDigestFromConfigData( block.chainid, address(this), s_configCount, args.signers, args.transmitters, args.f, args.onchainConfig, args.offchainConfigVersion, args.offchainConfig ); emit ConfigSet( previousConfigBlockNumber, s_latestConfigDigest, s_configCount, args.signers, args.transmitters, args.f, args.onchainConfig, args.offchainConfigVersion, args.offchainConfig ); uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; for (uint256 i = 0; i < args.signers.length; i++) { s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[i] = latestAggregatorRoundId; } } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Abstract function latestConfigDetails() external override view returns ( uint32 configCount, uint32 blockNumber, bytes32 configDigest ) { return (s_configCount, s_latestConfigBlockNumber, s_latestConfigDigest); } /** * @return list of addresses permitted to transmit reports to this contract * @dev The list will match the order used to specify the transmitter during setConfig */ function getTransmitters() external view returns(address[] memory) { return s_transmittersList; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Onchain Validation **************************************************************************/ // Configuration for validator struct ValidatorConfig { AggregatorValidatorInterface validator; uint32 gasLimit; } ValidatorConfig private s_validatorConfig; /** * @notice indicates that the validator configuration has been set * @param previousValidator previous validator contract * @param previousGasLimit previous gas limit for validate calls * @param currentValidator current validator contract * @param currentGasLimit current gas limit for validate calls */ event ValidatorConfigSet( AggregatorValidatorInterface indexed previousValidator, uint32 previousGasLimit, AggregatorValidatorInterface indexed currentValidator, uint32 currentGasLimit ); /** * @notice validator configuration * @return validator validator contract * @return gasLimit gas limit for validate calls */ function getValidatorConfig() external view returns (AggregatorValidatorInterface validator, uint32 gasLimit) { ValidatorConfig memory vc = s_validatorConfig; return (vc.validator, vc.gasLimit); } /** * @notice sets validator configuration * @dev set newValidator to 0x0 to disable validate calls * @param newValidator address of the new validator contract * @param newGasLimit new gas limit for validate calls */ function setValidatorConfig( AggregatorValidatorInterface newValidator, uint32 newGasLimit ) public onlyOwner() { ValidatorConfig memory previous = s_validatorConfig; if (previous.validator != newValidator || previous.gasLimit != newGasLimit) { s_validatorConfig = ValidatorConfig({ validator: newValidator, gasLimit: newGasLimit }); emit ValidatorConfigSet(previous.validator, previous.gasLimit, newValidator, newGasLimit); } } function _validateAnswer( uint32 aggregatorRoundId, int256 answer ) private { ValidatorConfig memory vc = s_validatorConfig; if (address(vc.validator) == address(0)) { return; } uint32 prevAggregatorRoundId = aggregatorRoundId - 1; int256 prevAggregatorRoundAnswer = s_transmissions[prevAggregatorRoundId].answer; require( _callWithExactGasEvenIfTargetIsNoContract( vc.gasLimit, address(vc.validator), abi.encodeWithSignature( "validate(uint256,int256,uint256,int256)", uint256(prevAggregatorRoundId), prevAggregatorRoundAnswer, uint256(aggregatorRoundId), answer ) ), "insufficient gas" ); } uint256 private constant CALL_WITH_EXACT_GAS_CUSHION = 5_000; /** * @dev calls target address with exactly gasAmount gas and data as calldata * or reverts if at least gasAmount gas is not available. */ function _callWithExactGasEvenIfTargetIsNoContract( uint256 gasAmount, address target, bytes memory data ) private returns (bool sufficientGas) { // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let g := gas() // Compute g -= CALL_WITH_EXACT_GAS_CUSHION and check for underflow. We // need the cushion since the logic following the above call to gas also // costs gas which we cannot account for exactly. So cushion is a // conservative upper bound for the cost of this logic. if iszero(lt(g, CALL_WITH_EXACT_GAS_CUSHION)) { g := sub(g, CALL_WITH_EXACT_GAS_CUSHION) // If g - g//64 <= gasAmount, we don't have enough gas. (We subtract g//64 // because of EIP-150.) if gt(sub(g, div(g, 64)), gasAmount) { // Call and ignore success/return data. Note that we did not check // whether a contract actually exists at the target address. pop(call(gasAmount, target, 0, add(data, 0x20), mload(data), 0, 0)) sufficientGas := true } } } } /*************************************************************************** * Section: RequestNewRound **************************************************************************/ AccessControllerInterface internal s_requesterAccessController; /** * @notice emitted when a new requester access controller contract is set * @param old the address prior to the current setting * @param current the address of the new access controller contract */ event RequesterAccessControllerSet(AccessControllerInterface old, AccessControllerInterface current); /** * @notice emitted to immediately request a new round * @param requester the address of the requester * @param configDigest the latest transmission's configDigest * @param epoch the latest transmission's epoch * @param round the latest transmission's round */ event RoundRequested(address indexed requester, bytes32 configDigest, uint32 epoch, uint8 round); /** * @notice address of the requester access controller contract * @return requester access controller address */ function getRequesterAccessController() external view returns (AccessControllerInterface) { return s_requesterAccessController; } /** * @notice sets the requester access controller * @param requesterAccessController designates the address of the new requester access controller */ function setRequesterAccessController(AccessControllerInterface requesterAccessController) public onlyOwner() { AccessControllerInterface oldController = s_requesterAccessController; if (requesterAccessController != oldController) { s_requesterAccessController = AccessControllerInterface(requesterAccessController); emit RequesterAccessControllerSet(oldController, requesterAccessController); } } /** * @notice immediately requests a new round * @return the aggregatorRoundId of the next round. Note: The report for this round may have been * transmitted (but not yet mined) *before* requestNewRound() was even called. There is *no* * guarantee of causality between the request and the report at aggregatorRoundId. */ function requestNewRound() external returns (uint80) { require(msg.sender == owner() || s_requesterAccessController.hasAccess(msg.sender, msg.data), "Only owner&requester can call"); uint40 latestEpochAndRound = s_hotVars.latestEpochAndRound; uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; emit RoundRequested( msg.sender, s_latestConfigDigest, uint32(latestEpochAndRound >> 8), uint8(latestEpochAndRound) ); return latestAggregatorRoundId + 1; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Transmission **************************************************************************/ /** * @notice indicates that a new report was transmitted * @param aggregatorRoundId the round to which this report was assigned * @param answer median of the observations attached to this report * @param transmitter address from which the report was transmitted * @param observationsTimestamp when were observations made offchain * @param observations observations transmitted with this report * @param observers i-th element is the oracle id of the oracle that made the i-th observation * @param juelsPerFeeCoin exchange rate between feeCoin (e.g. ETH on Ethereum) and LINK, denominated in juels * @param configDigest configDigest of transmission * @param epochAndRound least-significant byte is the OCR protocol round number, the other bytes give the big-endian OCR protocol epoch number */ event NewTransmission( uint32 indexed aggregatorRoundId, int192 answer, address transmitter, uint32 observationsTimestamp, int192[] observations, bytes observers, int192 juelsPerFeeCoin, bytes32 configDigest, uint40 epochAndRound ); // Used to relieve stack pressure in transmit struct Report { uint32 observationsTimestamp; bytes observers; // ith element is the index of the ith observer int192[] observations; // ith element is the ith observation int192 juelsPerFeeCoin; } // _decodeReport decodes a serialized report into a Report struct function _decodeReport(bytes memory rawReport) internal pure returns ( Report memory ) { uint32 observationsTimestamp; bytes32 rawObservers; int192[] memory observations; int192 juelsPerFeeCoin; (observationsTimestamp, rawObservers, observations, juelsPerFeeCoin) = abi.decode(rawReport, (uint32, bytes32, int192[], int192)); _requireExpectedReportLength(rawReport, observations); uint256 numObservations = observations.length; bytes memory observers = abi.encodePacked(rawObservers); assembly { // we truncate observers from length 32 to the number of observations mstore(observers, numObservations) } return Report({ observationsTimestamp: observationsTimestamp, observers: observers, observations: observations, juelsPerFeeCoin: juelsPerFeeCoin }); } // The constant-length components of the msg.data sent to transmit. // See the "If we wanted to call sam" example on for example reasoning // https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.7.2/abi-spec.html uint256 private constant TRANSMIT_MSGDATA_CONSTANT_LENGTH_COMPONENT = 4 + // function selector 32 * 3 + // 3 words containing reportContext 32 + // word containing start location of abiencoded report value 32 + // word containing start location of abiencoded rs value 32 + // word containing start location of abiencoded ss value 32 + // rawVs value 32 + // word containing length of report 32 + // word containing length rs 32 + // word containing length of ss 0; // placeholder // Make sure the calldata length matches the inputs. Otherwise, the // transmitter could append an arbitrarily long (up to gas-block limit) // string of 0 bytes, which we would reimburse at a rate of 16 gas/byte, but // which would only cost the transmitter 4 gas/byte. function _requireExpectedMsgDataLength( bytes calldata report, bytes32[] calldata rs, bytes32[] calldata ss ) private pure { // calldata will never be big enough to make this overflow uint256 expected = TRANSMIT_MSGDATA_CONSTANT_LENGTH_COMPONENT + report.length + // one byte per entry in report rs.length * 32 + // 32 bytes per entry in rs ss.length * 32 + // 32 bytes per entry in ss 0; // placeholder require(msg.data.length == expected, "calldata length mismatch"); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Abstract function transmit( // reportContext consists of: // reportContext[0]: ConfigDigest // reportContext[1]: 27 byte padding, 4-byte epoch and 1-byte round // reportContext[2]: ExtraHash bytes32[3] calldata reportContext, bytes calldata report, // ECDSA signatures bytes32[] calldata rs, bytes32[] calldata ss, bytes32 rawVs ) external override { // NOTE: If the arguments to this function are changed, _requireExpectedMsgDataLength and/or // TRANSMIT_MSGDATA_CONSTANT_LENGTH_COMPONENT need to be changed accordingly uint256 initialGas = gasleft(); // This line must come first HotVars memory hotVars = s_hotVars; uint40 epochAndRound = uint40(uint256(reportContext[1])); require(hotVars.latestEpochAndRound < epochAndRound, "stale report"); require(s_transmitters[msg.sender].active, "unauthorized transmitter"); require(s_latestConfigDigest == reportContext[0], "configDigest mismatch"); _requireExpectedMsgDataLength(report, rs, ss); require(rs.length == hotVars.f + 1, "wrong number of signatures"); require(rs.length == ss.length, "signatures out of registration"); // Verify signatures attached to report { bytes32 h = keccak256(abi.encode(keccak256(report), reportContext)); // i-th byte counts number of sigs made by i-th signer uint256 signedCount = 0; Signer memory signer; for (uint i = 0; i < rs.length; i++) { address signerAddress = ecrecover(h, uint8(rawVs[i])+27, rs[i], ss[i]); signer = s_signers[signerAddress]; require(signer.active, "signature error"); unchecked{ signedCount += 1 << (8 * signer.index); } } // The first byte of the mask can be 0, because we only ever have 31 oracles require(signedCount & 0x0001010101010101010101010101010101010101010101010101010101010101 == signedCount, "duplicate signer"); } int192 juelsPerFeeCoin = _report(hotVars, reportContext[0], epochAndRound, report); _payTransmitter(hotVars, juelsPerFeeCoin, uint32(initialGas), msg.sender); } /** * @notice details about the most recent report * @return configDigest domain separation tag for the latest report * @return epoch epoch in which the latest report was generated * @return round OCR round in which the latest report was generated * @return latestAnswer_ median value from latest report * @return latestTimestamp_ when the latest report was transmitted */ function latestTransmissionDetails() external view returns ( bytes32 configDigest, uint32 epoch, uint8 round, int192 latestAnswer_, uint64 latestTimestamp_ ) { require(msg.sender == tx.origin, "Only callable by EOA"); return ( s_latestConfigDigest, uint32(s_hotVars.latestEpochAndRound >> 8), uint8(s_hotVars.latestEpochAndRound), s_transmissions[s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId].answer, s_transmissions[s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId].transmissionTimestamp ); } /// @inheritdoc OCR2Abstract function latestConfigDigestAndEpoch() external override view virtual returns( bool scanLogs, bytes32 configDigest, uint32 epoch ) { return (false, s_latestConfigDigest, uint32(s_hotVars.latestEpochAndRound >> 8)); } function _requireExpectedReportLength( bytes memory report, int192[] memory observations ) private pure { uint256 expected = 32 + // observationsTimestamp 32 + // rawObservers 32 + // observations offset 32 + // juelsPerFeeCoin 32 + // observations length 32 * observations.length + // observations payload 0; require(report.length == expected, "report length mismatch"); } function _report( HotVars memory hotVars, bytes32 configDigest, uint40 epochAndRound, bytes memory rawReport ) internal returns (int192 juelsPerFeeCoin) { Report memory report = _decodeReport(rawReport); require(report.observations.length <= maxNumOracles, "num observations out of bounds"); // Offchain logic ensures that a quorum of oracles is operating on a matching set of at least // 2f+1 observations. By assumption, up to f of those can be faulty, which includes being // malformed. Conversely, more than f observations have to be well-formed and sent on chain. require(hotVars.f < report.observations.length, "too few values to trust median"); hotVars.latestEpochAndRound = epochAndRound; // get median, validate its range, store it in new aggregator round int192 median = report.observations[report.observations.length/2]; require(minAnswer <= median && median <= maxAnswer, "median is out of min-max range"); hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId++; s_transmissions[hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId] = Transmission({ answer: median, observationsTimestamp: report.observationsTimestamp, transmissionTimestamp: uint32(block.timestamp) }); // persist updates to hotVars s_hotVars = hotVars; emit NewTransmission( hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId, median, msg.sender, report.observationsTimestamp, report.observations, report.observers, report.juelsPerFeeCoin, configDigest, epochAndRound ); // Emit these for backwards compatibility with offchain consumers // that only support legacy events emit NewRound( hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId, address(0x0), // use zero address since we don't have anybody "starting" the round here report.observationsTimestamp ); emit AnswerUpdated( median, hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId, block.timestamp ); _validateAnswer(hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId, median); return report.juelsPerFeeCoin; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: v2 AggregatorInterface **************************************************************************/ /** * @notice median from the most recent report */ function latestAnswer() public override view virtual returns (int256) { return s_transmissions[s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId].answer; } /** * @notice timestamp of block in which last report was transmitted */ function latestTimestamp() public override view virtual returns (uint256) { return s_transmissions[s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId].transmissionTimestamp; } /** * @notice Aggregator round (NOT OCR round) in which last report was transmitted */ function latestRound() public override view virtual returns (uint256) { return s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; } /** * @notice median of report from given aggregator round (NOT OCR round) * @param roundId the aggregator round of the target report */ function getAnswer(uint256 roundId) public override view virtual returns (int256) { if (roundId > 0xFFFFFFFF) { return 0; } return s_transmissions[uint32(roundId)].answer; } /** * @notice timestamp of block in which report from given aggregator round was transmitted * @param roundId aggregator round (NOT OCR round) of target report */ function getTimestamp(uint256 roundId) public override view virtual returns (uint256) { if (roundId > 0xFFFFFFFF) { return 0; } return s_transmissions[uint32(roundId)].transmissionTimestamp; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: v3 AggregatorInterface **************************************************************************/ /** * @return answers are stored in fixed-point format, with this many digits of precision */ uint8 immutable public override decimals; /** * @notice aggregator contract version */ uint256 constant public override version = 6; string internal s_description; /** * @notice human-readable description of observable this contract is reporting on */ function description() public override view virtual returns (string memory) { return s_description; } /** * @notice details for the given aggregator round * @param roundId target aggregator round (NOT OCR round). Must fit in uint32 * @return roundId_ roundId * @return answer median of report from given roundId * @return startedAt timestamp of when observations were made offchain * @return updatedAt timestamp of block in which report from given roundId was transmitted * @return answeredInRound roundId */ function getRoundData(uint80 roundId) public override view virtual returns ( uint80 roundId_, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { if(roundId > type(uint32).max) { return (0, 0, 0, 0, 0); } Transmission memory transmission = s_transmissions[uint32(roundId)]; return ( roundId, transmission.answer, transmission.observationsTimestamp, transmission.transmissionTimestamp, roundId ); } /** * @notice aggregator details for the most recently transmitted report * @return roundId aggregator round of latest report (NOT OCR round) * @return answer median of latest report * @return startedAt timestamp of when observations were made offchain * @return updatedAt timestamp of block containing latest report * @return answeredInRound aggregator round of latest report */ function latestRoundData() public override view virtual returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ) { uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; Transmission memory transmission = s_transmissions[latestAggregatorRoundId]; return ( latestAggregatorRoundId, transmission.answer, transmission.observationsTimestamp, transmission.transmissionTimestamp, latestAggregatorRoundId ); } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Configurable LINK Token **************************************************************************/ // We assume that the token contract is correct. This contract is not written // to handle misbehaving ERC20 tokens! LinkTokenInterface internal s_linkToken; /* * @notice emitted when the LINK token contract is set * @param oldLinkToken the address of the old LINK token contract * @param newLinkToken the address of the new LINK token contract */ event LinkTokenSet( LinkTokenInterface indexed oldLinkToken, LinkTokenInterface indexed newLinkToken ); /** * @notice sets the LINK token contract used for paying oracles * @param linkToken the address of the LINK token contract * @param recipient remaining funds from the previous token contract are transferred * here * @dev this function will return early (without an error) without changing any state * if linkToken equals getLinkToken(). * @dev this will trigger a payout so that a malicious owner cannot take from oracles * what is already owed to them. * @dev we assume that the token contract is correct. This contract is not written * to handle misbehaving ERC20 tokens! */ function setLinkToken( LinkTokenInterface linkToken, address recipient ) external onlyOwner() { LinkTokenInterface oldLinkToken = s_linkToken; if (linkToken == oldLinkToken) { // No change, nothing to be done return; } // call balanceOf as a sanity check on whether we're talking to a token // contract linkToken.balanceOf(address(this)); // we break CEI here, but that's okay because we're dealing with a correct // token contract (by assumption). _payOracles(); uint256 remainingBalance = oldLinkToken.balanceOf(address(this)); require(oldLinkToken.transfer(recipient, remainingBalance), "transfer remaining funds failed"); s_linkToken = linkToken; emit LinkTokenSet(oldLinkToken, linkToken); } /* * @notice gets the LINK token contract used for paying oracles * @return linkToken the address of the LINK token contract */ function getLinkToken() external view returns(LinkTokenInterface linkToken) { return s_linkToken; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: BillingAccessController Management **************************************************************************/ // Controls who can change billing parameters. A billingAdmin is not able to // affect any OCR protocol settings and therefore cannot tamper with the // liveness or integrity of a data feed. However, a billingAdmin can set // faulty billing parameters causing oracles to be underpaid, or causing them // to be paid so much that further calls to setConfig, setBilling, // setLinkToken will always fail due to the contract being underfunded. AccessControllerInterface internal s_billingAccessController; /** * @notice emitted when a new access-control contract is set * @param old the address prior to the current setting * @param current the address of the new access-control contract */ event BillingAccessControllerSet(AccessControllerInterface old, AccessControllerInterface current); function _setBillingAccessController(AccessControllerInterface billingAccessController) internal { AccessControllerInterface oldController = s_billingAccessController; if (billingAccessController != oldController) { s_billingAccessController = billingAccessController; emit BillingAccessControllerSet( oldController, billingAccessController ); } } /** * @notice sets billingAccessController * @param _billingAccessController new billingAccessController contract address * @dev only owner can call this */ function setBillingAccessController(AccessControllerInterface _billingAccessController) external onlyOwner { _setBillingAccessController(_billingAccessController); } /** * @notice gets billingAccessController * @return address of billingAccessController contract */ function getBillingAccessController() external view returns (AccessControllerInterface) { return s_billingAccessController; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Billing Configuration **************************************************************************/ /** * @notice emitted when billing parameters are set * @param maximumGasPriceGwei highest gas price for which transmitter will be compensated * @param reasonableGasPriceGwei transmitter will receive reward for gas prices under this value * @param observationPaymentGjuels reward to oracle for contributing an observation to a successfully transmitted report * @param transmissionPaymentGjuels reward to transmitter of a successful report * @param accountingGas gas overhead incurred by accounting logic */ event BillingSet( uint32 maximumGasPriceGwei, uint32 reasonableGasPriceGwei, uint32 observationPaymentGjuels, uint32 transmissionPaymentGjuels, uint24 accountingGas ); /** * @notice sets billing parameters * @param maximumGasPriceGwei highest gas price for which transmitter will be compensated * @param reasonableGasPriceGwei transmitter will receive reward for gas prices under this value * @param observationPaymentGjuels reward to oracle for contributing an observation to a successfully transmitted report * @param transmissionPaymentGjuels reward to transmitter of a successful report * @param accountingGas gas overhead incurred by accounting logic * @dev access control provided by billingAccessController */ function setBilling( uint32 maximumGasPriceGwei, uint32 reasonableGasPriceGwei, uint32 observationPaymentGjuels, uint32 transmissionPaymentGjuels, uint24 accountingGas ) external { AccessControllerInterface access = s_billingAccessController; require(msg.sender == owner() || access.hasAccess(msg.sender, msg.data), "Only owner&billingAdmin can call"); _payOracles(); s_hotVars.maximumGasPriceGwei = maximumGasPriceGwei; s_hotVars.reasonableGasPriceGwei = reasonableGasPriceGwei; s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels = observationPaymentGjuels; s_hotVars.transmissionPaymentGjuels = transmissionPaymentGjuels; s_hotVars.accountingGas = accountingGas; emit BillingSet(maximumGasPriceGwei, reasonableGasPriceGwei, observationPaymentGjuels, transmissionPaymentGjuels, accountingGas); } /** * @notice gets billing parameters * @param maximumGasPriceGwei highest gas price for which transmitter will be compensated * @param reasonableGasPriceGwei transmitter will receive reward for gas prices under this value * @param observationPaymentGjuels reward to oracle for contributing an observation to a successfully transmitted report * @param transmissionPaymentGjuels reward to transmitter of a successful report * @param accountingGas gas overhead of the accounting logic */ function getBilling() external view returns ( uint32 maximumGasPriceGwei, uint32 reasonableGasPriceGwei, uint32 observationPaymentGjuels, uint32 transmissionPaymentGjuels, uint24 accountingGas ) { return ( s_hotVars.maximumGasPriceGwei, s_hotVars.reasonableGasPriceGwei, s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels, s_hotVars.transmissionPaymentGjuels, s_hotVars.accountingGas ); } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Payments and Withdrawals **************************************************************************/ /** * @notice withdraws an oracle's payment from the contract * @param transmitter the transmitter address of the oracle * @dev must be called by oracle's payee address */ function withdrawPayment(address transmitter) external { require(msg.sender == s_payees[transmitter], "Only payee can withdraw"); _payOracle(transmitter); } /** * @notice query an oracle's payment amount, denominated in juels * @param transmitterAddress the transmitter address of the oracle */ function owedPayment(address transmitterAddress) public view returns (uint256) { Transmitter memory transmitter = s_transmitters[transmitterAddress]; if (!transmitter.active) { return 0; } // safe from overflow: // s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId - s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitter.index] <= 2**32 // s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels <= 2**32 // 1 gwei <= 2**32 // hence juelsAmount <= 2**96 uint256 juelsAmount = uint256(s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId - s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitter.index]) * uint256(s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels) * (1 gwei); juelsAmount += transmitter.paymentJuels; return juelsAmount; } /** * @notice emitted when an oracle has been paid LINK * @param transmitter address from which the oracle sends reports to the transmit method * @param payee address to which the payment is sent * @param amount amount of LINK sent * @param linkToken address of the LINK token contract */ event OraclePaid( address indexed transmitter, address indexed payee, uint256 amount, LinkTokenInterface indexed linkToken ); // _payOracle pays out transmitter's balance to the corresponding payee, and zeros it out function _payOracle(address transmitterAddress) internal { Transmitter memory transmitter = s_transmitters[transmitterAddress]; if (!transmitter.active) { return; } uint256 juelsAmount = owedPayment(transmitterAddress); if (juelsAmount > 0) { address payee = s_payees[transmitterAddress]; // Poses no re-entrancy issues, because LINK.transfer does not yield // control flow. require(s_linkToken.transfer(payee, juelsAmount), "insufficient funds"); s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitter.index] = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; s_transmitters[transmitterAddress].paymentJuels = 0; emit OraclePaid(transmitterAddress, payee, juelsAmount, s_linkToken); } } // _payOracles pays out all transmitters, and zeros out their balances. // // It's much more gas-efficient to do this as a single operation, to avoid // hitting storage too much. function _payOracles() internal { unchecked { LinkTokenInterface linkToken = s_linkToken; uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; uint32[maxNumOracles] memory rewardFromAggregatorRoundId = s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId; address[] memory transmitters = s_transmittersList; for (uint transmitteridx = 0; transmitteridx < transmitters.length; transmitteridx++) { uint256 reimbursementAmountJuels = s_transmitters[transmitters[transmitteridx]].paymentJuels; s_transmitters[transmitters[transmitteridx]].paymentJuels = 0; uint256 obsCount = latestAggregatorRoundId - rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitteridx]; uint256 juelsAmount = obsCount * uint256(s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels) * (1 gwei) + reimbursementAmountJuels; if (juelsAmount > 0) { address payee = s_payees[transmitters[transmitteridx]]; // Poses no re-entrancy issues, because LINK.transfer does not yield // control flow. require(linkToken.transfer(payee, juelsAmount), "insufficient funds"); rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitteridx] = latestAggregatorRoundId; emit OraclePaid(transmitters[transmitteridx], payee, juelsAmount, linkToken); } } // "Zero" the accounting storage variables s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId = rewardFromAggregatorRoundId; } } /** * @notice withdraw any available funds left in the contract, up to amount, after accounting for the funds due to participants in past reports * @param recipient address to send funds to * @param amount maximum amount to withdraw, denominated in LINK-wei. * @dev access control provided by billingAccessController */ function withdrawFunds( address recipient, uint256 amount ) external { require(msg.sender == owner() || s_billingAccessController.hasAccess(msg.sender, msg.data), "Only owner&billingAdmin can call"); uint256 linkDue = _totalLinkDue(); uint256 linkBalance = s_linkToken.balanceOf(address(this)); require(linkBalance >= linkDue, "insufficient balance"); require(s_linkToken.transfer(recipient, _min(linkBalance - linkDue, amount)), "insufficient funds"); } // Total LINK due to participants in past reports (denominated in Juels). function _totalLinkDue() internal view returns (uint256 linkDue) { // Argument for overflow safety: We do all computations in // uint256s. The inputs to linkDue are: // - the <= 31 observation rewards each of which has less than // 64 bits (32 bits for observationPaymentGjuels, 32 bits // for wei/gwei conversion). Hence 69 bits are sufficient for this part. // - the <= 31 gas reimbursements, each of which consists of at most 96 // bits. Hence 101 bits are sufficient for this part. // So we never need more than 102 bits. address[] memory transmitters = s_transmittersList; uint256 n = transmitters.length; uint32 latestAggregatorRoundId = s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId; uint32[maxNumOracles] memory rewardFromAggregatorRoundId = s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId; for (uint i = 0; i < n; i++) { linkDue += latestAggregatorRoundId - rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[i]; } // Convert observationPaymentGjuels to uint256, or this overflows! linkDue *= uint256(s_hotVars.observationPaymentGjuels) * (1 gwei); for (uint i = 0; i < n; i++) { linkDue += uint256(s_transmitters[transmitters[i]].paymentJuels); } } /** * @notice allows oracles to check that sufficient LINK balance is available * @return availableBalance LINK available on this contract, after accounting for outstanding obligations. can become negative */ function linkAvailableForPayment() external view returns (int256 availableBalance) { // there are at most one billion LINK, so this cast is safe int256 balance = int256(s_linkToken.balanceOf(address(this))); // according to the argument in the definition of _totalLinkDue, // _totalLinkDue is never greater than 2**102, so this cast is safe int256 due = int256(_totalLinkDue()); // safe from overflow according to above sizes return int256(balance) - int256(due); } /** * @notice number of observations oracle is due to be reimbursed for * @param transmitterAddress address used by oracle for signing or transmitting reports */ function oracleObservationCount(address transmitterAddress) external view returns (uint32) { Transmitter memory transmitter = s_transmitters[transmitterAddress]; if (!transmitter.active) { return 0; } return s_hotVars.latestAggregatorRoundId - s_rewardFromAggregatorRoundId[transmitter.index]; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Transmitter Payment **************************************************************************/ // Gas price at which the transmitter should be reimbursed, in gwei/gas function _reimbursementGasPriceGwei( uint256 txGasPriceGwei, uint256 reasonableGasPriceGwei, uint256 maximumGasPriceGwei ) internal pure returns (uint256) { // this happens on the path for transmissions. we'd rather pay out // a wrong reward than risk a liveness failure due to a revert. unchecked { // Reward the transmitter for choosing an efficient gas price: if they manage // to come in lower than considered reasonable, give them half the savings. uint256 gasPriceGwei = txGasPriceGwei; if (txGasPriceGwei < reasonableGasPriceGwei) { // Give transmitter half the savings for coming in under the reasonable gas price gasPriceGwei += (reasonableGasPriceGwei - txGasPriceGwei) / 2; } // Don't reimburse a gas price higher than maximumGasPriceGwei return _min(gasPriceGwei, maximumGasPriceGwei); } } // gas reimbursement due the transmitter, in wei function _transmitterGasCostWei( uint256 initialGas, uint256 gasPriceGwei, uint256 callDataGas, uint256 accountingGas, uint256 leftGas ) internal pure returns (uint256) { // this happens on the path for transmissions. we'd rather pay out // a wrong reward than risk a liveness failure due to a revert. unchecked { require(initialGas >= leftGas, "leftGas cannot exceed initialGas"); uint256 usedGas = initialGas - leftGas + // observed gas usage callDataGas + accountingGas; // estimated gas usage uint256 fullGasCostWei = usedGas * gasPriceGwei * (1 gwei); return fullGasCostWei; } } function _payTransmitter( HotVars memory hotVars, int192 juelsPerFeeCoin, uint32 initialGas, address transmitter ) internal virtual { // this happens on the path for transmissions. we'd rather pay out // a wrong reward than risk a liveness failure due to a revert. unchecked { // we can't deal with negative juelsPerFeeCoin, better to just not pay if (juelsPerFeeCoin < 0) { return; } // Reimburse transmitter of the report for gas usage uint256 gasPriceGwei = _reimbursementGasPriceGwei( tx.gasprice / (1 gwei), // convert to ETH-gwei units hotVars.reasonableGasPriceGwei, hotVars.maximumGasPriceGwei ); // The following is only an upper bound, as it ignores the cheaper cost for // 0 bytes. Safe from overflow, because calldata just isn't that long. uint256 callDataGasCost = 16 * msg.data.length; uint256 gasLeft = gasleft(); uint256 gasCostEthWei = _transmitterGasCostWei( uint256(initialGas), gasPriceGwei, callDataGasCost, hotVars.accountingGas, gasLeft ); // Even if we assume absurdly large values, this still does not overflow. With // - usedGas <= 1'000'000 gas <= 2**20 gas // - weiPerGas <= 1'000'000 gwei <= 2**50 wei // - hence gasCostEthWei <= 2**70 // - juelsPerFeeCoin <= 2**96 (more than the entire supply) // we still fit into 166 bits uint256 gasCostJuels = (gasCostEthWei * uint192(juelsPerFeeCoin))/1e18; uint96 oldTransmitterPaymentJuels = s_transmitters[transmitter].paymentJuels; uint96 newTransmitterPaymentJuels = uint96(uint256(oldTransmitterPaymentJuels) + gasCostJuels + uint256(hotVars.transmissionPaymentGjuels) * (1 gwei)); // overflow *should* never happen, but if it does, let's not persist it. if (newTransmitterPaymentJuels < oldTransmitterPaymentJuels) { return; } s_transmitters[transmitter].paymentJuels = newTransmitterPaymentJuels; } } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Payee Management **************************************************************************/ // Addresses at which oracles want to receive payments, by transmitter address mapping (address /* transmitter */ => address /* payment address */) internal s_payees; // Payee addresses which must be approved by the owner mapping (address /* transmitter */ => address /* payment address */) internal s_proposedPayees; /** * @notice emitted when a transfer of an oracle's payee address has been initiated * @param transmitter address from which the oracle sends reports to the transmit method * @param current the payee address for the oracle, prior to this setting * @param proposed the proposed new payee address for the oracle */ event PayeeshipTransferRequested( address indexed transmitter, address indexed current, address indexed proposed ); /** * @notice emitted when a transfer of an oracle's payee address has been completed * @param transmitter address from which the oracle sends reports to the transmit method * @param current the payee address for the oracle, prior to this setting */ event PayeeshipTransferred( address indexed transmitter, address indexed previous, address indexed current ); /** * @notice sets the payees for transmitting addresses * @param transmitters addresses oracles use to transmit the reports * @param payees addresses of payees corresponding to list of transmitters * @dev must be called by owner * @dev cannot be used to change payee addresses, only to initially populate them */ function setPayees( address[] calldata transmitters, address[] calldata payees ) external onlyOwner() { require(transmitters.length == payees.length, "transmitters.size != payees.size"); for (uint i = 0; i < transmitters.length; i++) { address transmitter = transmitters[i]; address payee = payees[i]; address currentPayee = s_payees[transmitter]; bool zeroedOut = currentPayee == address(0); require(zeroedOut || currentPayee == payee, "payee already set"); s_payees[transmitter] = payee; if (currentPayee != payee) { emit PayeeshipTransferred(transmitter, currentPayee, payee); } } } /** * @notice first step of payeeship transfer (safe transfer pattern) * @param transmitter transmitter address of oracle whose payee is changing * @param proposed new payee address * @dev can only be called by payee address */ function transferPayeeship( address transmitter, address proposed ) external { require(msg.sender == s_payees[transmitter], "only current payee can update"); require(msg.sender != proposed, "cannot transfer to self"); address previousProposed = s_proposedPayees[transmitter]; s_proposedPayees[transmitter] = proposed; if (previousProposed != proposed) { emit PayeeshipTransferRequested(transmitter, msg.sender, proposed); } } /** * @notice second step of payeeship transfer (safe transfer pattern) * @param transmitter transmitter address of oracle whose payee is changing * @dev can only be called by proposed new payee address */ function acceptPayeeship( address transmitter ) external { require(msg.sender == s_proposedPayees[transmitter], "only proposed payees can accept"); address currentPayee = s_payees[transmitter]; s_payees[transmitter] = msg.sender; s_proposedPayees[transmitter] = address(0); emit PayeeshipTransferred(transmitter, currentPayee, msg.sender); } /*************************************************************************** * Section: TypeAndVersionInterface **************************************************************************/ function typeAndVersion() external override pure virtual returns (string memory) { return "OCR2Aggregator 1.0.0"; } /*************************************************************************** * Section: Helper Functions **************************************************************************/ function _min( uint256 a, uint256 b ) internal pure returns (uint256) { unchecked { if (a < b) { return a; } return b; } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity =0.8.19; import "./interfaces/TypeAndVersionInterface.sol"; import "./lib/ConfigDigestUtilEVMSimple.sol"; import "./OwnerIsCreator.sol"; import "./OCR2Abstract.sol"; /// @title OCRConfigurationStoreEVMSimple /// @notice This contract stores configurations for protocol versions OCR2 and /// above in contract storage. It uses the "EVMSimple" config digester. contract OCRConfigurationStoreEVMSimple is TypeAndVersionInterface { struct ConfigurationEVMSimple { address[] signers; address[] transmitters; bytes onchainConfig; bytes offchainConfig; address contractAddress; uint64 offchainConfigVersion; uint32 configCount; uint8 f; } /// @notice a list of configurations keyed by their digest mapping(bytes32 => ConfigurationEVMSimple) internal s_configurations; /// @notice emitted when a new configuration is added event NewConfiguration(bytes32 indexed configDigest); /// @notice adds a new configuration to the store function addConfig(ConfigurationEVMSimple calldata configuration) external returns (bytes32) { bytes32 configDigest = ConfigDigestUtilEVMSimple.configDigestFromConfigData( block.chainid, configuration.contractAddress, configuration.configCount, configuration.signers, configuration.transmitters, configuration.f, configuration.onchainConfig, configuration.offchainConfigVersion, configuration.offchainConfig ); s_configurations[configDigest] = configuration; emit NewConfiguration(configDigest); return configDigest; } /// @notice reads a configuration from the store function readConfig(bytes32 configDigest) external view returns (ConfigurationEVMSimple memory) { return s_configurations[configDigest]; } /// @inheritdoc TypeAndVersionInterface function typeAndVersion() external override pure virtual returns (string memory) { return "OCRConfigurationStoreEVMSimple 1.0.0"; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./ConfirmedOwner.sol"; /** * @title The OwnerIsCreator contract * @notice A contract with helpers for basic contract ownership. */ contract OwnerIsCreator is ConfirmedOwner { constructor( ) ConfirmedOwner( msg.sender ) { } }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./SimpleWriteAccessController.sol"; /** * @title SimpleReadAccessController * @notice Gives access to: * - any externally owned account (note that offchain actors can always read * any contract storage regardless of onchain access control measures, so this * does not weaken the access control while improving usability) * - accounts explicitly added to an access list * @dev SimpleReadAccessController is not suitable for access controlling writes * since it grants any externally owned account access! See * SimpleWriteAccessController for that. */ contract SimpleReadAccessController is SimpleWriteAccessController { /** * @notice Returns the access of an address * @param _user The address to query */ function hasAccess( address _user, bytes memory _calldata ) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return super.hasAccess(_user, _calldata) || _user == tx.origin; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./OwnerIsCreator.sol"; import "./interfaces/AccessControllerInterface.sol"; /** * @title SimpleWriteAccessController * @notice Gives access to accounts explicitly added to an access list by the * controller's owner. * @dev does not make any special permissions for externally, see * SimpleReadAccessController for that. */ contract SimpleWriteAccessController is AccessControllerInterface, OwnerIsCreator { bool public checkEnabled; mapping(address => bool) internal accessList; event AddedAccess(address user); event RemovedAccess(address user); event CheckAccessEnabled(); event CheckAccessDisabled(); constructor() // TODO // this is modified from the version in the Chainlink monorepo // OwnerIsCreator() { checkEnabled = true; } /** * @notice Returns the access of an address * @param _user The address to query */ function hasAccess( address _user, bytes memory ) public view virtual override returns (bool) { return accessList[_user] || !checkEnabled; } /** * @notice Adds an address to the access list * @param _user The address to add */ function addAccess(address _user) external onlyOwner() { if (!accessList[_user]) { accessList[_user] = true; emit AddedAccess(_user); } } /** * @notice Removes an address from the access list * @param _user The address to remove */ function removeAccess(address _user) external onlyOwner() { if (accessList[_user]) { accessList[_user] = false; emit RemovedAccess(_user); } } /** * @notice makes the access check enforced */ function enableAccessCheck() external onlyOwner() { if (!checkEnabled) { checkEnabled = true; emit CheckAccessEnabled(); } } /** * @notice makes the access check unenforced */ function disableAccessCheck() external onlyOwner() { if (checkEnabled) { checkEnabled = false; emit CheckAccessDisabled(); } } /** * @dev reverts if the caller does not have access */ modifier checkAccess() { require(hasAccess(msg.sender, msg.data), "No access"); _; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface AccessControllerInterface { function hasAccess(address user, bytes calldata data) external view returns (bool); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface AggregatorInterface { function latestAnswer() external view returns (int256); function latestTimestamp() external view returns (uint256); function latestRound() external view returns (uint256); function getAnswer(uint256 roundId) external view returns (int256); function getTimestamp(uint256 roundId) external view returns (uint256); event AnswerUpdated(int256 indexed current, uint256 indexed roundId, uint256 updatedAt); event NewRound(uint256 indexed roundId, address indexed startedBy, uint256 startedAt); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; import "./AggregatorInterface.sol"; import "./AggregatorV3Interface.sol"; interface AggregatorV2V3Interface is AggregatorInterface, AggregatorV3Interface { }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface AggregatorV3Interface { function decimals() external view returns (uint8); function description() external view returns (string memory); function version() external view returns (uint256); function getRoundData(uint80 _roundId) external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); function latestRoundData() external view returns ( uint80 roundId, int256 answer, uint256 startedAt, uint256 updatedAt, uint80 answeredInRound ); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface AggregatorValidatorInterface { function validate( uint256 previousRoundId, int256 previousAnswer, uint256 currentRoundId, int256 currentAnswer ) external returns (bool); }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface LinkTokenInterface { function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256 remaining); function approve(address spender, uint256 value) external returns (bool success); function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance); function decimals() external view returns (uint8 decimalPlaces); function decreaseApproval(address spender, uint256 addedValue) external returns (bool success); function increaseApproval(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) external; function name() external view returns (string memory tokenName); function symbol() external view returns (string memory tokenSymbol); function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256 totalTokensIssued); function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool success); function transferAndCall(address to, uint256 value, bytes calldata data) external returns (bool success); function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool success); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface OwnableInterface { function owner() external returns ( address ); function transferOwnership( address recipient ) external; function acceptOwnership() external; } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; interface TypeAndVersionInterface{ function typeAndVersion() external pure returns (string memory); }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.0; /// @title ConfigDigestUtilEVMSimple /// @notice ConfigDigest related utility functions for "EVMSimple" config /// digester library ConfigDigestUtilEVMSimple { function configDigestFromConfigData( uint256 chainId, address contractAddress, uint64 configCount, address[] memory signers, address[] memory transmitters, uint8 f, bytes memory onchainConfig, uint64 offchainConfigVersion, bytes memory offchainConfig ) internal pure returns (bytes32) { uint256 hash = uint256( keccak256( abi.encode( chainId, contractAddress, configCount, signers, transmitters, f, onchainConfig, offchainConfigVersion, offchainConfig ))); uint256 prefixMask = type(uint256).max << (256-16); // 0xFFFF00..00 uint256 prefix = 0x0001 << (256-16); // 0x000100..00 return bytes32((prefix & prefixMask) | (hash & ~prefixMask)); } }
File 8 of 8: FiatTokenV2_2
/** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { EIP712Domain } from "./EIP712Domain.sol"; // solhint-disable-line no-unused-import import { Blacklistable } from "../v1/Blacklistable.sol"; // solhint-disable-line no-unused-import import { FiatTokenV1 } from "../v1/FiatTokenV1.sol"; // solhint-disable-line no-unused-import import { FiatTokenV2 } from "./FiatTokenV2.sol"; // solhint-disable-line no-unused-import import { FiatTokenV2_1 } from "./FiatTokenV2_1.sol"; import { EIP712 } from "../util/EIP712.sol"; // solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase /** * @title FiatToken V2.2 * @notice ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves, version 2.2 */ contract FiatTokenV2_2 is FiatTokenV2_1 { /** * @notice Initialize v2.2 * @param accountsToBlacklist A list of accounts to migrate from the old blacklist * @param newSymbol New token symbol * data structure to the new blacklist data structure. */ function initializeV2_2( address[] calldata accountsToBlacklist, string calldata newSymbol ) external { // solhint-disable-next-line reason-string require(_initializedVersion == 2); // Update fiat token symbol symbol = newSymbol; // Add previously blacklisted accounts to the new blacklist data structure // and remove them from the old blacklist data structure. for (uint256 i = 0; i < accountsToBlacklist.length; i++) { require( _deprecatedBlacklisted[accountsToBlacklist[i]], "FiatTokenV2_2: Blacklisting previously unblacklisted account!" ); _blacklist(accountsToBlacklist[i]); delete _deprecatedBlacklisted[accountsToBlacklist[i]]; } _blacklist(address(this)); delete _deprecatedBlacklisted[address(this)]; _initializedVersion = 3; } /** * @dev Internal function to get the current chain id. * @return The current chain id. */ function _chainId() internal virtual view returns (uint256) { uint256 chainId; assembly { chainId := chainid() } return chainId; } /** * @inheritdoc EIP712Domain */ function _domainSeparator() internal override view returns (bytes32) { return EIP712.makeDomainSeparator(name, "2", _chainId()); } /** * @notice Update allowance with a signed permit * @dev EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer) * @param spender Spender's address * @param value Amount of allowance * @param deadline The time at which the signature expires (unix time), or max uint256 value to signal no expiration * @param signature Signature bytes signed by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, bytes memory signature ) external whenNotPaused { _permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, signature); } /** * @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization * @dev EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param signature Signature bytes signed by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function transferWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) { _transferWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, signature ); } /** * @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer * @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address * matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks. * EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param signature Signature bytes signed by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function receiveWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) { _receiveWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, signature ); } /** * @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization * @dev Works only if the authorization is not yet used. * EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @param signature Signature bytes signed by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function cancelAuthorization( address authorizer, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) external whenNotPaused { _cancelAuthorization(authorizer, nonce, signature); } /** * @dev Helper method that sets the blacklist state of an account on balanceAndBlacklistStates. * If _shouldBlacklist is true, we apply a (1 << 255) bitmask with an OR operation on the * account's balanceAndBlacklistState. This flips the high bit for the account to 1, * indicating that the account is blacklisted. * * If _shouldBlacklist if false, we reset the account's balanceAndBlacklistStates to their * balances. This clears the high bit for the account, indicating that the account is unblacklisted. * @param _account The address of the account. * @param _shouldBlacklist True if the account should be blacklisted, false if the account should be unblacklisted. */ function _setBlacklistState(address _account, bool _shouldBlacklist) internal override { balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] = _shouldBlacklist ? balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] | (1 << 255) : _balanceOf(_account); } /** * @dev Helper method that sets the balance of an account on balanceAndBlacklistStates. * Since balances are stored in the last 255 bits of the balanceAndBlacklistStates value, * we need to ensure that the updated balance does not exceed (2^255 - 1). * Since blacklisted accounts' balances cannot be updated, the method will also * revert if the account is blacklisted * @param _account The address of the account. * @param _balance The new fiat token balance of the account (max: (2^255 - 1)). */ function _setBalance(address _account, uint256 _balance) internal override { require( _balance <= ((1 << 255) - 1), "FiatTokenV2_2: Balance exceeds (2^255 - 1)" ); require( !_isBlacklisted(_account), "FiatTokenV2_2: Account is blacklisted" ); balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] = _balance; } /** * @inheritdoc Blacklistable */ function _isBlacklisted(address _account) internal override view returns (bool) { return balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] >> 255 == 1; } /** * @dev Helper method to obtain the balance of an account. Since balances * are stored in the last 255 bits of the balanceAndBlacklistStates value, * we apply a ((1 << 255) - 1) bit bitmask with an AND operation on the * balanceAndBlacklistState to obtain the balance. * @param _account The address of the account. * @return The fiat token balance of the account. */ function _balanceOf(address _account) internal override view returns (uint256) { return balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] & ((1 << 255) - 1); } /** * @inheritdoc FiatTokenV1 */ function approve(address spender, uint256 value) external override whenNotPaused returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, value); return true; } /** * @inheritdoc FiatTokenV2 */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external override whenNotPaused { _permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, v, r, s); } /** * @inheritdoc FiatTokenV2 */ function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 increment) external override whenNotPaused returns (bool) { _increaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, increment); return true; } /** * @inheritdoc FiatTokenV2 */ function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 decrement) external override whenNotPaused returns (bool) { _decreaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, decrement); return true; } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type */ library Address { /** * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract. * * [IMPORTANT] * ==== * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract. * * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following * types of addresses: * * - an externally-owned account * - a contract in construction * - an address where a contract will be created * - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed * ==== */ function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) { // This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the // constructor execution. uint256 size; // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { size := extcodesize(account) } return size > 0; } /** * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors. * * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation. * * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more]. * * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using * {ReentrancyGuard} or the * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern]. */ function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal { require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }(""); require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"); } /** * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A * plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this * function instead. * * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this * function (like regular Solidity function calls). * * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value, * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`]. * * Requirements: * * - `target` must be a contract. * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`. * * Requirements: * * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`. * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts. * * _Available since v3.1._ */ function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call"); require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) { return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a static call. * * _Available since v3.3._ */ function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) { return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed"); } /** * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`], * but performing a delegate call. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) { require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract"); // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data); return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage); } function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) { if (success) { return returndata; } else { // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present if (returndata.length > 0) { // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly assembly { let returndata_size := mload(returndata) revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size) } } else { revert(errorMessage); } } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; import "./IERC20.sol"; import "../../math/SafeMath.sol"; import "../../utils/Address.sol"; /** * @title SafeERC20 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be * successful. * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract, * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc. */ library SafeERC20 { using SafeMath for uint256; using Address for address; function safeTransfer(IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value) internal { _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)); } function safeTransferFrom(IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value) internal { _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)); } /** * @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in * {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged. * * Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and * {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead. */ function safeApprove(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal { // safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance, // or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use // 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance' // solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length require((value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0), "SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance" ); _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value)); } function safeIncreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal { uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).add(value); _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance)); } function safeDecreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal { uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).sub(value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero"); _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance)); } /** * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false). * @param token The token targeted by the call. * @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants). */ function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private { // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since // we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that // the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call. bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed"); if (returndata.length > 0) { // Return data is optional // solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed"); } } } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP. */ interface IERC20 { /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence. */ function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`. */ function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is * zero by default. * * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256); /** * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the * desired value afterwards: * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729 * * Emits an {Approval} event. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's * allowance. * * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded. * * Emits a {Transfer} event. */ function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool); /** * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to * another (`to`). * * Note that `value` may be zero. */ event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value); /** * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance. */ event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value); } // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0; /** * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow * checks. * * Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result * in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an * error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages. * `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an * operation overflows. * * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always. */ library SafeMath { /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; if (c < a) return (false, 0); return (true, c); } /** * @dev Returns the substraction of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function trySub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b > a) return (false, 0); return (true, a - b); } /** * @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { // Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the // benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested. // See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522 if (a == 0) return (true, 0); uint256 c = a * b; if (c / a != b) return (false, 0); return (true, c); } /** * @dev Returns the division of two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b == 0) return (false, 0); return (true, a / b); } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag. * * _Available since v3.4._ */ function tryMod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) { if (b == 0) return (false, 0); return (true, a % b); } /** * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Addition cannot overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow"); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow"); return a - b; } /** * @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on * overflow. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Multiplication cannot overflow. */ function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { if (a == 0) return 0; uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow"); return c; } /** * @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting on * division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a * `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity * uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, "SafeMath: division by zero"); return a / b; } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo), * reverting when dividing by zero. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert` * opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an * invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, "SafeMath: modulo by zero"); return a % b; } /** * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * overflow (when the result is negative). * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {trySub}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator. * * Requirements: * * - Subtraction cannot overflow. */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a, errorMessage); return a - b; } /** * @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on * division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryDiv}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a * `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity * uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); return a / b; } /** * @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo), * reverting with custom message when dividing by zero. * * CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error * message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryMod}. * * Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert` * opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an * invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas). * * Requirements: * * - The divisor cannot be zero. */ function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0, errorMessage); return a % b; } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { FiatTokenV2 } from "./FiatTokenV2.sol"; // solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase /** * @title FiatToken V2.1 * @notice ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves, version 2.1 */ contract FiatTokenV2_1 is FiatTokenV2 { /** * @notice Initialize v2.1 * @param lostAndFound The address to which the locked funds are sent */ function initializeV2_1(address lostAndFound) external { // solhint-disable-next-line reason-string require(_initializedVersion == 1); uint256 lockedAmount = _balanceOf(address(this)); if (lockedAmount > 0) { _transfer(address(this), lostAndFound, lockedAmount); } _blacklist(address(this)); _initializedVersion = 2; } /** * @notice Version string for the EIP712 domain separator * @return Version string */ function version() external pure returns (string memory) { return "2"; } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { FiatTokenV1_1 } from "../v1.1/FiatTokenV1_1.sol"; import { EIP712 } from "../util/EIP712.sol"; import { EIP3009 } from "./EIP3009.sol"; import { EIP2612 } from "./EIP2612.sol"; /** * @title FiatToken V2 * @notice ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves, version 2 */ contract FiatTokenV2 is FiatTokenV1_1, EIP3009, EIP2612 { uint8 internal _initializedVersion; /** * @notice Initialize v2 * @param newName New token name */ function initializeV2(string calldata newName) external { // solhint-disable-next-line reason-string require(initialized && _initializedVersion == 0); name = newName; _DEPRECATED_CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = EIP712.makeDomainSeparator( newName, "2" ); _initializedVersion = 1; } /** * @notice Increase the allowance by a given increment * @param spender Spender's address * @param increment Amount of increase in allowance * @return True if successful */ function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 increment) external virtual whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(spender) returns (bool) { _increaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, increment); return true; } /** * @notice Decrease the allowance by a given decrement * @param spender Spender's address * @param decrement Amount of decrease in allowance * @return True if successful */ function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 decrement) external virtual whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(spender) returns (bool) { _decreaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, decrement); return true; } /** * @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function transferWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) { _transferWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, v, r, s ); } /** * @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer * @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address * matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function receiveWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) { _receiveWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, v, r, s ); } /** * @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization * @dev Works only if the authorization is not yet used. * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function cancelAuthorization( address authorizer, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external whenNotPaused { _cancelAuthorization(authorizer, nonce, v, r, s); } /** * @notice Update allowance with a signed permit * @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer) * @param spender Spender's address * @param value Amount of allowance * @param deadline The time at which the signature expires (unix time), or max uint256 value to signal no expiration * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) external virtual whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(owner) notBlacklisted(spender) { _permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, v, r, s); } /** * @dev Internal function to increase the allowance by a given increment * @param owner Token owner's address * @param spender Spender's address * @param increment Amount of increase */ function _increaseAllowance( address owner, address spender, uint256 increment ) internal override { _approve(owner, spender, allowed[owner][spender].add(increment)); } /** * @dev Internal function to decrease the allowance by a given decrement * @param owner Token owner's address * @param spender Spender's address * @param decrement Amount of decrease */ function _decreaseAllowance( address owner, address spender, uint256 decrement ) internal override { _approve( owner, spender, allowed[owner][spender].sub( decrement, "ERC20: decreased allowance below zero" ) ); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; // solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase /** * @title EIP712 Domain */ contract EIP712Domain { // was originally DOMAIN_SEPARATOR // but that has been moved to a method so we can override it in V2_2+ bytes32 internal _DEPRECATED_CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; /** * @notice Get the EIP712 Domain Separator. * @return The bytes32 EIP712 domain separator. */ function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32) { return _domainSeparator(); } /** * @dev Internal method to get the EIP712 Domain Separator. * @return The bytes32 EIP712 domain separator. */ function _domainSeparator() internal virtual view returns (bytes32) { return _DEPRECATED_CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR; } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { AbstractFiatTokenV2 } from "./AbstractFiatTokenV2.sol"; import { EIP712Domain } from "./EIP712Domain.sol"; import { SignatureChecker } from "../util/SignatureChecker.sol"; import { MessageHashUtils } from "../util/MessageHashUtils.sol"; /** * @title EIP-3009 * @notice Provide internal implementation for gas-abstracted transfers * @dev Contracts that inherit from this must wrap these with publicly * accessible functions, optionally adding modifiers where necessary */ abstract contract EIP3009 is AbstractFiatTokenV2, EIP712Domain { // keccak256("TransferWithAuthorization(address from,address to,uint256 value,uint256 validAfter,uint256 validBefore,bytes32 nonce)") bytes32 public constant TRANSFER_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0x7c7c6cdb67a18743f49ec6fa9b35f50d52ed05cbed4cc592e13b44501c1a2267; // keccak256("ReceiveWithAuthorization(address from,address to,uint256 value,uint256 validAfter,uint256 validBefore,bytes32 nonce)") bytes32 public constant RECEIVE_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0xd099cc98ef71107a616c4f0f941f04c322d8e254fe26b3c6668db87aae413de8; // keccak256("CancelAuthorization(address authorizer,bytes32 nonce)") bytes32 public constant CANCEL_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0x158b0a9edf7a828aad02f63cd515c68ef2f50ba807396f6d12842833a1597429; /** * @dev authorizer address => nonce => bool (true if nonce is used) */ mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => bool)) private _authorizationStates; event AuthorizationUsed(address indexed authorizer, bytes32 indexed nonce); event AuthorizationCanceled( address indexed authorizer, bytes32 indexed nonce ); /** * @notice Returns the state of an authorization * @dev Nonces are randomly generated 32-byte data unique to the * authorizer's address * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @return True if the nonce is used */ function authorizationState(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce) external view returns (bool) { return _authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce]; } /** * @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function _transferWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal { _transferWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, abi.encodePacked(r, s, v) ); } /** * @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization * @dev EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param signature Signature byte array produced by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function _transferWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) internal { _requireValidAuthorization(from, nonce, validAfter, validBefore); _requireValidSignature( from, keccak256( abi.encode( TRANSFER_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH, from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce ) ), signature ); _markAuthorizationAsUsed(from, nonce); _transfer(from, to, value); } /** * @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer * @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address * matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function _receiveWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal { _receiveWithAuthorization( from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce, abi.encodePacked(r, s, v) ); } /** * @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer * @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address * matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks. * EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param from Payer's address (Authorizer) * @param to Payee's address * @param value Amount to be transferred * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) * @param nonce Unique nonce * @param signature Signature byte array produced by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function _receiveWithAuthorization( address from, address to, uint256 value, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) internal { require(to == msg.sender, "FiatTokenV2: caller must be the payee"); _requireValidAuthorization(from, nonce, validAfter, validBefore); _requireValidSignature( from, keccak256( abi.encode( RECEIVE_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH, from, to, value, validAfter, validBefore, nonce ) ), signature ); _markAuthorizationAsUsed(from, nonce); _transfer(from, to, value); } /** * @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function _cancelAuthorization( address authorizer, bytes32 nonce, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal { _cancelAuthorization(authorizer, nonce, abi.encodePacked(r, s, v)); } /** * @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization * @dev EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @param signature Signature byte array produced by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function _cancelAuthorization( address authorizer, bytes32 nonce, bytes memory signature ) internal { _requireUnusedAuthorization(authorizer, nonce); _requireValidSignature( authorizer, keccak256( abi.encode(CANCEL_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH, authorizer, nonce) ), signature ); _authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce] = true; emit AuthorizationCanceled(authorizer, nonce); } /** * @notice Validates that signature against input data struct * @param signer Signer's address * @param dataHash Hash of encoded data struct * @param signature Signature byte array produced by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function _requireValidSignature( address signer, bytes32 dataHash, bytes memory signature ) private view { require( SignatureChecker.isValidSignatureNow( signer, MessageHashUtils.toTypedDataHash(_domainSeparator(), dataHash), signature ), "FiatTokenV2: invalid signature" ); } /** * @notice Check that an authorization is unused * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization */ function _requireUnusedAuthorization(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce) private view { require( !_authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce], "FiatTokenV2: authorization is used or canceled" ); } /** * @notice Check that authorization is valid * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization * @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time) * @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time) */ function _requireValidAuthorization( address authorizer, bytes32 nonce, uint256 validAfter, uint256 validBefore ) private view { require( now > validAfter, "FiatTokenV2: authorization is not yet valid" ); require(now < validBefore, "FiatTokenV2: authorization is expired"); _requireUnusedAuthorization(authorizer, nonce); } /** * @notice Mark an authorization as used * @param authorizer Authorizer's address * @param nonce Nonce of the authorization */ function _markAuthorizationAsUsed(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce) private { _authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce] = true; emit AuthorizationUsed(authorizer, nonce); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { AbstractFiatTokenV2 } from "./AbstractFiatTokenV2.sol"; import { EIP712Domain } from "./EIP712Domain.sol"; import { MessageHashUtils } from "../util/MessageHashUtils.sol"; import { SignatureChecker } from "../util/SignatureChecker.sol"; /** * @title EIP-2612 * @notice Provide internal implementation for gas-abstracted approvals */ abstract contract EIP2612 is AbstractFiatTokenV2, EIP712Domain { // keccak256("Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)") bytes32 public constant PERMIT_TYPEHASH = 0x6e71edae12b1b97f4d1f60370fef10105fa2faae0126114a169c64845d6126c9; mapping(address => uint256) private _permitNonces; /** * @notice Nonces for permit * @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer) * @return Next nonce */ function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256) { return _permitNonces[owner]; } /** * @notice Verify a signed approval permit and execute if valid * @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer) * @param spender Spender's address * @param value Amount of allowance * @param deadline The time at which the signature expires (unix time), or max uint256 value to signal no expiration * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature */ function _permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal { _permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, abi.encodePacked(r, s, v)); } /** * @notice Verify a signed approval permit and execute if valid * @dev EOA wallet signatures should be packed in the order of r, s, v. * @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer) * @param spender Spender's address * @param value Amount of allowance * @param deadline The time at which the signature expires (unix time), or max uint256 value to signal no expiration * @param signature Signature byte array signed by an EOA wallet or a contract wallet */ function _permit( address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, bytes memory signature ) internal { require( deadline == type(uint256).max || deadline >= now, "FiatTokenV2: permit is expired" ); bytes32 typedDataHash = MessageHashUtils.toTypedDataHash( _domainSeparator(), keccak256( abi.encode( PERMIT_TYPEHASH, owner, spender, value, _permitNonces[owner]++, deadline ) ) ); require( SignatureChecker.isValidSignatureNow( owner, typedDataHash, signature ), "EIP2612: invalid signature" ); _approve(owner, spender, value); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { AbstractFiatTokenV1 } from "../v1/AbstractFiatTokenV1.sol"; abstract contract AbstractFiatTokenV2 is AbstractFiatTokenV1 { function _increaseAllowance( address owner, address spender, uint256 increment ) internal virtual; function _decreaseAllowance( address owner, address spender, uint256 decrement ) internal virtual; } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT * * Copyright (c) 2016 Smart Contract Solutions, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ * * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy * of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal * in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights * to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell * copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is * furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: * * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in * copies or substantial portions of the Software. * * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE * AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, * OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE * SOFTWARE. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { Ownable } from "./Ownable.sol"; /** * @notice Base contract which allows children to implement an emergency stop * mechanism * @dev Forked from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/feb665136c0dae9912e08397c1a21c4af3651ef3/contracts/lifecycle/Pausable.sol * Modifications: * 1. Added pauser role, switched pause/unpause to be onlyPauser (6/14/2018) * 2. Removed whenNotPause/whenPaused from pause/unpause (6/14/2018) * 3. Removed whenPaused (6/14/2018) * 4. Switches ownable library to use ZeppelinOS (7/12/18) * 5. Remove constructor (7/13/18) * 6. Reformat, conform to Solidity 0.6 syntax and add error messages (5/13/20) * 7. Make public functions external (5/27/20) */ contract Pausable is Ownable { event Pause(); event Unpause(); event PauserChanged(address indexed newAddress); address public pauser; bool public paused = false; /** * @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is not paused. */ modifier whenNotPaused() { require(!paused, "Pausable: paused"); _; } /** * @dev throws if called by any account other than the pauser */ modifier onlyPauser() { require(msg.sender == pauser, "Pausable: caller is not the pauser"); _; } /** * @dev called by the owner to pause, triggers stopped state */ function pause() external onlyPauser { paused = true; emit Pause(); } /** * @dev called by the owner to unpause, returns to normal state */ function unpause() external onlyPauser { paused = false; emit Unpause(); } /** * @notice Updates the pauser address. * @param _newPauser The address of the new pauser. */ function updatePauser(address _newPauser) external onlyOwner { require( _newPauser != address(0), "Pausable: new pauser is the zero address" ); pauser = _newPauser; emit PauserChanged(pauser); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT * * Copyright (c) 2018 zOS Global Limited. * Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ * * Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy * of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal * in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights * to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell * copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is * furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: * * The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in * copies or substantial portions of the Software. * * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR * IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE * AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, * OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE * SOFTWARE. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; /** * @notice The Ownable contract has an owner address, and provides basic * authorization control functions * @dev Forked from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-labs/blob/3887ab77b8adafba4a26ace002f3a684c1a3388b/upgradeability_ownership/contracts/ownership/Ownable.sol * Modifications: * 1. Consolidate OwnableStorage into this contract (7/13/18) * 2. Reformat, conform to Solidity 0.6 syntax, and add error messages (5/13/20) * 3. Make public functions external (5/27/20) */ contract Ownable { // Owner of the contract address private _owner; /** * @dev Event to show ownership has been transferred * @param previousOwner representing the address of the previous owner * @param newOwner representing the address of the new owner */ event OwnershipTransferred(address previousOwner, address newOwner); /** * @dev The constructor sets the original owner of the contract to the sender account. */ constructor() public { setOwner(msg.sender); } /** * @dev Tells the address of the owner * @return the address of the owner */ function owner() external view returns (address) { return _owner; } /** * @dev Sets a new owner address */ function setOwner(address newOwner) internal { _owner = newOwner; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner. */ modifier onlyOwner() { require(msg.sender == _owner, "Ownable: caller is not the owner"); _; } /** * @dev Allows the current owner to transfer control of the contract to a newOwner. * @param newOwner The address to transfer ownership to. */ function transferOwnership(address newOwner) external onlyOwner { require( newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address" ); emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, newOwner); setOwner(newOwner); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { SafeMath } from "@openzeppelin/contracts/math/SafeMath.sol"; import { AbstractFiatTokenV1 } from "./AbstractFiatTokenV1.sol"; import { Ownable } from "./Ownable.sol"; import { Pausable } from "./Pausable.sol"; import { Blacklistable } from "./Blacklistable.sol"; /** * @title FiatToken * @dev ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves */ contract FiatTokenV1 is AbstractFiatTokenV1, Ownable, Pausable, Blacklistable { using SafeMath for uint256; string public name; string public symbol; uint8 public decimals; string public currency; address public masterMinter; bool internal initialized; /// @dev A mapping that stores the balance and blacklist states for a given address. /// The first bit defines whether the address is blacklisted (1 if blacklisted, 0 otherwise). /// The last 255 bits define the balance for the address. mapping(address => uint256) internal balanceAndBlacklistStates; mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) internal allowed; uint256 internal totalSupply_ = 0; mapping(address => bool) internal minters; mapping(address => uint256) internal minterAllowed; event Mint(address indexed minter, address indexed to, uint256 amount); event Burn(address indexed burner, uint256 amount); event MinterConfigured(address indexed minter, uint256 minterAllowedAmount); event MinterRemoved(address indexed oldMinter); event MasterMinterChanged(address indexed newMasterMinter); /** * @notice Initializes the fiat token contract. * @param tokenName The name of the fiat token. * @param tokenSymbol The symbol of the fiat token. * @param tokenCurrency The fiat currency that the token represents. * @param tokenDecimals The number of decimals that the token uses. * @param newMasterMinter The masterMinter address for the fiat token. * @param newPauser The pauser address for the fiat token. * @param newBlacklister The blacklister address for the fiat token. * @param newOwner The owner of the fiat token. */ function initialize( string memory tokenName, string memory tokenSymbol, string memory tokenCurrency, uint8 tokenDecimals, address newMasterMinter, address newPauser, address newBlacklister, address newOwner ) public { require(!initialized, "FiatToken: contract is already initialized"); require( newMasterMinter != address(0), "FiatToken: new masterMinter is the zero address" ); require( newPauser != address(0), "FiatToken: new pauser is the zero address" ); require( newBlacklister != address(0), "FiatToken: new blacklister is the zero address" ); require( newOwner != address(0), "FiatToken: new owner is the zero address" ); name = tokenName; symbol = tokenSymbol; currency = tokenCurrency; decimals = tokenDecimals; masterMinter = newMasterMinter; pauser = newPauser; blacklister = newBlacklister; setOwner(newOwner); initialized = true; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than a minter. */ modifier onlyMinters() { require(minters[msg.sender], "FiatToken: caller is not a minter"); _; } /** * @notice Mints fiat tokens to an address. * @param _to The address that will receive the minted tokens. * @param _amount The amount of tokens to mint. Must be less than or equal * to the minterAllowance of the caller. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount) external whenNotPaused onlyMinters notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(_to) returns (bool) { require(_to != address(0), "FiatToken: mint to the zero address"); require(_amount > 0, "FiatToken: mint amount not greater than 0"); uint256 mintingAllowedAmount = minterAllowed[msg.sender]; require( _amount <= mintingAllowedAmount, "FiatToken: mint amount exceeds minterAllowance" ); totalSupply_ = totalSupply_.add(_amount); _setBalance(_to, _balanceOf(_to).add(_amount)); minterAllowed[msg.sender] = mintingAllowedAmount.sub(_amount); emit Mint(msg.sender, _to, _amount); emit Transfer(address(0), _to, _amount); return true; } /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the masterMinter */ modifier onlyMasterMinter() { require( msg.sender == masterMinter, "FiatToken: caller is not the masterMinter" ); _; } /** * @notice Gets the minter allowance for an account. * @param minter The address to check. * @return The remaining minter allowance for the account. */ function minterAllowance(address minter) external view returns (uint256) { return minterAllowed[minter]; } /** * @notice Checks if an account is a minter. * @param account The address to check. * @return True if the account is a minter, false if the account is not a minter. */ function isMinter(address account) external view returns (bool) { return minters[account]; } /** * @notice Gets the remaining amount of fiat tokens a spender is allowed to transfer on * behalf of the token owner. * @param owner The token owner's address. * @param spender The spender's address. * @return The remaining allowance. */ function allowance(address owner, address spender) external override view returns (uint256) { return allowed[owner][spender]; } /** * @notice Gets the totalSupply of the fiat token. * @return The totalSupply of the fiat token. */ function totalSupply() external override view returns (uint256) { return totalSupply_; } /** * @notice Gets the fiat token balance of an account. * @param account The address to check. * @return balance The fiat token balance of the account. */ function balanceOf(address account) external override view returns (uint256) { return _balanceOf(account); } /** * @notice Sets a fiat token allowance for a spender to spend on behalf of the caller. * @param spender The spender's address. * @param value The allowance amount. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function approve(address spender, uint256 value) external virtual override whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(spender) returns (bool) { _approve(msg.sender, spender, value); return true; } /** * @dev Internal function to set allowance. * @param owner Token owner's address. * @param spender Spender's address. * @param value Allowance amount. */ function _approve( address owner, address spender, uint256 value ) internal override { require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address"); require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address"); allowed[owner][spender] = value; emit Approval(owner, spender, value); } /** * @notice Transfers tokens from an address to another by spending the caller's allowance. * @dev The caller must have some fiat token allowance on the payer's tokens. * @param from Payer's address. * @param to Payee's address. * @param value Transfer amount. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function transferFrom( address from, address to, uint256 value ) external override whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) returns (bool) { require( value <= allowed[from][msg.sender], "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance" ); _transfer(from, to, value); allowed[from][msg.sender] = allowed[from][msg.sender].sub(value); return true; } /** * @notice Transfers tokens from the caller. * @param to Payee's address. * @param value Transfer amount. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external override whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(msg.sender) notBlacklisted(to) returns (bool) { _transfer(msg.sender, to, value); return true; } /** * @dev Internal function to process transfers. * @param from Payer's address. * @param to Payee's address. * @param value Transfer amount. */ function _transfer( address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal override { require(from != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address"); require(to != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address"); require( value <= _balanceOf(from), "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance" ); _setBalance(from, _balanceOf(from).sub(value)); _setBalance(to, _balanceOf(to).add(value)); emit Transfer(from, to, value); } /** * @notice Adds or updates a new minter with a mint allowance. * @param minter The address of the minter. * @param minterAllowedAmount The minting amount allowed for the minter. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function configureMinter(address minter, uint256 minterAllowedAmount) external whenNotPaused onlyMasterMinter returns (bool) { minters[minter] = true; minterAllowed[minter] = minterAllowedAmount; emit MinterConfigured(minter, minterAllowedAmount); return true; } /** * @notice Removes a minter. * @param minter The address of the minter to remove. * @return True if the operation was successful. */ function removeMinter(address minter) external onlyMasterMinter returns (bool) { minters[minter] = false; minterAllowed[minter] = 0; emit MinterRemoved(minter); return true; } /** * @notice Allows a minter to burn some of its own tokens. * @dev The caller must be a minter, must not be blacklisted, and the amount to burn * should be less than or equal to the account's balance. * @param _amount the amount of tokens to be burned. */ function burn(uint256 _amount) external whenNotPaused onlyMinters notBlacklisted(msg.sender) { uint256 balance = _balanceOf(msg.sender); require(_amount > 0, "FiatToken: burn amount not greater than 0"); require(balance >= _amount, "FiatToken: burn amount exceeds balance"); totalSupply_ = totalSupply_.sub(_amount); _setBalance(msg.sender, balance.sub(_amount)); emit Burn(msg.sender, _amount); emit Transfer(msg.sender, address(0), _amount); } /** * @notice Updates the master minter address. * @param _newMasterMinter The address of the new master minter. */ function updateMasterMinter(address _newMasterMinter) external onlyOwner { require( _newMasterMinter != address(0), "FiatToken: new masterMinter is the zero address" ); masterMinter = _newMasterMinter; emit MasterMinterChanged(masterMinter); } /** * @inheritdoc Blacklistable */ function _blacklist(address _account) internal override { _setBlacklistState(_account, true); } /** * @inheritdoc Blacklistable */ function _unBlacklist(address _account) internal override { _setBlacklistState(_account, false); } /** * @dev Helper method that sets the blacklist state of an account. * @param _account The address of the account. * @param _shouldBlacklist True if the account should be blacklisted, false if the account should be unblacklisted. */ function _setBlacklistState(address _account, bool _shouldBlacklist) internal virtual { _deprecatedBlacklisted[_account] = _shouldBlacklist; } /** * @dev Helper method that sets the balance of an account. * @param _account The address of the account. * @param _balance The new fiat token balance of the account. */ function _setBalance(address _account, uint256 _balance) internal virtual { balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account] = _balance; } /** * @inheritdoc Blacklistable */ function _isBlacklisted(address _account) internal virtual override view returns (bool) { return _deprecatedBlacklisted[_account]; } /** * @dev Helper method to obtain the balance of an account. * @param _account The address of the account. * @return The fiat token balance of the account. */ function _balanceOf(address _account) internal virtual view returns (uint256) { return balanceAndBlacklistStates[_account]; } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { Ownable } from "./Ownable.sol"; /** * @title Blacklistable Token * @dev Allows accounts to be blacklisted by a "blacklister" role */ abstract contract Blacklistable is Ownable { address public blacklister; mapping(address => bool) internal _deprecatedBlacklisted; event Blacklisted(address indexed _account); event UnBlacklisted(address indexed _account); event BlacklisterChanged(address indexed newBlacklister); /** * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the blacklister. */ modifier onlyBlacklister() { require( msg.sender == blacklister, "Blacklistable: caller is not the blacklister" ); _; } /** * @dev Throws if argument account is blacklisted. * @param _account The address to check. */ modifier notBlacklisted(address _account) { require( !_isBlacklisted(_account), "Blacklistable: account is blacklisted" ); _; } /** * @notice Checks if account is blacklisted. * @param _account The address to check. * @return True if the account is blacklisted, false if the account is not blacklisted. */ function isBlacklisted(address _account) external view returns (bool) { return _isBlacklisted(_account); } /** * @notice Adds account to blacklist. * @param _account The address to blacklist. */ function blacklist(address _account) external onlyBlacklister { _blacklist(_account); emit Blacklisted(_account); } /** * @notice Removes account from blacklist. * @param _account The address to remove from the blacklist. */ function unBlacklist(address _account) external onlyBlacklister { _unBlacklist(_account); emit UnBlacklisted(_account); } /** * @notice Updates the blacklister address. * @param _newBlacklister The address of the new blacklister. */ function updateBlacklister(address _newBlacklister) external onlyOwner { require( _newBlacklister != address(0), "Blacklistable: new blacklister is the zero address" ); blacklister = _newBlacklister; emit BlacklisterChanged(blacklister); } /** * @dev Checks if account is blacklisted. * @param _account The address to check. * @return true if the account is blacklisted, false otherwise. */ function _isBlacklisted(address _account) internal virtual view returns (bool); /** * @dev Helper method that blacklists an account. * @param _account The address to blacklist. */ function _blacklist(address _account) internal virtual; /** * @dev Helper method that unblacklists an account. * @param _account The address to unblacklist. */ function _unBlacklist(address _account) internal virtual; } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { IERC20 } from "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol"; abstract contract AbstractFiatTokenV1 is IERC20 { function _approve( address owner, address spender, uint256 value ) internal virtual; function _transfer( address from, address to, uint256 value ) internal virtual; } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { Ownable } from "../v1/Ownable.sol"; import { IERC20 } from "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol"; import { SafeERC20 } from "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/SafeERC20.sol"; contract Rescuable is Ownable { using SafeERC20 for IERC20; address private _rescuer; event RescuerChanged(address indexed newRescuer); /** * @notice Returns current rescuer * @return Rescuer's address */ function rescuer() external view returns (address) { return _rescuer; } /** * @notice Revert if called by any account other than the rescuer. */ modifier onlyRescuer() { require(msg.sender == _rescuer, "Rescuable: caller is not the rescuer"); _; } /** * @notice Rescue ERC20 tokens locked up in this contract. * @param tokenContract ERC20 token contract address * @param to Recipient address * @param amount Amount to withdraw */ function rescueERC20( IERC20 tokenContract, address to, uint256 amount ) external onlyRescuer { tokenContract.safeTransfer(to, amount); } /** * @notice Updates the rescuer address. * @param newRescuer The address of the new rescuer. */ function updateRescuer(address newRescuer) external onlyOwner { require( newRescuer != address(0), "Rescuable: new rescuer is the zero address" ); _rescuer = newRescuer; emit RescuerChanged(newRescuer); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { FiatTokenV1 } from "../v1/FiatTokenV1.sol"; import { Rescuable } from "./Rescuable.sol"; /** * @title FiatTokenV1_1 * @dev ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves */ contract FiatTokenV1_1 is FiatTokenV1, Rescuable { } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; import { ECRecover } from "./ECRecover.sol"; import { IERC1271 } from "../interface/IERC1271.sol"; /** * @dev Signature verification helper that can be used instead of `ECRecover.recover` to seamlessly support both ECDSA * signatures from externally owned accounts (EOAs) as well as ERC1271 signatures from smart contract wallets. * * Adapted from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/21bb89ef5bfc789b9333eb05e3ba2b7b284ac77c/contracts/utils/cryptography/SignatureChecker.sol */ library SignatureChecker { /** * @dev Checks if a signature is valid for a given signer and data hash. If the signer is a smart contract, the * signature is validated against that smart contract using ERC1271, otherwise it's validated using `ECRecover.recover`. * @param signer Address of the claimed signer * @param digest Keccak-256 hash digest of the signed message * @param signature Signature byte array associated with hash */ function isValidSignatureNow( address signer, bytes32 digest, bytes memory signature ) external view returns (bool) { if (!isContract(signer)) { return ECRecover.recover(digest, signature) == signer; } return isValidERC1271SignatureNow(signer, digest, signature); } /** * @dev Checks if a signature is valid for a given signer and data hash. The signature is validated * against the signer smart contract using ERC1271. * @param signer Address of the claimed signer * @param digest Keccak-256 hash digest of the signed message * @param signature Signature byte array associated with hash * * NOTE: Unlike ECDSA signatures, contract signatures are revocable, and the outcome of this function can thus * change through time. It could return true at block N and false at block N+1 (or the opposite). */ function isValidERC1271SignatureNow( address signer, bytes32 digest, bytes memory signature ) internal view returns (bool) { (bool success, bytes memory result) = signer.staticcall( abi.encodeWithSelector( IERC1271.isValidSignature.selector, digest, signature ) ); return (success && result.length >= 32 && abi.decode(result, (bytes32)) == bytes32(IERC1271.isValidSignature.selector)); } /** * @dev Checks if the input address is a smart contract. */ function isContract(address addr) internal view returns (bool) { uint256 size; assembly { size := extcodesize(addr) } return size > 0; } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; /** * @dev Signature message hash utilities for producing digests to be consumed by {ECDSA} recovery or signing. * * The library provides methods for generating a hash of a message that conforms to the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-191[EIP 191] and https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] * specifications. */ library MessageHashUtils { /** * @dev Returns the keccak256 digest of an EIP-712 typed data (EIP-191 version `0x01`). * Adapted from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/21bb89ef5bfc789b9333eb05e3ba2b7b284ac77c/contracts/utils/cryptography/MessageHashUtils.sol * * The digest is calculated from a `domainSeparator` and a `structHash`, by prefixing them with * `\\x19\\x01` and hashing the result. It corresponds to the hash signed by the * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[`eth_signTypedData`] JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-712. * * @param domainSeparator Domain separator * @param structHash Hashed EIP-712 data struct * @return digest The keccak256 digest of an EIP-712 typed data */ function toTypedDataHash(bytes32 domainSeparator, bytes32 structHash) internal pure returns (bytes32 digest) { assembly { let ptr := mload(0x40) mstore(ptr, "\\x19\\x01") mstore(add(ptr, 0x02), domainSeparator) mstore(add(ptr, 0x22), structHash) digest := keccak256(ptr, 0x42) } } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; /** * @title EIP712 * @notice A library that provides EIP712 helper functions */ library EIP712 { /** * @notice Make EIP712 domain separator * @param name Contract name * @param version Contract version * @param chainId Blockchain ID * @return Domain separator */ function makeDomainSeparator( string memory name, string memory version, uint256 chainId ) internal view returns (bytes32) { return keccak256( abi.encode( // keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)") 0x8b73c3c69bb8fe3d512ecc4cf759cc79239f7b179b0ffacaa9a75d522b39400f, keccak256(bytes(name)), keccak256(bytes(version)), chainId, address(this) ) ); } /** * @notice Make EIP712 domain separator * @param name Contract name * @param version Contract version * @return Domain separator */ function makeDomainSeparator(string memory name, string memory version) internal view returns (bytes32) { uint256 chainId; assembly { chainId := chainid() } return makeDomainSeparator(name, version, chainId); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; /** * @title ECRecover * @notice A library that provides a safe ECDSA recovery function */ library ECRecover { /** * @notice Recover signer's address from a signed message * @dev Adapted from: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/65e4ffde586ec89af3b7e9140bdc9235d1254853/contracts/cryptography/ECDSA.sol * Modifications: Accept v, r, and s as separate arguments * @param digest Keccak-256 hash digest of the signed message * @param v v of the signature * @param r r of the signature * @param s s of the signature * @return Signer address */ function recover( bytes32 digest, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s ) internal pure returns (address) { // EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature // unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines // the valid range for s in (281): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (282): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most // signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order. // // If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value // with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or // vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept // these malleable signatures as well. if ( uint256(s) > 0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0 ) { revert("ECRecover: invalid signature 's' value"); } if (v != 27 && v != 28) { revert("ECRecover: invalid signature 'v' value"); } // If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address address signer = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s); require(signer != address(0), "ECRecover: invalid signature"); return signer; } /** * @notice Recover signer's address from a signed message * @dev Adapted from: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/0053ee040a7ff1dbc39691c9e67a69f564930a88/contracts/utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol * @param digest Keccak-256 hash digest of the signed message * @param signature Signature byte array associated with hash * @return Signer address */ function recover(bytes32 digest, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address) { require(signature.length == 65, "ECRecover: invalid signature length"); bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint8 v; // ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them // currently is to use assembly. /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly assembly { r := mload(add(signature, 0x20)) s := mload(add(signature, 0x40)) v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60))) } return recover(digest, v, r, s); } } /** * SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 * * Copyright (c) 2023, Circle Internet Financial, LLC. * * Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); * you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. * You may obtain a copy of the License at * * http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 * * Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software * distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, * WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. * See the License for the specific language governing permissions and * limitations under the License. */ pragma solidity 0.6.12; /** * @dev Interface of the ERC1271 standard signature validation method for * contracts as defined in https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1271[ERC-1271]. */ interface IERC1271 { /** * @dev Should return whether the signature provided is valid for the provided data * @param hash Hash of the data to be signed * @param signature Signature byte array associated with the provided data hash * @return magicValue bytes4 magic value 0x1626ba7e when function passes */ function isValidSignature(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) external view returns (bytes4 magicValue); }